1
2 /* pngvalid.c - validate libpng by constructing then reading png files.
3 *
4 * Copyright (c) 2021 Cosmin Truta
5 * Copyright (c) 2014-2017 John Cunningham Bowler
6 *
7 * This code is released under the libpng license.
8 * For conditions of distribution and use, see the disclaimer
9 * and license in png.h
10 *
11 * NOTES:
12 * This is a C program that is intended to be linked against libpng. It
13 * generates bitmaps internally, stores them as PNG files (using the
14 * sequential write code) then reads them back (using the sequential
15 * read code) and validates that the result has the correct data.
16 *
17 * The program can be modified and extended to test the correctness of
18 * transformations performed by libpng.
19 */
20
21 #define _POSIX_SOURCE 1
22 #define _ISOC99_SOURCE 1 /* For floating point */
23 #define _GNU_SOURCE 1 /* For the floating point exception extension */
24 #define _BSD_SOURCE 1 /* For the floating point exception extension */
25 #define _DEFAULT_SOURCE 1 /* For the floating point exception extension */
26
27 #include <signal.h>
28 #include <stdio.h>
29
30 #if defined(HAVE_CONFIG_H) && !defined(PNG_NO_CONFIG_H)
31 # include <config.h>
32 #endif
33
34 #ifdef HAVE_FEENABLEEXCEPT /* from config.h, if included */
35 # include <fenv.h>
36 #endif
37
38 #ifndef FE_DIVBYZERO
39 # define FE_DIVBYZERO 0
40 #endif
41 #ifndef FE_INVALID
42 # define FE_INVALID 0
43 #endif
44 #ifndef FE_OVERFLOW
45 # define FE_OVERFLOW 0
46 #endif
47
48 /* Define the following to use this test against your installed libpng, rather
49 * than the one being built here:
50 */
51 #ifdef PNG_FREESTANDING_TESTS
52 # include <png.h>
53 #else
54 # include "../../png.h"
55 #endif
56
57 #ifdef PNG_ZLIB_HEADER
58 # include PNG_ZLIB_HEADER
59 #else
60 # include <zlib.h> /* For crc32 */
61 #endif
62
63 /* 1.6.1 added support for the configure test harness, which uses 77 to indicate
64 * a skipped test, in earlier versions we need to succeed on a skipped test, so:
65 */
66 #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10601 && defined(HAVE_CONFIG_H)
67 # define SKIP 77
68 #else
69 # define SKIP 0
70 #endif
71
72 /* pngvalid requires write support and one of the fixed or floating point APIs.
73 */
74 #if defined(PNG_WRITE_SUPPORTED) &&\
75 (defined(PNG_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED) || defined(PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED))
76
77 #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10500
78 /* This deliberately lacks the const. */
79 typedef png_byte *png_const_bytep;
80
81 /* This is copied from 1.5.1 png.h: */
82 #define PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7_PASSES 7
83 #define PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass) (((1U&~(pass))<<(3-((pass)>>1)))&7)
84 #define PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass) (((1U& (pass))<<(3-(((pass)+1)>>1)))&7)
85 #define PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass) ((pass)>2?(8-(pass))>>1:3)
86 #define PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass) ((pass)>1?(7-(pass))>>1:3)
87 #define PNG_PASS_ROWS(height, pass) (((height)+(((1<<PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass))\
88 -1)-PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass)))>>PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass))
89 #define PNG_PASS_COLS(width, pass) (((width)+(((1<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass))\
90 -1)-PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass)))>>PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass))
91 #define PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(yIn, pass) \
92 (((yIn)<<PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass))+PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass))
93 #define PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(xIn, pass) \
94 (((xIn)<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass))+PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass))
95 #define PNG_PASS_MASK(pass,off) ( \
96 ((0x110145AFU>>(((7-(off))-(pass))<<2)) & 0xFU) | \
97 ((0x01145AF0U>>(((7-(off))-(pass))<<2)) & 0xF0U))
98 #define PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass) \
99 ((PNG_PASS_MASK(pass,0) >> ((y)&7)) & 1)
100 #define PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(x, pass) \
101 ((PNG_PASS_MASK(pass,1) >> ((x)&7)) & 1)
102
103 /* These are needed too for the default build: */
104 #define PNG_WRITE_16BIT_SUPPORTED
105 #define PNG_READ_16BIT_SUPPORTED
106
107 /* This comes from pnglibconf.h after 1.5: */
108 #define PNG_FP_1 100000
109 #define PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD_FIXED\
110 ((png_fixed_point)(PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD * PNG_FP_1))
111 #endif
112
113 #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10600
114 /* 1.6.0 constifies many APIs, the following exists to allow pngvalid to be
115 * compiled against earlier versions.
116 */
117 # define png_const_structp png_structp
118 #endif
119
120 #ifndef RELEASE_BUILD
121 /* RELEASE_BUILD is true for releases and release candidates: */
122 # define RELEASE_BUILD (PNG_LIBPNG_BUILD_BASE_TYPE >= PNG_LIBPNG_BUILD_RC)
123 #endif
124 #if RELEASE_BUILD
125 # define debugonly(something)
126 #else /* !RELEASE_BUILD */
127 # define debugonly(something) something
128 #endif /* !RELEASE_BUILD */
129
130 #include <float.h> /* For floating point constants */
131 #include <stdlib.h> /* For malloc */
132 #include <string.h> /* For memcpy, memset */
133 #include <math.h> /* For floor */
134
135 /* Convenience macros. */
136 #define CHUNK(a,b,c,d) (((a)<<24)+((b)<<16)+((c)<<8)+(d))
137 #define CHUNK_IHDR CHUNK(73,72,68,82)
138 #define CHUNK_PLTE CHUNK(80,76,84,69)
139 #define CHUNK_IDAT CHUNK(73,68,65,84)
140 #define CHUNK_IEND CHUNK(73,69,78,68)
141 #define CHUNK_cHRM CHUNK(99,72,82,77)
142 #define CHUNK_gAMA CHUNK(103,65,77,65)
143 #define CHUNK_sBIT CHUNK(115,66,73,84)
144 #define CHUNK_sRGB CHUNK(115,82,71,66)
145
146 /* Unused formal parameter errors are removed using the following macro which is
147 * expected to have no bad effects on performance.
148 */
149 #ifndef UNUSED
150 # if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(_MSC_VER)
151 # define UNUSED(param) (void)param;
152 # else
153 # define UNUSED(param)
154 # endif
155 #endif
156
157 /***************************** EXCEPTION HANDLING *****************************/
158 #ifdef PNG_FREESTANDING_TESTS
159 # include <cexcept.h>
160 #else
161 # include "../visupng/cexcept.h"
162 #endif
163
164 #ifdef __cplusplus
165 # define this not_the_cpp_this
166 # define new not_the_cpp_new
167 # define voidcast(type, value) static_cast<type>(value)
168 #else
169 # define voidcast(type, value) (value)
170 #endif /* __cplusplus */
171
172 struct png_store;
173 define_exception_type(struct png_store*);
174
175 /* The following are macros to reduce typing everywhere where the well known
176 * name 'the_exception_context' must be defined.
177 */
178 #define anon_context(ps) struct exception_context *the_exception_context = \
179 &(ps)->exception_context
180 #define context(ps,fault) anon_context(ps); png_store *fault
181
182 /* This macro returns the number of elements in an array as an (unsigned int),
183 * it is necessary to avoid the inability of certain versions of GCC to use
184 * the value of a compile-time constant when performing range checks. It must
185 * be passed an array name.
186 */
187 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) ((unsigned int)((sizeof (a))/(sizeof (a)[0])))
188
189 /* GCC BUG 66447 (https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=66447) requires
190 * some broken GCC versions to be fixed up to avoid invalid whining about auto
191 * variables that are *not* changed within the scope of a setjmp being changed.
192 *
193 * Feel free to extend the list of broken versions.
194 */
195 #define is_gnu(major,minor)\
196 (defined __GNUC__) && __GNUC__ == (major) && __GNUC_MINOR__ == (minor)
197 #define is_gnu_patch(major,minor,patch)\
198 is_gnu(major,minor) && __GNUC_PATCHLEVEL__ == 0
199 /* For the moment just do it always; all versions of GCC seem to be broken: */
200 #ifdef __GNUC__
201 const void * volatile make_volatile_for_gnu;
202 # define gnu_volatile(x) make_volatile_for_gnu = &x;
203 #else /* !GNUC broken versions */
204 # define gnu_volatile(x)
205 #endif /* !GNUC broken versions */
206
207 /******************************* UTILITIES ************************************/
208 /* Error handling is particularly problematic in production code - error
209 * handlers often themselves have bugs which lead to programs that detect
210 * minor errors crashing. The following functions deal with one very
211 * common class of errors in error handlers - attempting to format error or
212 * warning messages into buffers that are too small.
213 */
safecat(char * buffer,size_t bufsize,size_t pos,const char * cat)214 static size_t safecat(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos,
215 const char *cat)
216 {
217 while (pos < bufsize && cat != NULL && *cat != 0)
218 buffer[pos++] = *cat++;
219
220 if (pos >= bufsize)
221 pos = bufsize-1;
222
223 buffer[pos] = 0;
224 return pos;
225 }
226
safecatn(char * buffer,size_t bufsize,size_t pos,int n)227 static size_t safecatn(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, int n)
228 {
229 char number[64];
230 sprintf(number, "%d", n);
231 return safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, number);
232 }
233
234 #ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
safecatd(char * buffer,size_t bufsize,size_t pos,double d,int precision)235 static size_t safecatd(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, double d,
236 int precision)
237 {
238 char number[64];
239 sprintf(number, "%.*f", precision, d);
240 return safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, number);
241 }
242 #endif
243
244 static const char invalid[] = "invalid";
245 static const char sep[] = ": ";
246
247 static const char *colour_types[8] =
248 {
249 "grayscale", invalid, "truecolour", "indexed-colour",
250 "grayscale with alpha", invalid, "truecolour with alpha", invalid
251 };
252
253 #ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
254 /* Convert a double precision value to fixed point. */
255 static png_fixed_point
fix(double d)256 fix(double d)
257 {
258 d = floor(d * PNG_FP_1 + .5);
259 return (png_fixed_point)d;
260 }
261 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
262
263 /* Generate random bytes. This uses a boring repeatable algorithm and it
264 * is implemented here so that it gives the same set of numbers on every
265 * architecture. It's a linear congruential generator (Knuth or Sedgewick
266 * "Algorithms") but it comes from the 'feedback taps' table in Horowitz and
267 * Hill, "The Art of Electronics" (Pseudo-Random Bit Sequences and Noise
268 * Generation.)
269 */
270 static void
make_random_bytes(png_uint_32 * seed,void * pv,size_t size)271 make_random_bytes(png_uint_32* seed, void* pv, size_t size)
272 {
273 png_uint_32 u0 = seed[0], u1 = seed[1];
274 png_bytep bytes = voidcast(png_bytep, pv);
275
276 /* There are thirty three bits, the next bit in the sequence is bit-33 XOR
277 * bit-20. The top 1 bit is in u1, the bottom 32 are in u0.
278 */
279 size_t i;
280 for (i=0; i<size; ++i)
281 {
282 /* First generate 8 new bits then shift them in at the end. */
283 png_uint_32 u = ((u0 >> (20-8)) ^ ((u1 << 7) | (u0 >> (32-7)))) & 0xff;
284 u1 <<= 8;
285 u1 |= u0 >> 24;
286 u0 <<= 8;
287 u0 |= u;
288 *bytes++ = (png_byte)u;
289 }
290
291 seed[0] = u0;
292 seed[1] = u1;
293 }
294
295 static void
make_four_random_bytes(png_uint_32 * seed,png_bytep bytes)296 make_four_random_bytes(png_uint_32* seed, png_bytep bytes)
297 {
298 make_random_bytes(seed, bytes, 4);
299 }
300
301 #if defined PNG_READ_SUPPORTED || defined PNG_WRITE_tRNS_SUPPORTED ||\
302 defined PNG_WRITE_FILTER_SUPPORTED
303 static void
randomize(void * pv,size_t size)304 randomize(void *pv, size_t size)
305 {
306 static png_uint_32 random_seed[2] = {0x56789abc, 0xd};
307 make_random_bytes(random_seed, pv, size);
308 }
309
310 #define R8(this) randomize(&(this), sizeof (this))
311
312 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
313 static png_byte
random_byte(void)314 random_byte(void)
315 {
316 unsigned char b1[1];
317 randomize(b1, sizeof b1);
318 return b1[0];
319 }
320 #endif /* READ */
321
322 static png_uint_16
random_u16(void)323 random_u16(void)
324 {
325 unsigned char b2[2];
326 randomize(b2, sizeof b2);
327 return png_get_uint_16(b2);
328 }
329
330 #if defined PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED ||\
331 defined PNG_READ_FILLER_SUPPORTED
332 static png_uint_32
random_u32(void)333 random_u32(void)
334 {
335 unsigned char b4[4];
336 randomize(b4, sizeof b4);
337 return png_get_uint_32(b4);
338 }
339 #endif /* READ_FILLER || READ_RGB_TO_GRAY */
340
341 #endif /* READ || WRITE_tRNS || WRITE_FILTER */
342
343 #if defined PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED ||\
344 defined PNG_WRITE_FILTER_SUPPORTED
345 static unsigned int
random_mod(unsigned int max)346 random_mod(unsigned int max)
347 {
348 return random_u16() % max; /* 0 .. max-1 */
349 }
350 #endif /* READ_TRANSFORMS || WRITE_FILTER */
351
352 #if (defined PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED) ||\
353 (defined PNG_READ_FILLER_SUPPORTED)
354 static int
random_choice(void)355 random_choice(void)
356 {
357 return random_byte() & 1;
358 }
359 #endif /* READ_RGB_TO_GRAY || READ_FILLER */
360
361 /* A numeric ID based on PNG file characteristics. The 'do_interlace' field
362 * simply records whether pngvalid did the interlace itself or whether it
363 * was done by libpng. Width and height must be less than 256. 'palette' is an
364 * index of the palette to use for formats with a palette otherwise a boolean
365 * indicating if a tRNS chunk was generated.
366 */
367 #define FILEID(col, depth, palette, interlace, width, height, do_interlace) \
368 ((png_uint_32)((col) + ((depth)<<3) + ((palette)<<8) + ((interlace)<<13) + \
369 (((do_interlace)!=0)<<15) + ((width)<<16) + ((height)<<24)))
370
371 #define COL_FROM_ID(id) ((png_byte)((id)& 0x7U))
372 #define DEPTH_FROM_ID(id) ((png_byte)(((id) >> 3) & 0x1fU))
373 #define PALETTE_FROM_ID(id) (((id) >> 8) & 0x1f)
374 #define INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id) ((png_byte)(((id) >> 13) & 0x3))
375 #define DO_INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id) ((int)(((id)>>15) & 1))
376 #define WIDTH_FROM_ID(id) (((id)>>16) & 0xff)
377 #define HEIGHT_FROM_ID(id) (((id)>>24) & 0xff)
378
379 /* Utility to construct a standard name for a standard image. */
380 static size_t
standard_name(char * buffer,size_t bufsize,size_t pos,png_byte colour_type,int bit_depth,unsigned int npalette,int interlace_type,png_uint_32 w,png_uint_32 h,int do_interlace)381 standard_name(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, png_byte colour_type,
382 int bit_depth, unsigned int npalette, int interlace_type,
383 png_uint_32 w, png_uint_32 h, int do_interlace)
384 {
385 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, colour_types[colour_type]);
386 if (colour_type == 3) /* must have a palette */
387 {
388 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "[");
389 pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, npalette);
390 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "]");
391 }
392
393 else if (npalette != 0)
394 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "+tRNS");
395
396 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " ");
397 pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, bit_depth);
398 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " bit");
399
400 if (interlace_type != PNG_INTERLACE_NONE)
401 {
402 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " interlaced");
403 if (do_interlace)
404 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "(pngvalid)");
405 else
406 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "(libpng)");
407 }
408
409 if (w > 0 || h > 0)
410 {
411 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, " ");
412 pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, w);
413 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "x");
414 pos = safecatn(buffer, bufsize, pos, h);
415 }
416
417 return pos;
418 }
419
420 static size_t
standard_name_from_id(char * buffer,size_t bufsize,size_t pos,png_uint_32 id)421 standard_name_from_id(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos, png_uint_32 id)
422 {
423 return standard_name(buffer, bufsize, pos, COL_FROM_ID(id),
424 DEPTH_FROM_ID(id), PALETTE_FROM_ID(id), INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id),
425 WIDTH_FROM_ID(id), HEIGHT_FROM_ID(id), DO_INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id));
426 }
427
428 /* Convenience API and defines to list valid formats. Note that 16 bit read and
429 * write support is required to do 16 bit read tests (we must be able to make a
430 * 16 bit image to test!)
431 */
432 #ifdef PNG_WRITE_16BIT_SUPPORTED
433 # define WRITE_BDHI 4
434 # ifdef PNG_READ_16BIT_SUPPORTED
435 # define READ_BDHI 4
436 # define DO_16BIT
437 # endif
438 #else
439 # define WRITE_BDHI 3
440 #endif
441 #ifndef DO_16BIT
442 # define READ_BDHI 3
443 #endif
444
445 /* The following defines the number of different palettes to generate for
446 * each log bit depth of a colour type 3 standard image.
447 */
448 #define PALETTE_COUNT(bit_depth) ((bit_depth) > 4 ? 1U : 16U)
449
450 static int
next_format(png_bytep colour_type,png_bytep bit_depth,unsigned int * palette_number,int low_depth_gray,int tRNS)451 next_format(png_bytep colour_type, png_bytep bit_depth,
452 unsigned int* palette_number, int low_depth_gray, int tRNS)
453 {
454 if (*bit_depth == 0)
455 {
456 *colour_type = 0;
457 if (low_depth_gray)
458 *bit_depth = 1;
459 else
460 *bit_depth = 8;
461 *palette_number = 0;
462 return 1;
463 }
464
465 if (*colour_type < 4/*no alpha channel*/)
466 {
467 /* Add multiple palettes for colour type 3, one image with tRNS
468 * and one without for other non-alpha formats:
469 */
470 unsigned int pn = ++*palette_number;
471 png_byte ct = *colour_type;
472
473 if (((ct == 0/*GRAY*/ || ct/*RGB*/ == 2) && tRNS && pn < 2) ||
474 (ct == 3/*PALETTE*/ && pn < PALETTE_COUNT(*bit_depth)))
475 return 1;
476
477 /* No: next bit depth */
478 *palette_number = 0;
479 }
480
481 *bit_depth = (png_byte)(*bit_depth << 1);
482
483 /* Palette images are restricted to 8 bit depth */
484 if (*bit_depth <= 8
485 #ifdef DO_16BIT
486 || (*colour_type != 3 && *bit_depth <= 16)
487 #endif
488 )
489 return 1;
490
491 /* Move to the next color type, or return 0 at the end. */
492 switch (*colour_type)
493 {
494 case 0:
495 *colour_type = 2;
496 *bit_depth = 8;
497 return 1;
498
499 case 2:
500 *colour_type = 3;
501 *bit_depth = 1;
502 return 1;
503
504 case 3:
505 *colour_type = 4;
506 *bit_depth = 8;
507 return 1;
508
509 case 4:
510 *colour_type = 6;
511 *bit_depth = 8;
512 return 1;
513
514 default:
515 return 0;
516 }
517 }
518
519 #ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
520 static unsigned int
sample(png_const_bytep row,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth,png_uint_32 x,unsigned int sample_index,int swap16,int littleendian)521 sample(png_const_bytep row, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth,
522 png_uint_32 x, unsigned int sample_index, int swap16, int littleendian)
523 {
524 png_uint_32 bit_index, result;
525
526 /* Find a sample index for the desired sample: */
527 x *= bit_depth;
528 bit_index = x;
529
530 if ((colour_type & 1) == 0) /* !palette */
531 {
532 if (colour_type & 2)
533 bit_index *= 3;
534
535 if (colour_type & 4)
536 bit_index += x; /* Alpha channel */
537
538 /* Multiple channels; select one: */
539 if (colour_type & (2+4))
540 bit_index += sample_index * bit_depth;
541 }
542
543 /* Return the sample from the row as an integer. */
544 row += bit_index >> 3;
545 result = *row;
546
547 if (bit_depth == 8)
548 return result;
549
550 else if (bit_depth > 8)
551 {
552 if (swap16)
553 return (*++row << 8) + result;
554 else
555 return (result << 8) + *++row;
556 }
557
558 /* Less than 8 bits per sample. By default PNG has the big end of
559 * the egg on the left of the screen, but if littleendian is set
560 * then the big end is on the right.
561 */
562 bit_index &= 7;
563
564 if (!littleendian)
565 bit_index = 8-bit_index-bit_depth;
566
567 return (result >> bit_index) & ((1U<<bit_depth)-1);
568 }
569 #endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
570
571 /* Copy a single pixel, of a given size, from one buffer to another -
572 * while this is basically bit addressed there is an implicit assumption
573 * that pixels 8 or more bits in size are byte aligned and that pixels
574 * do not otherwise cross byte boundaries. (This is, so far as I know,
575 * universally true in bitmap computer graphics. [JCB 20101212])
576 *
577 * NOTE: The to and from buffers may be the same.
578 */
579 static void
pixel_copy(png_bytep toBuffer,png_uint_32 toIndex,png_const_bytep fromBuffer,png_uint_32 fromIndex,unsigned int pixelSize,int littleendian)580 pixel_copy(png_bytep toBuffer, png_uint_32 toIndex,
581 png_const_bytep fromBuffer, png_uint_32 fromIndex, unsigned int pixelSize,
582 int littleendian)
583 {
584 /* Assume we can multiply by 'size' without overflow because we are
585 * just working in a single buffer.
586 */
587 toIndex *= pixelSize;
588 fromIndex *= pixelSize;
589 if (pixelSize < 8) /* Sub-byte */
590 {
591 /* Mask to select the location of the copied pixel: */
592 unsigned int destMask = ((1U<<pixelSize)-1) <<
593 (littleendian ? toIndex&7 : 8-pixelSize-(toIndex&7));
594 /* The following read the entire pixels and clears the extra: */
595 unsigned int destByte = toBuffer[toIndex >> 3] & ~destMask;
596 unsigned int sourceByte = fromBuffer[fromIndex >> 3];
597
598 /* Don't rely on << or >> supporting '0' here, just in case: */
599 fromIndex &= 7;
600 if (littleendian)
601 {
602 if (fromIndex > 0) sourceByte >>= fromIndex;
603 if ((toIndex & 7) > 0) sourceByte <<= toIndex & 7;
604 }
605
606 else
607 {
608 if (fromIndex > 0) sourceByte <<= fromIndex;
609 if ((toIndex & 7) > 0) sourceByte >>= toIndex & 7;
610 }
611
612 toBuffer[toIndex >> 3] = (png_byte)(destByte | (sourceByte & destMask));
613 }
614 else /* One or more bytes */
615 memmove(toBuffer+(toIndex>>3), fromBuffer+(fromIndex>>3), pixelSize>>3);
616 }
617
618 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
619 /* Copy a complete row of pixels, taking into account potential partial
620 * bytes at the end.
621 */
622 static void
row_copy(png_bytep toBuffer,png_const_bytep fromBuffer,unsigned int bitWidth,int littleendian)623 row_copy(png_bytep toBuffer, png_const_bytep fromBuffer, unsigned int bitWidth,
624 int littleendian)
625 {
626 memcpy(toBuffer, fromBuffer, bitWidth >> 3);
627
628 if ((bitWidth & 7) != 0)
629 {
630 unsigned int mask;
631
632 toBuffer += bitWidth >> 3;
633 fromBuffer += bitWidth >> 3;
634 if (littleendian)
635 mask = 0xff << (bitWidth & 7);
636 else
637 mask = 0xff >> (bitWidth & 7);
638 *toBuffer = (png_byte)((*toBuffer & mask) | (*fromBuffer & ~mask));
639 }
640 }
641
642 /* Compare pixels - they are assumed to start at the first byte in the
643 * given buffers.
644 */
645 static int
pixel_cmp(png_const_bytep pa,png_const_bytep pb,png_uint_32 bit_width)646 pixel_cmp(png_const_bytep pa, png_const_bytep pb, png_uint_32 bit_width)
647 {
648 #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10506
649 if (memcmp(pa, pb, bit_width>>3) == 0)
650 {
651 png_uint_32 p;
652
653 if ((bit_width & 7) == 0) return 0;
654
655 /* Ok, any differences? */
656 p = pa[bit_width >> 3];
657 p ^= pb[bit_width >> 3];
658
659 if (p == 0) return 0;
660
661 /* There are, but they may not be significant, remove the bits
662 * after the end (the low order bits in PNG.)
663 */
664 bit_width &= 7;
665 p >>= 8-bit_width;
666
667 if (p == 0) return 0;
668 }
669 #else
670 /* From libpng-1.5.6 the overwrite should be fixed, so compare the trailing
671 * bits too:
672 */
673 if (memcmp(pa, pb, (bit_width+7)>>3) == 0)
674 return 0;
675 #endif
676
677 /* Return the index of the changed byte. */
678 {
679 png_uint_32 where = 0;
680
681 while (pa[where] == pb[where]) ++where;
682 return 1+where;
683 }
684 }
685 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
686
687 /*************************** BASIC PNG FILE WRITING ***************************/
688 /* A png_store takes data from the sequential writer or provides data
689 * to the sequential reader. It can also store the result of a PNG
690 * write for later retrieval.
691 */
692 #define STORE_BUFFER_SIZE 500 /* arbitrary */
693 typedef struct png_store_buffer
694 {
695 struct png_store_buffer* prev; /* NOTE: stored in reverse order */
696 png_byte buffer[STORE_BUFFER_SIZE];
697 } png_store_buffer;
698
699 #define FILE_NAME_SIZE 64
700
701 typedef struct store_palette_entry /* record of a single palette entry */
702 {
703 png_byte red;
704 png_byte green;
705 png_byte blue;
706 png_byte alpha;
707 } store_palette_entry, store_palette[256];
708
709 typedef struct png_store_file
710 {
711 struct png_store_file* next; /* as many as you like... */
712 char name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
713 unsigned int IDAT_bits; /* Number of bits in IDAT size */
714 png_uint_32 IDAT_size; /* Total size of IDAT data */
715 png_uint_32 id; /* must be correct (see FILEID) */
716 size_t datacount; /* In this (the last) buffer */
717 png_store_buffer data; /* Last buffer in file */
718 int npalette; /* Number of entries in palette */
719 store_palette_entry* palette; /* May be NULL */
720 } png_store_file;
721
722 /* The following is a pool of memory allocated by a single libpng read or write
723 * operation.
724 */
725 typedef struct store_pool
726 {
727 struct png_store *store; /* Back pointer */
728 struct store_memory *list; /* List of allocated memory */
729 png_byte mark[4]; /* Before and after data */
730
731 /* Statistics for this run. */
732 png_alloc_size_t max; /* Maximum single allocation */
733 png_alloc_size_t current; /* Current allocation */
734 png_alloc_size_t limit; /* Highest current allocation */
735 png_alloc_size_t total; /* Total allocation */
736
737 /* Overall statistics (retained across successive runs). */
738 png_alloc_size_t max_max;
739 png_alloc_size_t max_limit;
740 png_alloc_size_t max_total;
741 } store_pool;
742
743 typedef struct png_store
744 {
745 /* For cexcept.h exception handling - simply store one of these;
746 * the context is a self pointer but it may point to a different
747 * png_store (in fact it never does in this program.)
748 */
749 struct exception_context
750 exception_context;
751
752 unsigned int verbose :1;
753 unsigned int treat_warnings_as_errors :1;
754 unsigned int expect_error :1;
755 unsigned int expect_warning :1;
756 unsigned int saw_warning :1;
757 unsigned int speed :1;
758 unsigned int progressive :1; /* use progressive read */
759 unsigned int validated :1; /* used as a temporary flag */
760 int nerrors;
761 int nwarnings;
762 int noptions; /* number of options below: */
763 struct {
764 unsigned char option; /* option number, 0..30 */
765 unsigned char setting; /* setting (unset,invalid,on,off) */
766 } options[16];
767 char test[128]; /* Name of test */
768 char error[256];
769
770 /* Share fields */
771 png_uint_32 chunklen; /* Length of chunk+overhead (chunkpos >= 8) */
772 png_uint_32 chunktype;/* Type of chunk (valid if chunkpos >= 4) */
773 png_uint_32 chunkpos; /* Position in chunk */
774 png_uint_32 IDAT_size;/* Accumulated IDAT size in .new */
775 unsigned int IDAT_bits;/* Cache of the file store value */
776
777 /* Read fields */
778 png_structp pread; /* Used to read a saved file */
779 png_infop piread;
780 png_store_file* current; /* Set when reading */
781 png_store_buffer* next; /* Set when reading */
782 size_t readpos; /* Position in *next */
783 png_byte* image; /* Buffer for reading interlaced images */
784 size_t cb_image; /* Size of this buffer */
785 size_t cb_row; /* Row size of the image(s) */
786 uLong IDAT_crc;
787 png_uint_32 IDAT_len; /* Used when re-chunking IDAT chunks */
788 png_uint_32 IDAT_pos; /* Used when re-chunking IDAT chunks */
789 png_uint_32 image_h; /* Number of rows in a single image */
790 store_pool read_memory_pool;
791
792 /* Write fields */
793 png_store_file* saved;
794 png_structp pwrite; /* Used when writing a new file */
795 png_infop piwrite;
796 size_t writepos; /* Position in .new */
797 char wname[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
798 png_store_buffer new; /* The end of the new PNG file being written. */
799 store_pool write_memory_pool;
800 store_palette_entry* palette;
801 int npalette;
802 } png_store;
803
804 /* Initialization and cleanup */
805 static void
store_pool_mark(png_bytep mark)806 store_pool_mark(png_bytep mark)
807 {
808 static png_uint_32 store_seed[2] = { 0x12345678, 1};
809
810 make_four_random_bytes(store_seed, mark);
811 }
812
813 #ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
814 /* Use this for random 32 bit values; this function makes sure the result is
815 * non-zero.
816 */
817 static png_uint_32
random_32(void)818 random_32(void)
819 {
820
821 for (;;)
822 {
823 png_byte mark[4];
824 png_uint_32 result;
825
826 store_pool_mark(mark);
827 result = png_get_uint_32(mark);
828
829 if (result != 0)
830 return result;
831 }
832 }
833 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
834
835 static void
store_pool_init(png_store * ps,store_pool * pool)836 store_pool_init(png_store *ps, store_pool *pool)
837 {
838 memset(pool, 0, sizeof *pool);
839
840 pool->store = ps;
841 pool->list = NULL;
842 pool->max = pool->current = pool->limit = pool->total = 0;
843 pool->max_max = pool->max_limit = pool->max_total = 0;
844 store_pool_mark(pool->mark);
845 }
846
847 static void
store_init(png_store * ps)848 store_init(png_store* ps)
849 {
850 memset(ps, 0, sizeof *ps);
851 init_exception_context(&ps->exception_context);
852 store_pool_init(ps, &ps->read_memory_pool);
853 store_pool_init(ps, &ps->write_memory_pool);
854 ps->verbose = 0;
855 ps->treat_warnings_as_errors = 0;
856 ps->expect_error = 0;
857 ps->expect_warning = 0;
858 ps->saw_warning = 0;
859 ps->speed = 0;
860 ps->progressive = 0;
861 ps->validated = 0;
862 ps->nerrors = ps->nwarnings = 0;
863 ps->pread = NULL;
864 ps->piread = NULL;
865 ps->saved = ps->current = NULL;
866 ps->next = NULL;
867 ps->readpos = 0;
868 ps->image = NULL;
869 ps->cb_image = 0;
870 ps->cb_row = 0;
871 ps->image_h = 0;
872 ps->pwrite = NULL;
873 ps->piwrite = NULL;
874 ps->writepos = 0;
875 ps->chunkpos = 8;
876 ps->chunktype = 0;
877 ps->chunklen = 16;
878 ps->IDAT_size = 0;
879 ps->IDAT_bits = 0;
880 ps->new.prev = NULL;
881 ps->palette = NULL;
882 ps->npalette = 0;
883 ps->noptions = 0;
884 }
885
886 static void
store_freebuffer(png_store_buffer * psb)887 store_freebuffer(png_store_buffer* psb)
888 {
889 if (psb->prev)
890 {
891 store_freebuffer(psb->prev);
892 free(psb->prev);
893 psb->prev = NULL;
894 }
895 }
896
897 static void
store_freenew(png_store * ps)898 store_freenew(png_store *ps)
899 {
900 store_freebuffer(&ps->new);
901 ps->writepos = 0;
902 ps->chunkpos = 8;
903 ps->chunktype = 0;
904 ps->chunklen = 16;
905 ps->IDAT_size = 0;
906 ps->IDAT_bits = 0;
907 if (ps->palette != NULL)
908 {
909 free(ps->palette);
910 ps->palette = NULL;
911 ps->npalette = 0;
912 }
913 }
914
915 static void
store_storenew(png_store * ps)916 store_storenew(png_store *ps)
917 {
918 png_store_buffer *pb;
919
920 pb = voidcast(png_store_buffer*, malloc(sizeof *pb));
921
922 if (pb == NULL)
923 png_error(ps->pwrite, "store new: OOM");
924
925 *pb = ps->new;
926 ps->new.prev = pb;
927 ps->writepos = 0;
928 }
929
930 static void
store_freefile(png_store_file ** ppf)931 store_freefile(png_store_file **ppf)
932 {
933 if (*ppf != NULL)
934 {
935 store_freefile(&(*ppf)->next);
936
937 store_freebuffer(&(*ppf)->data);
938 (*ppf)->datacount = 0;
939 if ((*ppf)->palette != NULL)
940 {
941 free((*ppf)->palette);
942 (*ppf)->palette = NULL;
943 (*ppf)->npalette = 0;
944 }
945 free(*ppf);
946 *ppf = NULL;
947 }
948 }
949
950 static unsigned int
bits_of(png_uint_32 num)951 bits_of(png_uint_32 num)
952 {
953 /* Return the number of bits in 'num' */
954 unsigned int b = 0;
955
956 if (num & 0xffff0000U) b += 16U, num >>= 16;
957 if (num & 0xff00U) b += 8U, num >>= 8;
958 if (num & 0xf0U) b += 4U, num >>= 4;
959 if (num & 0xcU) b += 2U, num >>= 2;
960 if (num & 0x2U) ++b, num >>= 1;
961 if (num) ++b;
962
963 return b; /* 0..32 */
964 }
965
966 /* Main interface to file storage, after writing a new PNG file (see the API
967 * below) call store_storefile to store the result with the given name and id.
968 */
969 static void
store_storefile(png_store * ps,png_uint_32 id)970 store_storefile(png_store *ps, png_uint_32 id)
971 {
972 png_store_file *pf;
973
974 if (ps->chunkpos != 0U || ps->chunktype != 0U || ps->chunklen != 0U ||
975 ps->IDAT_size == 0)
976 png_error(ps->pwrite, "storefile: incomplete write");
977
978 pf = voidcast(png_store_file*, malloc(sizeof *pf));
979 if (pf == NULL)
980 png_error(ps->pwrite, "storefile: OOM");
981 safecat(pf->name, sizeof pf->name, 0, ps->wname);
982 pf->id = id;
983 pf->data = ps->new;
984 pf->datacount = ps->writepos;
985 pf->IDAT_size = ps->IDAT_size;
986 pf->IDAT_bits = bits_of(ps->IDAT_size);
987 /* Because the IDAT always has zlib header stuff this must be true: */
988 if (pf->IDAT_bits == 0U)
989 png_error(ps->pwrite, "storefile: 0 sized IDAT");
990 ps->new.prev = NULL;
991 ps->writepos = 0;
992 ps->chunkpos = 8;
993 ps->chunktype = 0;
994 ps->chunklen = 16;
995 ps->IDAT_size = 0;
996 pf->palette = ps->palette;
997 pf->npalette = ps->npalette;
998 ps->palette = 0;
999 ps->npalette = 0;
1000
1001 /* And save it. */
1002 pf->next = ps->saved;
1003 ps->saved = pf;
1004 }
1005
1006 /* Generate an error message (in the given buffer) */
1007 static size_t
store_message(png_store * ps,png_const_structp pp,char * buffer,size_t bufsize,size_t pos,const char * msg)1008 store_message(png_store *ps, png_const_structp pp, char *buffer, size_t bufsize,
1009 size_t pos, const char *msg)
1010 {
1011 if (pp != NULL && pp == ps->pread)
1012 {
1013 /* Reading a file */
1014 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "read: ");
1015
1016 if (ps->current != NULL)
1017 {
1018 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ps->current->name);
1019 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, sep);
1020 }
1021 }
1022
1023 else if (pp != NULL && pp == ps->pwrite)
1024 {
1025 /* Writing a file */
1026 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "write: ");
1027 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ps->wname);
1028 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, sep);
1029 }
1030
1031 else
1032 {
1033 /* Neither reading nor writing (or a memory error in struct delete) */
1034 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "pngvalid: ");
1035 }
1036
1037 if (ps->test[0] != 0)
1038 {
1039 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ps->test);
1040 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, sep);
1041 }
1042 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, msg);
1043 return pos;
1044 }
1045
1046 /* Verbose output to the error stream: */
1047 static void
store_verbose(png_store * ps,png_const_structp pp,png_const_charp prefix,png_const_charp message)1048 store_verbose(png_store *ps, png_const_structp pp, png_const_charp prefix,
1049 png_const_charp message)
1050 {
1051 char buffer[512];
1052
1053 if (prefix)
1054 fputs(prefix, stderr);
1055
1056 (void)store_message(ps, pp, buffer, sizeof buffer, 0, message);
1057 fputs(buffer, stderr);
1058 fputc('\n', stderr);
1059 }
1060
1061 /* Log an error or warning - the relevant count is always incremented. */
1062 static void
store_log(png_store * ps,png_const_structp pp,png_const_charp message,int is_error)1063 store_log(png_store* ps, png_const_structp pp, png_const_charp message,
1064 int is_error)
1065 {
1066 /* The warning is copied to the error buffer if there are no errors and it is
1067 * the first warning. The error is copied to the error buffer if it is the
1068 * first error (overwriting any prior warnings).
1069 */
1070 if (is_error ? (ps->nerrors)++ == 0 :
1071 (ps->nwarnings)++ == 0 && ps->nerrors == 0)
1072 store_message(ps, pp, ps->error, sizeof ps->error, 0, message);
1073
1074 if (ps->verbose)
1075 store_verbose(ps, pp, is_error ? "error: " : "warning: ", message);
1076 }
1077
1078 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
1079 /* Internal error function, called with a png_store but no libpng stuff. */
1080 static void
internal_error(png_store * ps,png_const_charp message)1081 internal_error(png_store *ps, png_const_charp message)
1082 {
1083 store_log(ps, NULL, message, 1 /* error */);
1084
1085 /* And finally throw an exception. */
1086 {
1087 struct exception_context *the_exception_context = &ps->exception_context;
1088 Throw ps;
1089 }
1090 }
1091 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
1092
1093 /* Functions to use as PNG callbacks. */
1094 static void PNGCBAPI
store_error(png_structp ppIn,png_const_charp message)1095 store_error(png_structp ppIn, png_const_charp message) /* PNG_NORETURN */
1096 {
1097 png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
1098 png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_error_ptr(pp));
1099
1100 if (!ps->expect_error)
1101 store_log(ps, pp, message, 1 /* error */);
1102
1103 /* And finally throw an exception. */
1104 {
1105 struct exception_context *the_exception_context = &ps->exception_context;
1106 Throw ps;
1107 }
1108 }
1109
1110 static void PNGCBAPI
store_warning(png_structp ppIn,png_const_charp message)1111 store_warning(png_structp ppIn, png_const_charp message)
1112 {
1113 png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
1114 png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_error_ptr(pp));
1115
1116 if (!ps->expect_warning)
1117 store_log(ps, pp, message, 0 /* warning */);
1118 else
1119 ps->saw_warning = 1;
1120 }
1121
1122 /* These somewhat odd functions are used when reading an image to ensure that
1123 * the buffer is big enough, the png_structp is for errors.
1124 */
1125 /* Return a single row from the correct image. */
1126 static png_bytep
store_image_row(const png_store * ps,png_const_structp pp,int nImage,png_uint_32 y)1127 store_image_row(const png_store* ps, png_const_structp pp, int nImage,
1128 png_uint_32 y)
1129 {
1130 size_t coffset = (nImage * ps->image_h + y) * (ps->cb_row + 5) + 2;
1131
1132 if (ps->image == NULL)
1133 png_error(pp, "no allocated image");
1134
1135 if (coffset + ps->cb_row + 3 > ps->cb_image)
1136 png_error(pp, "image too small");
1137
1138 return ps->image + coffset;
1139 }
1140
1141 static void
store_image_free(png_store * ps,png_const_structp pp)1142 store_image_free(png_store *ps, png_const_structp pp)
1143 {
1144 if (ps->image != NULL)
1145 {
1146 png_bytep image = ps->image;
1147
1148 if (image[-1] != 0xed || image[ps->cb_image] != 0xfe)
1149 {
1150 if (pp != NULL)
1151 png_error(pp, "png_store image overwrite (1)");
1152 else
1153 store_log(ps, NULL, "png_store image overwrite (2)", 1);
1154 }
1155
1156 ps->image = NULL;
1157 ps->cb_image = 0;
1158 --image;
1159 free(image);
1160 }
1161 }
1162
1163 static void
store_ensure_image(png_store * ps,png_const_structp pp,int nImages,size_t cbRow,png_uint_32 cRows)1164 store_ensure_image(png_store *ps, png_const_structp pp, int nImages,
1165 size_t cbRow, png_uint_32 cRows)
1166 {
1167 size_t cb = nImages * cRows * (cbRow + 5);
1168
1169 if (ps->cb_image < cb)
1170 {
1171 png_bytep image;
1172
1173 store_image_free(ps, pp);
1174
1175 /* The buffer is deliberately mis-aligned. */
1176 image = voidcast(png_bytep, malloc(cb+2));
1177 if (image == NULL)
1178 {
1179 /* Called from the startup - ignore the error for the moment. */
1180 if (pp == NULL)
1181 return;
1182
1183 png_error(pp, "OOM allocating image buffer");
1184 }
1185
1186 /* These magic tags are used to detect overwrites above. */
1187 ++image;
1188 image[-1] = 0xed;
1189 image[cb] = 0xfe;
1190
1191 ps->image = image;
1192 ps->cb_image = cb;
1193 }
1194
1195 /* We have an adequate sized image; lay out the rows. There are 2 bytes at
1196 * the start and three at the end of each (this ensures that the row
1197 * alignment starts out odd - 2+1 and changes for larger images on each row.)
1198 */
1199 ps->cb_row = cbRow;
1200 ps->image_h = cRows;
1201
1202 /* For error checking, the whole buffer is set to 10110010 (0xb2 - 178).
1203 * This deliberately doesn't match the bits in the size test image which are
1204 * outside the image; these are set to 0xff (all 1). To make the row
1205 * comparison work in the 'size' test case the size rows are pre-initialized
1206 * to the same value prior to calling 'standard_row'.
1207 */
1208 memset(ps->image, 178, cb);
1209
1210 /* Then put in the marks. */
1211 while (--nImages >= 0)
1212 {
1213 png_uint_32 y;
1214
1215 for (y=0; y<cRows; ++y)
1216 {
1217 png_bytep row = store_image_row(ps, pp, nImages, y);
1218
1219 /* The markers: */
1220 row[-2] = 190;
1221 row[-1] = 239;
1222 row[cbRow] = 222;
1223 row[cbRow+1] = 173;
1224 row[cbRow+2] = 17;
1225 }
1226 }
1227 }
1228
1229 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
1230 static void
store_image_check(const png_store * ps,png_const_structp pp,int iImage)1231 store_image_check(const png_store* ps, png_const_structp pp, int iImage)
1232 {
1233 png_const_bytep image = ps->image;
1234
1235 if (image[-1] != 0xed || image[ps->cb_image] != 0xfe)
1236 png_error(pp, "image overwrite");
1237 else
1238 {
1239 size_t cbRow = ps->cb_row;
1240 png_uint_32 rows = ps->image_h;
1241
1242 image += iImage * (cbRow+5) * ps->image_h;
1243
1244 image += 2; /* skip image first row markers */
1245
1246 for (; rows > 0; --rows)
1247 {
1248 if (image[-2] != 190 || image[-1] != 239)
1249 png_error(pp, "row start overwritten");
1250
1251 if (image[cbRow] != 222 || image[cbRow+1] != 173 ||
1252 image[cbRow+2] != 17)
1253 png_error(pp, "row end overwritten");
1254
1255 image += cbRow+5;
1256 }
1257 }
1258 }
1259 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
1260
1261 static int
valid_chunktype(png_uint_32 chunktype)1262 valid_chunktype(png_uint_32 chunktype)
1263 {
1264 /* Each byte in the chunk type must be in one of the ranges 65..90, 97..122
1265 * (both inclusive), so:
1266 */
1267 unsigned int i;
1268
1269 for (i=0; i<4; ++i)
1270 {
1271 unsigned int c = chunktype & 0xffU;
1272
1273 if (!((c >= 65U && c <= 90U) || (c >= 97U && c <= 122U)))
1274 return 0;
1275
1276 chunktype >>= 8;
1277 }
1278
1279 return 1; /* It's valid */
1280 }
1281
1282 static void PNGCBAPI
store_write(png_structp ppIn,png_bytep pb,size_t st)1283 store_write(png_structp ppIn, png_bytep pb, size_t st)
1284 {
1285 png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
1286 png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_io_ptr(pp));
1287 size_t writepos = ps->writepos;
1288 png_uint_32 chunkpos = ps->chunkpos;
1289 png_uint_32 chunktype = ps->chunktype;
1290 png_uint_32 chunklen = ps->chunklen;
1291
1292 if (ps->pwrite != pp)
1293 png_error(pp, "store state damaged");
1294
1295 /* Technically this is legal, but in practice libpng never writes more than
1296 * the maximum chunk size at once so if it happens something weird has
1297 * changed inside libpng (probably).
1298 */
1299 if (st > 0x7fffffffU)
1300 png_error(pp, "unexpected write size");
1301
1302 /* Now process the bytes to be written. Do this in units of the space in the
1303 * output (write) buffer or, at the start 4 bytes for the chunk type and
1304 * length limited in any case by the amount of data.
1305 */
1306 while (st > 0)
1307 {
1308 if (writepos >= STORE_BUFFER_SIZE)
1309 store_storenew(ps), writepos = 0;
1310
1311 if (chunkpos < 4)
1312 {
1313 png_byte b = *pb++;
1314 --st;
1315 chunklen = (chunklen << 8) + b;
1316 ps->new.buffer[writepos++] = b;
1317 ++chunkpos;
1318 }
1319
1320 else if (chunkpos < 8)
1321 {
1322 png_byte b = *pb++;
1323 --st;
1324 chunktype = (chunktype << 8) + b;
1325 ps->new.buffer[writepos++] = b;
1326
1327 if (++chunkpos == 8)
1328 {
1329 chunklen &= 0xffffffffU;
1330 if (chunklen > 0x7fffffffU)
1331 png_error(pp, "chunk length too great");
1332
1333 chunktype &= 0xffffffffU;
1334 if (chunktype == CHUNK_IDAT)
1335 {
1336 if (chunklen > ~ps->IDAT_size)
1337 png_error(pp, "pngvalid internal image too large");
1338
1339 ps->IDAT_size += chunklen;
1340 }
1341
1342 else if (!valid_chunktype(chunktype))
1343 png_error(pp, "invalid chunk type");
1344
1345 chunklen += 12; /* for header and CRC */
1346 }
1347 }
1348
1349 else /* chunkpos >= 8 */
1350 {
1351 size_t cb = st;
1352
1353 if (cb > STORE_BUFFER_SIZE - writepos)
1354 cb = STORE_BUFFER_SIZE - writepos;
1355
1356 if (cb > chunklen - chunkpos/* bytes left in chunk*/)
1357 cb = (size_t)/*SAFE*/(chunklen - chunkpos);
1358
1359 memcpy(ps->new.buffer + writepos, pb, cb);
1360 chunkpos += (png_uint_32)/*SAFE*/cb;
1361 pb += cb;
1362 writepos += cb;
1363 st -= cb;
1364
1365 if (chunkpos >= chunklen) /* must be equal */
1366 chunkpos = chunktype = chunklen = 0;
1367 }
1368 } /* while (st > 0) */
1369
1370 ps->writepos = writepos;
1371 ps->chunkpos = chunkpos;
1372 ps->chunktype = chunktype;
1373 ps->chunklen = chunklen;
1374 }
1375
1376 static void PNGCBAPI
store_flush(png_structp ppIn)1377 store_flush(png_structp ppIn)
1378 {
1379 UNUSED(ppIn) /*DOES NOTHING*/
1380 }
1381
1382 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
1383 static size_t
store_read_buffer_size(png_store * ps)1384 store_read_buffer_size(png_store *ps)
1385 {
1386 /* Return the bytes available for read in the current buffer. */
1387 if (ps->next != &ps->current->data)
1388 return STORE_BUFFER_SIZE;
1389
1390 return ps->current->datacount;
1391 }
1392
1393 /* Return total bytes available for read. */
1394 static size_t
store_read_buffer_avail(png_store * ps)1395 store_read_buffer_avail(png_store *ps)
1396 {
1397 if (ps->current != NULL && ps->next != NULL)
1398 {
1399 png_store_buffer *next = &ps->current->data;
1400 size_t cbAvail = ps->current->datacount;
1401
1402 while (next != ps->next && next != NULL)
1403 {
1404 next = next->prev;
1405 cbAvail += STORE_BUFFER_SIZE;
1406 }
1407
1408 if (next != ps->next)
1409 png_error(ps->pread, "buffer read error");
1410
1411 if (cbAvail > ps->readpos)
1412 return cbAvail - ps->readpos;
1413 }
1414
1415 return 0;
1416 }
1417
1418 static int
store_read_buffer_next(png_store * ps)1419 store_read_buffer_next(png_store *ps)
1420 {
1421 png_store_buffer *pbOld = ps->next;
1422 png_store_buffer *pbNew = &ps->current->data;
1423 if (pbOld != pbNew)
1424 {
1425 while (pbNew != NULL && pbNew->prev != pbOld)
1426 pbNew = pbNew->prev;
1427
1428 if (pbNew != NULL)
1429 {
1430 ps->next = pbNew;
1431 ps->readpos = 0;
1432 return 1;
1433 }
1434
1435 png_error(ps->pread, "buffer lost");
1436 }
1437
1438 return 0; /* EOF or error */
1439 }
1440
1441 /* Need separate implementation and callback to allow use of the same code
1442 * during progressive read, where the io_ptr is set internally by libpng.
1443 */
1444 static void
store_read_imp(png_store * ps,png_bytep pb,size_t st)1445 store_read_imp(png_store *ps, png_bytep pb, size_t st)
1446 {
1447 if (ps->current == NULL || ps->next == NULL)
1448 png_error(ps->pread, "store state damaged");
1449
1450 while (st > 0)
1451 {
1452 size_t cbAvail = store_read_buffer_size(ps) - ps->readpos;
1453
1454 if (cbAvail > 0)
1455 {
1456 if (cbAvail > st) cbAvail = st;
1457 memcpy(pb, ps->next->buffer + ps->readpos, cbAvail);
1458 st -= cbAvail;
1459 pb += cbAvail;
1460 ps->readpos += cbAvail;
1461 }
1462
1463 else if (!store_read_buffer_next(ps))
1464 png_error(ps->pread, "read beyond end of file");
1465 }
1466 }
1467
1468 static size_t
store_read_chunk(png_store * ps,png_bytep pb,size_t max,size_t min)1469 store_read_chunk(png_store *ps, png_bytep pb, size_t max, size_t min)
1470 {
1471 png_uint_32 chunklen = ps->chunklen;
1472 png_uint_32 chunktype = ps->chunktype;
1473 png_uint_32 chunkpos = ps->chunkpos;
1474 size_t st = max;
1475
1476 if (st > 0) do
1477 {
1478 if (chunkpos >= chunklen) /* end of last chunk */
1479 {
1480 png_byte buffer[8];
1481
1482 /* Read the header of the next chunk: */
1483 store_read_imp(ps, buffer, 8U);
1484 chunklen = png_get_uint_32(buffer) + 12U;
1485 chunktype = png_get_uint_32(buffer+4U);
1486 chunkpos = 0U; /* Position read so far */
1487 }
1488
1489 if (chunktype == CHUNK_IDAT)
1490 {
1491 png_uint_32 IDAT_pos = ps->IDAT_pos;
1492 png_uint_32 IDAT_len = ps->IDAT_len;
1493 png_uint_32 IDAT_size = ps->IDAT_size;
1494
1495 /* The IDAT headers are constructed here; skip the input header. */
1496 if (chunkpos < 8U)
1497 chunkpos = 8U;
1498
1499 if (IDAT_pos == IDAT_len)
1500 {
1501 png_byte random = random_byte();
1502
1503 /* Make a new IDAT chunk, if IDAT_len is 0 this is the first IDAT,
1504 * if IDAT_size is 0 this is the end. At present this is set up
1505 * using a random number so that there is a 25% chance before
1506 * the start of the first IDAT chunk being 0 length.
1507 */
1508 if (IDAT_len == 0U) /* First IDAT */
1509 {
1510 switch (random & 3U)
1511 {
1512 case 0U: IDAT_len = 12U; break; /* 0 bytes */
1513 case 1U: IDAT_len = 13U; break; /* 1 byte */
1514 default: IDAT_len = random_u32();
1515 IDAT_len %= IDAT_size;
1516 IDAT_len += 13U; /* 1..IDAT_size bytes */
1517 break;
1518 }
1519 }
1520
1521 else if (IDAT_size == 0U) /* all IDAT data read */
1522 {
1523 /* The last (IDAT) chunk should be positioned at the CRC now: */
1524 if (chunkpos != chunklen-4U)
1525 png_error(ps->pread, "internal: IDAT size mismatch");
1526
1527 /* The only option here is to add a zero length IDAT, this
1528 * happens 25% of the time. Because of the check above
1529 * chunklen-4U-chunkpos must be zero, we just need to skip the
1530 * CRC now.
1531 */
1532 if ((random & 3U) == 0U)
1533 IDAT_len = 12U; /* Output another 0 length IDAT */
1534
1535 else
1536 {
1537 /* End of IDATs, skip the CRC to make the code above load the
1538 * next chunk header next time round.
1539 */
1540 png_byte buffer[4];
1541
1542 store_read_imp(ps, buffer, 4U);
1543 chunkpos += 4U;
1544 ps->IDAT_pos = IDAT_pos;
1545 ps->IDAT_len = IDAT_len;
1546 ps->IDAT_size = 0U;
1547 continue; /* Read the next chunk */
1548 }
1549 }
1550
1551 else
1552 {
1553 /* Middle of IDATs, use 'random' to determine the number of bits
1554 * to use in the IDAT length.
1555 */
1556 IDAT_len = random_u32();
1557 IDAT_len &= (1U << (1U + random % ps->IDAT_bits)) - 1U;
1558 if (IDAT_len > IDAT_size)
1559 IDAT_len = IDAT_size;
1560 IDAT_len += 12U; /* zero bytes may occur */
1561 }
1562
1563 IDAT_pos = 0U;
1564 ps->IDAT_crc = 0x35af061e; /* Ie: crc32(0UL, "IDAT", 4) */
1565 } /* IDAT_pos == IDAT_len */
1566
1567 if (IDAT_pos < 8U) /* Return the header */ do
1568 {
1569 png_uint_32 b;
1570 unsigned int shift;
1571
1572 if (IDAT_pos < 4U)
1573 b = IDAT_len - 12U;
1574
1575 else
1576 b = CHUNK_IDAT;
1577
1578 shift = 3U & IDAT_pos;
1579 ++IDAT_pos;
1580
1581 if (shift < 3U)
1582 b >>= 8U*(3U-shift);
1583
1584 *pb++ = 0xffU & b;
1585 }
1586 while (--st > 0 && IDAT_pos < 8);
1587
1588 else if (IDAT_pos < IDAT_len - 4U) /* I.e not the CRC */
1589 {
1590 if (chunkpos < chunklen-4U)
1591 {
1592 uInt avail = (uInt)-1;
1593
1594 if (avail > (IDAT_len-4U) - IDAT_pos)
1595 avail = (uInt)/*SAFE*/((IDAT_len-4U) - IDAT_pos);
1596
1597 if (avail > st)
1598 avail = (uInt)/*SAFE*/st;
1599
1600 if (avail > (chunklen-4U) - chunkpos)
1601 avail = (uInt)/*SAFE*/((chunklen-4U) - chunkpos);
1602
1603 store_read_imp(ps, pb, avail);
1604 ps->IDAT_crc = crc32(ps->IDAT_crc, pb, avail);
1605 pb += (size_t)/*SAFE*/avail;
1606 st -= (size_t)/*SAFE*/avail;
1607 chunkpos += (png_uint_32)/*SAFE*/avail;
1608 IDAT_size -= (png_uint_32)/*SAFE*/avail;
1609 IDAT_pos += (png_uint_32)/*SAFE*/avail;
1610 }
1611
1612 else /* skip the input CRC */
1613 {
1614 png_byte buffer[4];
1615
1616 store_read_imp(ps, buffer, 4U);
1617 chunkpos += 4U;
1618 }
1619 }
1620
1621 else /* IDAT crc */ do
1622 {
1623 uLong b = ps->IDAT_crc;
1624 unsigned int shift = (IDAT_len - IDAT_pos); /* 4..1 */
1625 ++IDAT_pos;
1626
1627 if (shift > 1U)
1628 b >>= 8U*(shift-1U);
1629
1630 *pb++ = 0xffU & b;
1631 }
1632 while (--st > 0 && IDAT_pos < IDAT_len);
1633
1634 ps->IDAT_pos = IDAT_pos;
1635 ps->IDAT_len = IDAT_len;
1636 ps->IDAT_size = IDAT_size;
1637 }
1638
1639 else /* !IDAT */
1640 {
1641 /* If there is still some pending IDAT data after the IDAT chunks have
1642 * been processed there is a problem:
1643 */
1644 if (ps->IDAT_len > 0 && ps->IDAT_size > 0)
1645 png_error(ps->pread, "internal: missing IDAT data");
1646
1647 if (chunktype == CHUNK_IEND && ps->IDAT_len == 0U)
1648 png_error(ps->pread, "internal: missing IDAT");
1649
1650 if (chunkpos < 8U) /* Return the header */ do
1651 {
1652 png_uint_32 b;
1653 unsigned int shift;
1654
1655 if (chunkpos < 4U)
1656 b = chunklen - 12U;
1657
1658 else
1659 b = chunktype;
1660
1661 shift = 3U & chunkpos;
1662 ++chunkpos;
1663
1664 if (shift < 3U)
1665 b >>= 8U*(3U-shift);
1666
1667 *pb++ = 0xffU & b;
1668 }
1669 while (--st > 0 && chunkpos < 8);
1670
1671 else /* Return chunk bytes, including the CRC */
1672 {
1673 size_t avail = st;
1674
1675 if (avail > chunklen - chunkpos)
1676 avail = (size_t)/*SAFE*/(chunklen - chunkpos);
1677
1678 store_read_imp(ps, pb, avail);
1679 pb += avail;
1680 st -= avail;
1681 chunkpos += (png_uint_32)/*SAFE*/avail;
1682
1683 /* Check for end of chunk and end-of-file; don't try to read a new
1684 * chunk header at this point unless instructed to do so by 'min'.
1685 */
1686 if (chunkpos >= chunklen && max-st >= min &&
1687 store_read_buffer_avail(ps) == 0)
1688 break;
1689 }
1690 } /* !IDAT */
1691 }
1692 while (st > 0);
1693
1694 ps->chunklen = chunklen;
1695 ps->chunktype = chunktype;
1696 ps->chunkpos = chunkpos;
1697
1698 return st; /* space left */
1699 }
1700
1701 static void PNGCBAPI
store_read(png_structp ppIn,png_bytep pb,size_t st)1702 store_read(png_structp ppIn, png_bytep pb, size_t st)
1703 {
1704 png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
1705 png_store *ps = voidcast(png_store*, png_get_io_ptr(pp));
1706
1707 if (ps == NULL || ps->pread != pp)
1708 png_error(pp, "bad store read call");
1709
1710 store_read_chunk(ps, pb, st, st);
1711 }
1712
1713 static void
store_progressive_read(png_store * ps,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)1714 store_progressive_read(png_store *ps, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
1715 {
1716 if (ps->pread != pp || ps->current == NULL || ps->next == NULL)
1717 png_error(pp, "store state damaged (progressive)");
1718
1719 /* This is another Horowitz and Hill random noise generator. In this case
1720 * the aim is to stress the progressive reader with truly horrible variable
1721 * buffer sizes in the range 1..500, so a sequence of 9 bit random numbers
1722 * is generated. We could probably just count from 1 to 32767 and get as
1723 * good a result.
1724 */
1725 while (store_read_buffer_avail(ps) > 0)
1726 {
1727 static png_uint_32 noise = 2;
1728 size_t cb;
1729 png_byte buffer[512];
1730
1731 /* Generate 15 more bits of stuff: */
1732 noise = (noise << 9) | ((noise ^ (noise >> (9-5))) & 0x1ff);
1733 cb = noise & 0x1ff;
1734 cb -= store_read_chunk(ps, buffer, cb, 1);
1735 png_process_data(pp, pi, buffer, cb);
1736 }
1737 }
1738 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
1739
1740 /* The caller must fill this in: */
1741 static store_palette_entry *
store_write_palette(png_store * ps,int npalette)1742 store_write_palette(png_store *ps, int npalette)
1743 {
1744 if (ps->pwrite == NULL)
1745 store_log(ps, NULL, "attempt to write palette without write stream", 1);
1746
1747 if (ps->palette != NULL)
1748 png_error(ps->pwrite, "multiple store_write_palette calls");
1749
1750 /* This function can only return NULL if called with '0'! */
1751 if (npalette > 0)
1752 {
1753 ps->palette = voidcast(store_palette_entry*, malloc(npalette *
1754 sizeof *ps->palette));
1755
1756 if (ps->palette == NULL)
1757 png_error(ps->pwrite, "store new palette: OOM");
1758
1759 ps->npalette = npalette;
1760 }
1761
1762 return ps->palette;
1763 }
1764
1765 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
1766 static store_palette_entry *
store_current_palette(png_store * ps,int * npalette)1767 store_current_palette(png_store *ps, int *npalette)
1768 {
1769 /* This is an internal error (the call has been made outside a read
1770 * operation.)
1771 */
1772 if (ps->current == NULL)
1773 {
1774 store_log(ps, ps->pread, "no current stream for palette", 1);
1775 return NULL;
1776 }
1777
1778 /* The result may be null if there is no palette. */
1779 *npalette = ps->current->npalette;
1780 return ps->current->palette;
1781 }
1782 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
1783
1784 /***************************** MEMORY MANAGEMENT*** ***************************/
1785 #ifdef PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED
1786 /* A store_memory is simply the header for an allocated block of memory. The
1787 * pointer returned to libpng is just after the end of the header block, the
1788 * allocated memory is followed by a second copy of the 'mark'.
1789 */
1790 typedef struct store_memory
1791 {
1792 store_pool *pool; /* Originating pool */
1793 struct store_memory *next; /* Singly linked list */
1794 png_alloc_size_t size; /* Size of memory allocated */
1795 png_byte mark[4]; /* ID marker */
1796 } store_memory;
1797
1798 /* Handle a fatal error in memory allocation. This calls png_error if the
1799 * libpng struct is non-NULL, else it outputs a message and returns. This means
1800 * that a memory problem while libpng is running will abort (png_error) the
1801 * handling of particular file while one in cleanup (after the destroy of the
1802 * struct has returned) will simply keep going and free (or attempt to free)
1803 * all the memory.
1804 */
1805 static void
store_pool_error(png_store * ps,png_const_structp pp,const char * msg)1806 store_pool_error(png_store *ps, png_const_structp pp, const char *msg)
1807 {
1808 if (pp != NULL)
1809 png_error(pp, msg);
1810
1811 /* Else we have to do it ourselves. png_error eventually calls store_log,
1812 * above. store_log accepts a NULL png_structp - it just changes what gets
1813 * output by store_message.
1814 */
1815 store_log(ps, pp, msg, 1 /* error */);
1816 }
1817
1818 static void
store_memory_free(png_const_structp pp,store_pool * pool,store_memory * memory)1819 store_memory_free(png_const_structp pp, store_pool *pool, store_memory *memory)
1820 {
1821 /* Note that pp may be NULL (see store_pool_delete below), the caller has
1822 * found 'memory' in pool->list *and* unlinked this entry, so this is a valid
1823 * pointer (for sure), but the contents may have been trashed.
1824 */
1825 if (memory->pool != pool)
1826 store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (pool)");
1827
1828 else if (memcmp(memory->mark, pool->mark, sizeof memory->mark) != 0)
1829 store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (start)");
1830
1831 /* It should be safe to read the size field now. */
1832 else
1833 {
1834 png_alloc_size_t cb = memory->size;
1835
1836 if (cb > pool->max)
1837 store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (size)");
1838
1839 else if (memcmp((png_bytep)(memory+1)+cb, pool->mark, sizeof pool->mark)
1840 != 0)
1841 store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "memory corrupted (end)");
1842
1843 /* Finally give the library a chance to find problems too: */
1844 else
1845 {
1846 pool->current -= cb;
1847 free(memory);
1848 }
1849 }
1850 }
1851
1852 static void
store_pool_delete(png_store * ps,store_pool * pool)1853 store_pool_delete(png_store *ps, store_pool *pool)
1854 {
1855 if (pool->list != NULL)
1856 {
1857 fprintf(stderr, "%s: %s %s: memory lost (list follows):\n", ps->test,
1858 pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? "read" : "write",
1859 pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? (ps->current != NULL ?
1860 ps->current->name : "unknown file") : ps->wname);
1861 ++ps->nerrors;
1862
1863 do
1864 {
1865 store_memory *next = pool->list;
1866 pool->list = next->next;
1867 next->next = NULL;
1868
1869 fprintf(stderr, "\t%lu bytes @ %p\n",
1870 (unsigned long)next->size, (const void*)(next+1));
1871 /* The NULL means this will always return, even if the memory is
1872 * corrupted.
1873 */
1874 store_memory_free(NULL, pool, next);
1875 }
1876 while (pool->list != NULL);
1877 }
1878
1879 /* And reset the other fields too for the next time. */
1880 if (pool->max > pool->max_max) pool->max_max = pool->max;
1881 pool->max = 0;
1882 if (pool->current != 0) /* unexpected internal error */
1883 fprintf(stderr, "%s: %s %s: memory counter mismatch (internal error)\n",
1884 ps->test, pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? "read" : "write",
1885 pool == &ps->read_memory_pool ? (ps->current != NULL ?
1886 ps->current->name : "unknown file") : ps->wname);
1887 pool->current = 0;
1888
1889 if (pool->limit > pool->max_limit)
1890 pool->max_limit = pool->limit;
1891
1892 pool->limit = 0;
1893
1894 if (pool->total > pool->max_total)
1895 pool->max_total = pool->total;
1896
1897 pool->total = 0;
1898
1899 /* Get a new mark too. */
1900 store_pool_mark(pool->mark);
1901 }
1902
1903 /* The memory callbacks: */
1904 static png_voidp PNGCBAPI
store_malloc(png_structp ppIn,png_alloc_size_t cb)1905 store_malloc(png_structp ppIn, png_alloc_size_t cb)
1906 {
1907 png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
1908 store_pool *pool = voidcast(store_pool*, png_get_mem_ptr(pp));
1909 store_memory *new = voidcast(store_memory*, malloc(cb + (sizeof *new) +
1910 (sizeof pool->mark)));
1911
1912 if (new != NULL)
1913 {
1914 if (cb > pool->max)
1915 pool->max = cb;
1916
1917 pool->current += cb;
1918
1919 if (pool->current > pool->limit)
1920 pool->limit = pool->current;
1921
1922 pool->total += cb;
1923
1924 new->size = cb;
1925 memcpy(new->mark, pool->mark, sizeof new->mark);
1926 memcpy((png_byte*)(new+1) + cb, pool->mark, sizeof pool->mark);
1927 new->pool = pool;
1928 new->next = pool->list;
1929 pool->list = new;
1930 ++new;
1931 }
1932
1933 else
1934 {
1935 /* NOTE: the PNG user malloc function cannot use the png_ptr it is passed
1936 * other than to retrieve the allocation pointer! libpng calls the
1937 * store_malloc callback in two basic cases:
1938 *
1939 * 1) From png_malloc; png_malloc will do a png_error itself if NULL is
1940 * returned.
1941 * 2) From png_struct or png_info structure creation; png_malloc is
1942 * to return so cleanup can be performed.
1943 *
1944 * To handle this store_malloc can log a message, but can't do anything
1945 * else.
1946 */
1947 store_log(pool->store, pp, "out of memory", 1 /* is_error */);
1948 }
1949
1950 return new;
1951 }
1952
1953 static void PNGCBAPI
store_free(png_structp ppIn,png_voidp memory)1954 store_free(png_structp ppIn, png_voidp memory)
1955 {
1956 png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
1957 store_pool *pool = voidcast(store_pool*, png_get_mem_ptr(pp));
1958 store_memory *this = voidcast(store_memory*, memory), **test;
1959
1960 /* Because libpng calls store_free with a dummy png_struct when deleting
1961 * png_struct or png_info via png_destroy_struct_2 it is necessary to check
1962 * the passed in png_structp to ensure it is valid, and not pass it to
1963 * png_error if it is not.
1964 */
1965 if (pp != pool->store->pread && pp != pool->store->pwrite)
1966 pp = NULL;
1967
1968 /* First check that this 'memory' really is valid memory - it must be in the
1969 * pool list. If it is, use the shared memory_free function to free it.
1970 */
1971 --this;
1972 for (test = &pool->list; *test != this; test = &(*test)->next)
1973 {
1974 if (*test == NULL)
1975 {
1976 store_pool_error(pool->store, pp, "bad pointer to free");
1977 return;
1978 }
1979 }
1980
1981 /* Unlink this entry, *test == this. */
1982 *test = this->next;
1983 this->next = NULL;
1984 store_memory_free(pp, pool, this);
1985 }
1986 #endif /* PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED */
1987
1988 /* Setup functions. */
1989 /* Cleanup when aborting a write or after storing the new file. */
1990 static void
store_write_reset(png_store * ps)1991 store_write_reset(png_store *ps)
1992 {
1993 if (ps->pwrite != NULL)
1994 {
1995 anon_context(ps);
1996
1997 Try
1998 png_destroy_write_struct(&ps->pwrite, &ps->piwrite);
1999
2000 Catch_anonymous
2001 {
2002 /* memory corruption: continue. */
2003 }
2004
2005 ps->pwrite = NULL;
2006 ps->piwrite = NULL;
2007 }
2008
2009 /* And make sure that all the memory has been freed - this will output
2010 * spurious errors in the case of memory corruption above, but this is safe.
2011 */
2012 # ifdef PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED
2013 store_pool_delete(ps, &ps->write_memory_pool);
2014 # endif
2015
2016 store_freenew(ps);
2017 }
2018
2019 /* The following is the main write function, it returns a png_struct and,
2020 * optionally, a png_info suitable for writiing a new PNG file. Use
2021 * store_storefile above to record this file after it has been written. The
2022 * returned libpng structures as destroyed by store_write_reset above.
2023 */
2024 static png_structp
set_store_for_write(png_store * ps,png_infopp ppi,const char * name)2025 set_store_for_write(png_store *ps, png_infopp ppi, const char *name)
2026 {
2027 anon_context(ps);
2028
2029 Try
2030 {
2031 if (ps->pwrite != NULL)
2032 png_error(ps->pwrite, "write store already in use");
2033
2034 store_write_reset(ps);
2035 safecat(ps->wname, sizeof ps->wname, 0, name);
2036
2037 /* Don't do the slow memory checks if doing a speed test, also if user
2038 * memory is not supported we can't do it anyway.
2039 */
2040 # ifdef PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED
2041 if (!ps->speed)
2042 ps->pwrite = png_create_write_struct_2(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING,
2043 ps, store_error, store_warning, &ps->write_memory_pool,
2044 store_malloc, store_free);
2045
2046 else
2047 # endif
2048 ps->pwrite = png_create_write_struct(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING,
2049 ps, store_error, store_warning);
2050
2051 png_set_write_fn(ps->pwrite, ps, store_write, store_flush);
2052
2053 # ifdef PNG_SET_OPTION_SUPPORTED
2054 {
2055 int opt;
2056 for (opt=0; opt<ps->noptions; ++opt)
2057 if (png_set_option(ps->pwrite, ps->options[opt].option,
2058 ps->options[opt].setting) == PNG_OPTION_INVALID)
2059 png_error(ps->pwrite, "png option invalid");
2060 }
2061 # endif
2062
2063 if (ppi != NULL)
2064 *ppi = ps->piwrite = png_create_info_struct(ps->pwrite);
2065 }
2066
2067 Catch_anonymous
2068 return NULL;
2069
2070 return ps->pwrite;
2071 }
2072
2073 /* Cleanup when finished reading (either due to error or in the success case).
2074 * This routine exists even when there is no read support to make the code
2075 * tidier (avoid a mass of ifdefs) and so easier to maintain.
2076 */
2077 static void
store_read_reset(png_store * ps)2078 store_read_reset(png_store *ps)
2079 {
2080 # ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
2081 if (ps->pread != NULL)
2082 {
2083 anon_context(ps);
2084
2085 Try
2086 png_destroy_read_struct(&ps->pread, &ps->piread, NULL);
2087
2088 Catch_anonymous
2089 {
2090 /* error already output: continue */
2091 }
2092
2093 ps->pread = NULL;
2094 ps->piread = NULL;
2095 }
2096 # endif
2097
2098 # ifdef PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED
2099 /* Always do this to be safe. */
2100 store_pool_delete(ps, &ps->read_memory_pool);
2101 # endif
2102
2103 ps->current = NULL;
2104 ps->next = NULL;
2105 ps->readpos = 0;
2106 ps->validated = 0;
2107
2108 ps->chunkpos = 8;
2109 ps->chunktype = 0;
2110 ps->chunklen = 16;
2111 ps->IDAT_size = 0;
2112 }
2113
2114 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
2115 static void
store_read_set(png_store * ps,png_uint_32 id)2116 store_read_set(png_store *ps, png_uint_32 id)
2117 {
2118 png_store_file *pf = ps->saved;
2119
2120 while (pf != NULL)
2121 {
2122 if (pf->id == id)
2123 {
2124 ps->current = pf;
2125 ps->next = NULL;
2126 ps->IDAT_size = pf->IDAT_size;
2127 ps->IDAT_bits = pf->IDAT_bits; /* just a cache */
2128 ps->IDAT_len = 0;
2129 ps->IDAT_pos = 0;
2130 ps->IDAT_crc = 0UL;
2131 store_read_buffer_next(ps);
2132 return;
2133 }
2134
2135 pf = pf->next;
2136 }
2137
2138 {
2139 size_t pos;
2140 char msg[FILE_NAME_SIZE+64];
2141
2142 pos = standard_name_from_id(msg, sizeof msg, 0, id);
2143 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ": file not found");
2144 png_error(ps->pread, msg);
2145 }
2146 }
2147
2148 /* The main interface for reading a saved file - pass the id number of the file
2149 * to retrieve. Ids must be unique or the earlier file will be hidden. The API
2150 * returns a png_struct and, optionally, a png_info. Both of these will be
2151 * destroyed by store_read_reset above.
2152 */
2153 static png_structp
set_store_for_read(png_store * ps,png_infopp ppi,png_uint_32 id,const char * name)2154 set_store_for_read(png_store *ps, png_infopp ppi, png_uint_32 id,
2155 const char *name)
2156 {
2157 /* Set the name for png_error */
2158 safecat(ps->test, sizeof ps->test, 0, name);
2159
2160 if (ps->pread != NULL)
2161 png_error(ps->pread, "read store already in use");
2162
2163 store_read_reset(ps);
2164
2165 /* Both the create APIs can return NULL if used in their default mode
2166 * (because there is no other way of handling an error because the jmp_buf
2167 * by default is stored in png_struct and that has not been allocated!)
2168 * However, given that store_error works correctly in these circumstances
2169 * we don't ever expect NULL in this program.
2170 */
2171 # ifdef PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED
2172 if (!ps->speed)
2173 ps->pread = png_create_read_struct_2(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING, ps,
2174 store_error, store_warning, &ps->read_memory_pool, store_malloc,
2175 store_free);
2176
2177 else
2178 # endif
2179 ps->pread = png_create_read_struct(PNG_LIBPNG_VER_STRING, ps, store_error,
2180 store_warning);
2181
2182 if (ps->pread == NULL)
2183 {
2184 struct exception_context *the_exception_context = &ps->exception_context;
2185
2186 store_log(ps, NULL, "png_create_read_struct returned NULL (unexpected)",
2187 1 /*error*/);
2188
2189 Throw ps;
2190 }
2191
2192 # ifdef PNG_SET_OPTION_SUPPORTED
2193 {
2194 int opt;
2195 for (opt=0; opt<ps->noptions; ++opt)
2196 if (png_set_option(ps->pread, ps->options[opt].option,
2197 ps->options[opt].setting) == PNG_OPTION_INVALID)
2198 png_error(ps->pread, "png option invalid");
2199 }
2200 # endif
2201
2202 store_read_set(ps, id);
2203
2204 if (ppi != NULL)
2205 *ppi = ps->piread = png_create_info_struct(ps->pread);
2206
2207 return ps->pread;
2208 }
2209 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
2210
2211 /* The overall cleanup of a store simply calls the above then removes all the
2212 * saved files. This does not delete the store itself.
2213 */
2214 static void
store_delete(png_store * ps)2215 store_delete(png_store *ps)
2216 {
2217 store_write_reset(ps);
2218 store_read_reset(ps);
2219 store_freefile(&ps->saved);
2220 store_image_free(ps, NULL);
2221 }
2222
2223 /*********************** PNG FILE MODIFICATION ON READ ************************/
2224 /* Files may be modified on read. The following structure contains a complete
2225 * png_store together with extra members to handle modification and a special
2226 * read callback for libpng. To use this the 'modifications' field must be set
2227 * to a list of png_modification structures that actually perform the
2228 * modification, otherwise a png_modifier is functionally equivalent to a
2229 * png_store. There is a special read function, set_modifier_for_read, which
2230 * replaces set_store_for_read.
2231 */
2232 typedef enum modifier_state
2233 {
2234 modifier_start, /* Initial value */
2235 modifier_signature, /* Have a signature */
2236 modifier_IHDR /* Have an IHDR */
2237 } modifier_state;
2238
2239 typedef struct CIE_color
2240 {
2241 /* A single CIE tristimulus value, representing the unique response of a
2242 * standard observer to a variety of light spectra. The observer recognizes
2243 * all spectra that produce this response as the same color, therefore this
2244 * is effectively a description of a color.
2245 */
2246 double X, Y, Z;
2247 } CIE_color;
2248
2249 typedef struct color_encoding
2250 {
2251 /* A description of an (R,G,B) encoding of color (as defined above); this
2252 * includes the actual colors of the (R,G,B) triples (1,0,0), (0,1,0) and
2253 * (0,0,1) plus an encoding value that is used to encode the linear
2254 * components R, G and B to give the actual values R^gamma, G^gamma and
2255 * B^gamma that are stored.
2256 */
2257 double gamma; /* Encoding (file) gamma of space */
2258 CIE_color red, green, blue; /* End points */
2259 } color_encoding;
2260
2261 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
2262 #if defined PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED && defined PNG_READ_cHRM_SUPPORTED
2263 static double
chromaticity_x(CIE_color c)2264 chromaticity_x(CIE_color c)
2265 {
2266 return c.X / (c.X + c.Y + c.Z);
2267 }
2268
2269 static double
chromaticity_y(CIE_color c)2270 chromaticity_y(CIE_color c)
2271 {
2272 return c.Y / (c.X + c.Y + c.Z);
2273 }
2274
2275 static CIE_color
white_point(const color_encoding * encoding)2276 white_point(const color_encoding *encoding)
2277 {
2278 CIE_color white;
2279
2280 white.X = encoding->red.X + encoding->green.X + encoding->blue.X;
2281 white.Y = encoding->red.Y + encoding->green.Y + encoding->blue.Y;
2282 white.Z = encoding->red.Z + encoding->green.Z + encoding->blue.Z;
2283
2284 return white;
2285 }
2286 #endif /* READ_TRANSFORMS && READ_cHRM */
2287
2288 #ifdef PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED
2289 static void
normalize_color_encoding(color_encoding * encoding)2290 normalize_color_encoding(color_encoding *encoding)
2291 {
2292 const double whiteY = encoding->red.Y + encoding->green.Y +
2293 encoding->blue.Y;
2294
2295 if (whiteY != 1)
2296 {
2297 encoding->red.X /= whiteY;
2298 encoding->red.Y /= whiteY;
2299 encoding->red.Z /= whiteY;
2300 encoding->green.X /= whiteY;
2301 encoding->green.Y /= whiteY;
2302 encoding->green.Z /= whiteY;
2303 encoding->blue.X /= whiteY;
2304 encoding->blue.Y /= whiteY;
2305 encoding->blue.Z /= whiteY;
2306 }
2307 }
2308 #endif
2309
2310 #ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
2311 static size_t
safecat_color_encoding(char * buffer,size_t bufsize,size_t pos,const color_encoding * e,double encoding_gamma)2312 safecat_color_encoding(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos,
2313 const color_encoding *e, double encoding_gamma)
2314 {
2315 if (e != 0)
2316 {
2317 if (encoding_gamma != 0)
2318 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "(");
2319 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "R(");
2320 pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->red.X, 4);
2321 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
2322 pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->red.Y, 4);
2323 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
2324 pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->red.Z, 4);
2325 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "),G(");
2326 pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->green.X, 4);
2327 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
2328 pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->green.Y, 4);
2329 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
2330 pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->green.Z, 4);
2331 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "),B(");
2332 pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->blue.X, 4);
2333 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
2334 pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->blue.Y, 4);
2335 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ",");
2336 pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, e->blue.Z, 4);
2337 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ")");
2338 if (encoding_gamma != 0)
2339 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, ")");
2340 }
2341
2342 if (encoding_gamma != 0)
2343 {
2344 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "^");
2345 pos = safecatd(buffer, bufsize, pos, encoding_gamma, 5);
2346 }
2347
2348 return pos;
2349 }
2350 #endif /* READ_TRANSFORMS */
2351 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
2352
2353 typedef struct png_modifier
2354 {
2355 png_store this; /* I am a png_store */
2356 struct png_modification *modifications; /* Changes to make */
2357
2358 modifier_state state; /* My state */
2359
2360 /* Information from IHDR: */
2361 png_byte bit_depth; /* From IHDR */
2362 png_byte colour_type; /* From IHDR */
2363
2364 /* While handling PLTE, IDAT and IEND these chunks may be pended to allow
2365 * other chunks to be inserted.
2366 */
2367 png_uint_32 pending_len;
2368 png_uint_32 pending_chunk;
2369
2370 /* Test values */
2371 double *gammas;
2372 unsigned int ngammas;
2373 unsigned int ngamma_tests; /* Number of gamma tests to run*/
2374 double current_gamma; /* 0 if not set */
2375 const color_encoding *encodings;
2376 unsigned int nencodings;
2377 const color_encoding *current_encoding; /* If an encoding has been set */
2378 unsigned int encoding_counter; /* For iteration */
2379 int encoding_ignored; /* Something overwrote it */
2380
2381 /* Control variables used to iterate through possible encodings, the
2382 * following must be set to 0 and tested by the function that uses the
2383 * png_modifier because the modifier only sets it to 1 (true.)
2384 */
2385 unsigned int repeat :1; /* Repeat this transform test. */
2386 unsigned int test_uses_encoding :1;
2387
2388 /* Lowest sbit to test (pre-1.7 libpng fails for sbit < 8) */
2389 png_byte sbitlow;
2390
2391 /* Error control - these are the limits on errors accepted by the gamma tests
2392 * below.
2393 */
2394 double maxout8; /* Maximum output value error */
2395 double maxabs8; /* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
2396 double maxcalc8; /* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
2397 double maxpc8; /* Percentage sample error 0..100% */
2398 double maxout16; /* Maximum output value error */
2399 double maxabs16; /* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
2400 double maxcalc16;/* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
2401 double maxcalcG; /* Absolute sample error 0..1 */
2402 double maxpc16; /* Percentage sample error 0..100% */
2403
2404 /* This is set by transforms that need to allow a higher limit, it is an
2405 * internal check on pngvalid to ensure that the calculated error limits are
2406 * not ridiculous; without this it is too easy to make a mistake in pngvalid
2407 * that allows any value through.
2408 *
2409 * NOTE: this is not checked in release builds.
2410 */
2411 double limit; /* limit on error values, normally 4E-3 */
2412
2413 /* Log limits - values above this are logged, but not necessarily
2414 * warned.
2415 */
2416 double log8; /* Absolute error in 8 bits to log */
2417 double log16; /* Absolute error in 16 bits to log */
2418
2419 /* Logged 8 and 16 bit errors ('output' values): */
2420 double error_gray_2;
2421 double error_gray_4;
2422 double error_gray_8;
2423 double error_gray_16;
2424 double error_color_8;
2425 double error_color_16;
2426 double error_indexed;
2427
2428 /* Flags: */
2429 /* Whether to call png_read_update_info, not png_read_start_image, and how
2430 * many times to call it.
2431 */
2432 int use_update_info;
2433
2434 /* Whether or not to interlace. */
2435 int interlace_type :9; /* int, but must store '1' */
2436
2437 /* Run the standard tests? */
2438 unsigned int test_standard :1;
2439
2440 /* Run the odd-sized image and interlace read/write tests? */
2441 unsigned int test_size :1;
2442
2443 /* Run tests on reading with a combination of transforms, */
2444 unsigned int test_transform :1;
2445 unsigned int test_tRNS :1; /* Includes tRNS images */
2446
2447 /* When to use the use_input_precision option, this controls the gamma
2448 * validation code checks. If set any value that is within the transformed
2449 * range input-.5 to input+.5 will be accepted, otherwise the value must be
2450 * within the normal limits. It should not be necessary to set this; the
2451 * result should always be exact within the permitted error limits.
2452 */
2453 unsigned int use_input_precision :1;
2454 unsigned int use_input_precision_sbit :1;
2455 unsigned int use_input_precision_16to8 :1;
2456
2457 /* If set assume that the calculation bit depth is set by the input
2458 * precision, not the output precision.
2459 */
2460 unsigned int calculations_use_input_precision :1;
2461
2462 /* If set assume that the calculations are done in 16 bits even if the sample
2463 * depth is 8 bits.
2464 */
2465 unsigned int assume_16_bit_calculations :1;
2466
2467 /* Which gamma tests to run: */
2468 unsigned int test_gamma_threshold :1;
2469 unsigned int test_gamma_transform :1; /* main tests */
2470 unsigned int test_gamma_sbit :1;
2471 unsigned int test_gamma_scale16 :1;
2472 unsigned int test_gamma_background :1;
2473 unsigned int test_gamma_alpha_mode :1;
2474 unsigned int test_gamma_expand16 :1;
2475 unsigned int test_exhaustive :1;
2476
2477 /* Whether or not to run the low-bit-depth grayscale tests. This fails on
2478 * gamma images in some cases because of gross inaccuracies in the grayscale
2479 * gamma handling for low bit depth.
2480 */
2481 unsigned int test_lbg :1;
2482 unsigned int test_lbg_gamma_threshold :1;
2483 unsigned int test_lbg_gamma_transform :1;
2484 unsigned int test_lbg_gamma_sbit :1;
2485 unsigned int test_lbg_gamma_composition :1;
2486
2487 unsigned int log :1; /* Log max error */
2488
2489 /* Buffer information, the buffer size limits the size of the chunks that can
2490 * be modified - they must fit (including header and CRC) into the buffer!
2491 */
2492 size_t flush; /* Count of bytes to flush */
2493 size_t buffer_count; /* Bytes in buffer */
2494 size_t buffer_position; /* Position in buffer */
2495 png_byte buffer[1024];
2496 } png_modifier;
2497
2498 /* This returns true if the test should be stopped now because it has already
2499 * failed and it is running silently.
2500 */
fail(png_modifier * pm)2501 static int fail(png_modifier *pm)
2502 {
2503 return !pm->log && !pm->this.verbose && (pm->this.nerrors > 0 ||
2504 (pm->this.treat_warnings_as_errors && pm->this.nwarnings > 0));
2505 }
2506
2507 static void
modifier_init(png_modifier * pm)2508 modifier_init(png_modifier *pm)
2509 {
2510 memset(pm, 0, sizeof *pm);
2511 store_init(&pm->this);
2512 pm->modifications = NULL;
2513 pm->state = modifier_start;
2514 pm->sbitlow = 1U;
2515 pm->ngammas = 0;
2516 pm->ngamma_tests = 0;
2517 pm->gammas = 0;
2518 pm->current_gamma = 0;
2519 pm->encodings = 0;
2520 pm->nencodings = 0;
2521 pm->current_encoding = 0;
2522 pm->encoding_counter = 0;
2523 pm->encoding_ignored = 0;
2524 pm->repeat = 0;
2525 pm->test_uses_encoding = 0;
2526 pm->maxout8 = pm->maxpc8 = pm->maxabs8 = pm->maxcalc8 = 0;
2527 pm->maxout16 = pm->maxpc16 = pm->maxabs16 = pm->maxcalc16 = 0;
2528 pm->maxcalcG = 0;
2529 pm->limit = 4E-3;
2530 pm->log8 = pm->log16 = 0; /* Means 'off' */
2531 pm->error_gray_2 = pm->error_gray_4 = pm->error_gray_8 = 0;
2532 pm->error_gray_16 = pm->error_color_8 = pm->error_color_16 = 0;
2533 pm->error_indexed = 0;
2534 pm->use_update_info = 0;
2535 pm->interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
2536 pm->test_standard = 0;
2537 pm->test_size = 0;
2538 pm->test_transform = 0;
2539 # ifdef PNG_WRITE_tRNS_SUPPORTED
2540 pm->test_tRNS = 1;
2541 # else
2542 pm->test_tRNS = 0;
2543 # endif
2544 pm->use_input_precision = 0;
2545 pm->use_input_precision_sbit = 0;
2546 pm->use_input_precision_16to8 = 0;
2547 pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
2548 pm->assume_16_bit_calculations = 0;
2549 pm->test_gamma_threshold = 0;
2550 pm->test_gamma_transform = 0;
2551 pm->test_gamma_sbit = 0;
2552 pm->test_gamma_scale16 = 0;
2553 pm->test_gamma_background = 0;
2554 pm->test_gamma_alpha_mode = 0;
2555 pm->test_gamma_expand16 = 0;
2556 pm->test_lbg = 1;
2557 pm->test_lbg_gamma_threshold = 1;
2558 pm->test_lbg_gamma_transform = 1;
2559 pm->test_lbg_gamma_sbit = 1;
2560 pm->test_lbg_gamma_composition = 1;
2561 pm->test_exhaustive = 0;
2562 pm->log = 0;
2563
2564 /* Rely on the memset for all the other fields - there are no pointers */
2565 }
2566
2567 #ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
2568
2569 /* This controls use of checks that explicitly know how libpng digitizes the
2570 * samples in calculations; setting this circumvents simple error limit checking
2571 * in the rgb_to_gray check, replacing it with an exact copy of the libpng 1.5
2572 * algorithm.
2573 */
2574 #define DIGITIZE PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
2575
2576 /* If pm->calculations_use_input_precision is set then operations will happen
2577 * with the precision of the input, not the precision of the output depth.
2578 *
2579 * If pm->assume_16_bit_calculations is set then even 8 bit calculations use 16
2580 * bit precision. This only affects those of the following limits that pertain
2581 * to a calculation - not a digitization operation - unless the following API is
2582 * called directly.
2583 */
2584 #ifdef PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED
2585 #if DIGITIZE
digitize(double value,int depth,int do_round)2586 static double digitize(double value, int depth, int do_round)
2587 {
2588 /* 'value' is in the range 0 to 1, the result is the same value rounded to a
2589 * multiple of the digitization factor - 8 or 16 bits depending on both the
2590 * sample depth and the 'assume' setting. Digitization is normally by
2591 * rounding and 'do_round' should be 1, if it is 0 the digitized value will
2592 * be truncated.
2593 */
2594 unsigned int digitization_factor = (1U << depth) - 1;
2595
2596 /* Limiting the range is done as a convenience to the caller - it's easier to
2597 * do it once here than every time at the call site.
2598 */
2599 if (value <= 0)
2600 value = 0;
2601
2602 else if (value >= 1)
2603 value = 1;
2604
2605 value *= digitization_factor;
2606 if (do_round) value += .5;
2607 return floor(value)/digitization_factor;
2608 }
2609 #endif
2610 #endif /* RGB_TO_GRAY */
2611
2612 #ifdef PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED
abserr(const png_modifier * pm,int in_depth,int out_depth)2613 static double abserr(const png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
2614 {
2615 /* Absolute error permitted in linear values - affected by the bit depth of
2616 * the calculations.
2617 */
2618 if (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations ||
2619 (pm->calculations_use_input_precision ? in_depth : out_depth) == 16)
2620 return pm->maxabs16;
2621 else
2622 return pm->maxabs8;
2623 }
2624
calcerr(const png_modifier * pm,int in_depth,int out_depth)2625 static double calcerr(const png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
2626 {
2627 /* Error in the linear composition arithmetic - only relevant when
2628 * composition actually happens (0 < alpha < 1).
2629 */
2630 if ((pm->calculations_use_input_precision ? in_depth : out_depth) == 16)
2631 return pm->maxcalc16;
2632 else if (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations)
2633 return pm->maxcalcG;
2634 else
2635 return pm->maxcalc8;
2636 }
2637
pcerr(const png_modifier * pm,int in_depth,int out_depth)2638 static double pcerr(const png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
2639 {
2640 /* Percentage error permitted in the linear values. Note that the specified
2641 * value is a percentage but this routine returns a simple number.
2642 */
2643 if (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations ||
2644 (pm->calculations_use_input_precision ? in_depth : out_depth) == 16)
2645 return pm->maxpc16 * .01;
2646 else
2647 return pm->maxpc8 * .01;
2648 }
2649
2650 /* Output error - the error in the encoded value. This is determined by the
2651 * digitization of the output so can be +/-0.5 in the actual output value. In
2652 * the expand_16 case with the current code in libpng the expand happens after
2653 * all the calculations are done in 8 bit arithmetic, so even though the output
2654 * depth is 16 the output error is determined by the 8 bit calculation.
2655 *
2656 * This limit is not determined by the bit depth of internal calculations.
2657 *
2658 * The specified parameter does *not* include the base .5 digitization error but
2659 * it is added here.
2660 */
outerr(const png_modifier * pm,int in_depth,int out_depth)2661 static double outerr(const png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
2662 {
2663 /* There is a serious error in the 2 and 4 bit grayscale transform because
2664 * the gamma table value (8 bits) is simply shifted, not rounded, so the
2665 * error in 4 bit grayscale gamma is up to the value below. This is a hack
2666 * to allow pngvalid to succeed:
2667 *
2668 * TODO: fix this in libpng
2669 */
2670 if (out_depth == 2)
2671 return .73182-.5;
2672
2673 if (out_depth == 4)
2674 return .90644-.5;
2675
2676 if ((pm->calculations_use_input_precision ? in_depth : out_depth) == 16)
2677 return pm->maxout16;
2678
2679 /* This is the case where the value was calculated at 8-bit precision then
2680 * scaled to 16 bits.
2681 */
2682 else if (out_depth == 16)
2683 return pm->maxout8 * 257;
2684
2685 else
2686 return pm->maxout8;
2687 }
2688
2689 /* This does the same thing as the above however it returns the value to log,
2690 * rather than raising a warning. This is useful for debugging to track down
2691 * exactly what set of parameters cause high error values.
2692 */
outlog(const png_modifier * pm,int in_depth,int out_depth)2693 static double outlog(const png_modifier *pm, int in_depth, int out_depth)
2694 {
2695 /* The command line parameters are either 8 bit (0..255) or 16 bit (0..65535)
2696 * and so must be adjusted for low bit depth grayscale:
2697 */
2698 if (out_depth <= 8)
2699 {
2700 if (pm->log8 == 0) /* switched off */
2701 return 256;
2702
2703 if (out_depth < 8)
2704 return pm->log8 / 255 * ((1<<out_depth)-1);
2705
2706 return pm->log8;
2707 }
2708
2709 if ((pm->calculations_use_input_precision ? in_depth : out_depth) == 16)
2710 {
2711 if (pm->log16 == 0)
2712 return 65536;
2713
2714 return pm->log16;
2715 }
2716
2717 /* This is the case where the value was calculated at 8-bit precision then
2718 * scaled to 16 bits.
2719 */
2720 if (pm->log8 == 0)
2721 return 65536;
2722
2723 return pm->log8 * 257;
2724 }
2725
2726 /* This complements the above by providing the appropriate quantization for the
2727 * final value. Normally this would just be quantization to an integral value,
2728 * but in the 8 bit calculation case it's actually quantization to a multiple of
2729 * 257!
2730 */
output_quantization_factor(const png_modifier * pm,int in_depth,int out_depth)2731 static int output_quantization_factor(const png_modifier *pm, int in_depth,
2732 int out_depth)
2733 {
2734 if (out_depth == 16 && in_depth != 16 &&
2735 pm->calculations_use_input_precision)
2736 return 257;
2737 else
2738 return 1;
2739 }
2740 #endif /* PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED */
2741
2742 /* One modification structure must be provided for each chunk to be modified (in
2743 * fact more than one can be provided if multiple separate changes are desired
2744 * for a single chunk.) Modifications include adding a new chunk when a
2745 * suitable chunk does not exist.
2746 *
2747 * The caller of modify_fn will reset the CRC of the chunk and record 'modified'
2748 * or 'added' as appropriate if the modify_fn returns 1 (true). If the
2749 * modify_fn is NULL the chunk is simply removed.
2750 */
2751 typedef struct png_modification
2752 {
2753 struct png_modification *next;
2754 png_uint_32 chunk;
2755
2756 /* If the following is NULL all matching chunks will be removed: */
2757 int (*modify_fn)(struct png_modifier *pm,
2758 struct png_modification *me, int add);
2759
2760 /* If the following is set to PLTE, IDAT or IEND and the chunk has not been
2761 * found and modified (and there is a modify_fn) the modify_fn will be called
2762 * to add the chunk before the relevant chunk.
2763 */
2764 png_uint_32 add;
2765 unsigned int modified :1; /* Chunk was modified */
2766 unsigned int added :1; /* Chunk was added */
2767 unsigned int removed :1; /* Chunk was removed */
2768 } png_modification;
2769
2770 static void
modification_reset(png_modification * pmm)2771 modification_reset(png_modification *pmm)
2772 {
2773 if (pmm != NULL)
2774 {
2775 pmm->modified = 0;
2776 pmm->added = 0;
2777 pmm->removed = 0;
2778 modification_reset(pmm->next);
2779 }
2780 }
2781
2782 static void
modification_init(png_modification * pmm)2783 modification_init(png_modification *pmm)
2784 {
2785 memset(pmm, 0, sizeof *pmm);
2786 pmm->next = NULL;
2787 pmm->chunk = 0;
2788 pmm->modify_fn = NULL;
2789 pmm->add = 0;
2790 modification_reset(pmm);
2791 }
2792
2793 #ifdef PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED
2794 static void
modifier_current_encoding(const png_modifier * pm,color_encoding * ce)2795 modifier_current_encoding(const png_modifier *pm, color_encoding *ce)
2796 {
2797 if (pm->current_encoding != 0)
2798 *ce = *pm->current_encoding;
2799
2800 else
2801 memset(ce, 0, sizeof *ce);
2802
2803 ce->gamma = pm->current_gamma;
2804 }
2805 #endif
2806
2807 #ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
2808 static size_t
safecat_current_encoding(char * buffer,size_t bufsize,size_t pos,const png_modifier * pm)2809 safecat_current_encoding(char *buffer, size_t bufsize, size_t pos,
2810 const png_modifier *pm)
2811 {
2812 pos = safecat_color_encoding(buffer, bufsize, pos, pm->current_encoding,
2813 pm->current_gamma);
2814
2815 if (pm->encoding_ignored)
2816 pos = safecat(buffer, bufsize, pos, "[overridden]");
2817
2818 return pos;
2819 }
2820 #endif
2821
2822 /* Iterate through the usefully testable color encodings. An encoding is one
2823 * of:
2824 *
2825 * 1) Nothing (no color space, no gamma).
2826 * 2) Just a gamma value from the gamma array (including 1.0)
2827 * 3) A color space from the encodings array with the corresponding gamma.
2828 * 4) The same, but with gamma 1.0 (only really useful with 16 bit calculations)
2829 *
2830 * The iterator selects these in turn, the randomizer selects one at random,
2831 * which is used depends on the setting of the 'test_exhaustive' flag. Notice
2832 * that this function changes the colour space encoding so it must only be
2833 * called on completion of the previous test. This is what 'modifier_reset'
2834 * does, below.
2835 *
2836 * After the function has been called the 'repeat' flag will still be set; the
2837 * caller of modifier_reset must reset it at the start of each run of the test!
2838 */
2839 static unsigned int
modifier_total_encodings(const png_modifier * pm)2840 modifier_total_encodings(const png_modifier *pm)
2841 {
2842 return 1 + /* (1) nothing */
2843 pm->ngammas + /* (2) gamma values to test */
2844 pm->nencodings + /* (3) total number of encodings */
2845 /* The following test only works after the first time through the
2846 * png_modifier code because 'bit_depth' is set when the IHDR is read.
2847 * modifier_reset, below, preserves the setting until after it has called
2848 * the iterate function (also below.)
2849 *
2850 * For this reason do not rely on this function outside a call to
2851 * modifier_reset.
2852 */
2853 ((pm->bit_depth == 16 || pm->assume_16_bit_calculations) ?
2854 pm->nencodings : 0); /* (4) encodings with gamma == 1.0 */
2855 }
2856
2857 static void
modifier_encoding_iterate(png_modifier * pm)2858 modifier_encoding_iterate(png_modifier *pm)
2859 {
2860 if (!pm->repeat && /* Else something needs the current encoding again. */
2861 pm->test_uses_encoding) /* Some transform is encoding dependent */
2862 {
2863 if (pm->test_exhaustive)
2864 {
2865 if (++pm->encoding_counter >= modifier_total_encodings(pm))
2866 pm->encoding_counter = 0; /* This will stop the repeat */
2867 }
2868
2869 else
2870 {
2871 /* Not exhaustive - choose an encoding at random; generate a number in
2872 * the range 1..(max-1), so the result is always non-zero:
2873 */
2874 if (pm->encoding_counter == 0)
2875 pm->encoding_counter = random_mod(modifier_total_encodings(pm)-1)+1;
2876 else
2877 pm->encoding_counter = 0;
2878 }
2879
2880 if (pm->encoding_counter > 0)
2881 pm->repeat = 1;
2882 }
2883
2884 else if (!pm->repeat)
2885 pm->encoding_counter = 0;
2886 }
2887
2888 static void
modifier_reset(png_modifier * pm)2889 modifier_reset(png_modifier *pm)
2890 {
2891 store_read_reset(&pm->this);
2892 pm->limit = 4E-3;
2893 pm->pending_len = pm->pending_chunk = 0;
2894 pm->flush = pm->buffer_count = pm->buffer_position = 0;
2895 pm->modifications = NULL;
2896 pm->state = modifier_start;
2897 modifier_encoding_iterate(pm);
2898 /* The following must be set in the next run. In particular
2899 * test_uses_encodings must be set in the _ini function of each transform
2900 * that looks at the encodings. (Not the 'add' function!)
2901 */
2902 pm->test_uses_encoding = 0;
2903 pm->current_gamma = 0;
2904 pm->current_encoding = 0;
2905 pm->encoding_ignored = 0;
2906 /* These only become value after IHDR is read: */
2907 pm->bit_depth = pm->colour_type = 0;
2908 }
2909
2910 /* The following must be called before anything else to get the encoding set up
2911 * on the modifier. In particular it must be called before the transform init
2912 * functions are called.
2913 */
2914 static void
modifier_set_encoding(png_modifier * pm)2915 modifier_set_encoding(png_modifier *pm)
2916 {
2917 /* Set the encoding to the one specified by the current encoding counter,
2918 * first clear out all the settings - this corresponds to an encoding_counter
2919 * of 0.
2920 */
2921 pm->current_gamma = 0;
2922 pm->current_encoding = 0;
2923 pm->encoding_ignored = 0; /* not ignored yet - happens in _ini functions. */
2924
2925 /* Now, if required, set the gamma and encoding fields. */
2926 if (pm->encoding_counter > 0)
2927 {
2928 /* The gammas[] array is an array of screen gammas, not encoding gammas,
2929 * so we need the inverse:
2930 */
2931 if (pm->encoding_counter <= pm->ngammas)
2932 pm->current_gamma = 1/pm->gammas[pm->encoding_counter-1];
2933
2934 else
2935 {
2936 unsigned int i = pm->encoding_counter - pm->ngammas;
2937
2938 if (i >= pm->nencodings)
2939 {
2940 i %= pm->nencodings;
2941 pm->current_gamma = 1; /* Linear, only in the 16 bit case */
2942 }
2943
2944 else
2945 pm->current_gamma = pm->encodings[i].gamma;
2946
2947 pm->current_encoding = pm->encodings + i;
2948 }
2949 }
2950 }
2951
2952 /* Enquiry functions to find out what is set. Notice that there is an implicit
2953 * assumption below that the first encoding in the list is the one for sRGB.
2954 */
2955 static int
modifier_color_encoding_is_sRGB(const png_modifier * pm)2956 modifier_color_encoding_is_sRGB(const png_modifier *pm)
2957 {
2958 return pm->current_encoding != 0 && pm->current_encoding == pm->encodings &&
2959 pm->current_encoding->gamma == pm->current_gamma;
2960 }
2961
2962 static int
modifier_color_encoding_is_set(const png_modifier * pm)2963 modifier_color_encoding_is_set(const png_modifier *pm)
2964 {
2965 return pm->current_gamma != 0;
2966 }
2967
2968 /* The guts of modification are performed during a read. */
2969 static void
modifier_crc(png_bytep buffer)2970 modifier_crc(png_bytep buffer)
2971 {
2972 /* Recalculate the chunk CRC - a complete chunk must be in
2973 * the buffer, at the start.
2974 */
2975 uInt datalen = png_get_uint_32(buffer);
2976 uLong crc = crc32(0, buffer+4, datalen+4);
2977 /* The cast to png_uint_32 is safe because a crc32 is always a 32 bit value.
2978 */
2979 png_save_uint_32(buffer+datalen+8, (png_uint_32)crc);
2980 }
2981
2982 static void
modifier_setbuffer(png_modifier * pm)2983 modifier_setbuffer(png_modifier *pm)
2984 {
2985 modifier_crc(pm->buffer);
2986 pm->buffer_count = png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer)+12;
2987 pm->buffer_position = 0;
2988 }
2989
2990 /* Separate the callback into the actual implementation (which is passed the
2991 * png_modifier explicitly) and the callback, which gets the modifier from the
2992 * png_struct.
2993 */
2994 static void
modifier_read_imp(png_modifier * pm,png_bytep pb,size_t st)2995 modifier_read_imp(png_modifier *pm, png_bytep pb, size_t st)
2996 {
2997 while (st > 0)
2998 {
2999 size_t cb;
3000 png_uint_32 len, chunk;
3001 png_modification *mod;
3002
3003 if (pm->buffer_position >= pm->buffer_count) switch (pm->state)
3004 {
3005 static png_byte sign[8] = { 137, 80, 78, 71, 13, 10, 26, 10 };
3006 case modifier_start:
3007 store_read_chunk(&pm->this, pm->buffer, 8, 8); /* signature. */
3008 pm->buffer_count = 8;
3009 pm->buffer_position = 0;
3010
3011 if (memcmp(pm->buffer, sign, 8) != 0)
3012 png_error(pm->this.pread, "invalid PNG file signature");
3013 pm->state = modifier_signature;
3014 break;
3015
3016 case modifier_signature:
3017 store_read_chunk(&pm->this, pm->buffer, 13+12, 13+12); /* IHDR */
3018 pm->buffer_count = 13+12;
3019 pm->buffer_position = 0;
3020
3021 if (png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer) != 13 ||
3022 png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer+4) != CHUNK_IHDR)
3023 png_error(pm->this.pread, "invalid IHDR");
3024
3025 /* Check the list of modifiers for modifications to the IHDR. */
3026 mod = pm->modifications;
3027 while (mod != NULL)
3028 {
3029 if (mod->chunk == CHUNK_IHDR && mod->modify_fn &&
3030 (*mod->modify_fn)(pm, mod, 0))
3031 {
3032 mod->modified = 1;
3033 modifier_setbuffer(pm);
3034 }
3035
3036 /* Ignore removal or add if IHDR! */
3037 mod = mod->next;
3038 }
3039
3040 /* Cache information from the IHDR (the modified one.) */
3041 pm->bit_depth = pm->buffer[8+8];
3042 pm->colour_type = pm->buffer[8+8+1];
3043
3044 pm->state = modifier_IHDR;
3045 pm->flush = 0;
3046 break;
3047
3048 case modifier_IHDR:
3049 default:
3050 /* Read a new chunk and process it until we see PLTE, IDAT or
3051 * IEND. 'flush' indicates that there is still some data to
3052 * output from the preceding chunk.
3053 */
3054 if ((cb = pm->flush) > 0)
3055 {
3056 if (cb > st) cb = st;
3057 pm->flush -= cb;
3058 store_read_chunk(&pm->this, pb, cb, cb);
3059 pb += cb;
3060 st -= cb;
3061 if (st == 0) return;
3062 }
3063
3064 /* No more bytes to flush, read a header, or handle a pending
3065 * chunk.
3066 */
3067 if (pm->pending_chunk != 0)
3068 {
3069 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, pm->pending_len);
3070 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, pm->pending_chunk);
3071 pm->pending_len = 0;
3072 pm->pending_chunk = 0;
3073 }
3074 else
3075 store_read_chunk(&pm->this, pm->buffer, 8, 8);
3076
3077 pm->buffer_count = 8;
3078 pm->buffer_position = 0;
3079
3080 /* Check for something to modify or a terminator chunk. */
3081 len = png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer);
3082 chunk = png_get_uint_32(pm->buffer+4);
3083
3084 /* Terminators first, they may have to be delayed for added
3085 * chunks
3086 */
3087 if (chunk == CHUNK_PLTE || chunk == CHUNK_IDAT ||
3088 chunk == CHUNK_IEND)
3089 {
3090 mod = pm->modifications;
3091
3092 while (mod != NULL)
3093 {
3094 if ((mod->add == chunk ||
3095 (mod->add == CHUNK_PLTE && chunk == CHUNK_IDAT)) &&
3096 mod->modify_fn != NULL && !mod->modified && !mod->added)
3097 {
3098 /* Regardless of what the modify function does do not run
3099 * this again.
3100 */
3101 mod->added = 1;
3102
3103 if ((*mod->modify_fn)(pm, mod, 1 /*add*/))
3104 {
3105 /* Reset the CRC on a new chunk */
3106 if (pm->buffer_count > 0)
3107 modifier_setbuffer(pm);
3108
3109 else
3110 {
3111 pm->buffer_position = 0;
3112 mod->removed = 1;
3113 }
3114
3115 /* The buffer has been filled with something (we assume)
3116 * so output this. Pend the current chunk.
3117 */
3118 pm->pending_len = len;
3119 pm->pending_chunk = chunk;
3120 break; /* out of while */
3121 }
3122 }
3123
3124 mod = mod->next;
3125 }
3126
3127 /* Don't do any further processing if the buffer was modified -
3128 * otherwise the code will end up modifying a chunk that was
3129 * just added.
3130 */
3131 if (mod != NULL)
3132 break; /* out of switch */
3133 }
3134
3135 /* If we get to here then this chunk may need to be modified. To
3136 * do this it must be less than 1024 bytes in total size, otherwise
3137 * it just gets flushed.
3138 */
3139 if (len+12 <= sizeof pm->buffer)
3140 {
3141 size_t s = len+12-pm->buffer_count;
3142 store_read_chunk(&pm->this, pm->buffer+pm->buffer_count, s, s);
3143 pm->buffer_count = len+12;
3144
3145 /* Check for a modification, else leave it be. */
3146 mod = pm->modifications;
3147 while (mod != NULL)
3148 {
3149 if (mod->chunk == chunk)
3150 {
3151 if (mod->modify_fn == NULL)
3152 {
3153 /* Remove this chunk */
3154 pm->buffer_count = pm->buffer_position = 0;
3155 mod->removed = 1;
3156 break; /* Terminate the while loop */
3157 }
3158
3159 else if ((*mod->modify_fn)(pm, mod, 0))
3160 {
3161 mod->modified = 1;
3162 /* The chunk may have been removed: */
3163 if (pm->buffer_count == 0)
3164 {
3165 pm->buffer_position = 0;
3166 break;
3167 }
3168 modifier_setbuffer(pm);
3169 }
3170 }
3171
3172 mod = mod->next;
3173 }
3174 }
3175
3176 else
3177 pm->flush = len+12 - pm->buffer_count; /* data + crc */
3178
3179 /* Take the data from the buffer (if there is any). */
3180 break;
3181 }
3182
3183 /* Here to read from the modifier buffer (not directly from
3184 * the store, as in the flush case above.)
3185 */
3186 cb = pm->buffer_count - pm->buffer_position;
3187
3188 if (cb > st)
3189 cb = st;
3190
3191 memcpy(pb, pm->buffer + pm->buffer_position, cb);
3192 st -= cb;
3193 pb += cb;
3194 pm->buffer_position += cb;
3195 }
3196 }
3197
3198 /* The callback: */
3199 static void PNGCBAPI
modifier_read(png_structp ppIn,png_bytep pb,size_t st)3200 modifier_read(png_structp ppIn, png_bytep pb, size_t st)
3201 {
3202 png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
3203 png_modifier *pm = voidcast(png_modifier*, png_get_io_ptr(pp));
3204
3205 if (pm == NULL || pm->this.pread != pp)
3206 png_error(pp, "bad modifier_read call");
3207
3208 modifier_read_imp(pm, pb, st);
3209 }
3210
3211 /* Like store_progressive_read but the data is getting changed as we go so we
3212 * need a local buffer.
3213 */
3214 static void
modifier_progressive_read(png_modifier * pm,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)3215 modifier_progressive_read(png_modifier *pm, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
3216 {
3217 if (pm->this.pread != pp || pm->this.current == NULL ||
3218 pm->this.next == NULL)
3219 png_error(pp, "store state damaged (progressive)");
3220
3221 /* This is another Horowitz and Hill random noise generator. In this case
3222 * the aim is to stress the progressive reader with truly horrible variable
3223 * buffer sizes in the range 1..500, so a sequence of 9 bit random numbers
3224 * is generated. We could probably just count from 1 to 32767 and get as
3225 * good a result.
3226 */
3227 for (;;)
3228 {
3229 static png_uint_32 noise = 1;
3230 size_t cb, cbAvail;
3231 png_byte buffer[512];
3232
3233 /* Generate 15 more bits of stuff: */
3234 noise = (noise << 9) | ((noise ^ (noise >> (9-5))) & 0x1ff);
3235 cb = noise & 0x1ff;
3236
3237 /* Check that this number of bytes are available (in the current buffer.)
3238 * (This doesn't quite work - the modifier might delete a chunk; unlikely
3239 * but possible, it doesn't happen at present because the modifier only
3240 * adds chunks to standard images.)
3241 */
3242 cbAvail = store_read_buffer_avail(&pm->this);
3243 if (pm->buffer_count > pm->buffer_position)
3244 cbAvail += pm->buffer_count - pm->buffer_position;
3245
3246 if (cb > cbAvail)
3247 {
3248 /* Check for EOF: */
3249 if (cbAvail == 0)
3250 break;
3251
3252 cb = cbAvail;
3253 }
3254
3255 modifier_read_imp(pm, buffer, cb);
3256 png_process_data(pp, pi, buffer, cb);
3257 }
3258
3259 /* Check the invariants at the end (if this fails it's a problem in this
3260 * file!)
3261 */
3262 if (pm->buffer_count > pm->buffer_position ||
3263 pm->this.next != &pm->this.current->data ||
3264 pm->this.readpos < pm->this.current->datacount)
3265 png_error(pp, "progressive read implementation error");
3266 }
3267
3268 /* Set up a modifier. */
3269 static png_structp
set_modifier_for_read(png_modifier * pm,png_infopp ppi,png_uint_32 id,const char * name)3270 set_modifier_for_read(png_modifier *pm, png_infopp ppi, png_uint_32 id,
3271 const char *name)
3272 {
3273 /* Do this first so that the modifier fields are cleared even if an error
3274 * happens allocating the png_struct. No allocation is done here so no
3275 * cleanup is required.
3276 */
3277 pm->state = modifier_start;
3278 pm->bit_depth = 0;
3279 pm->colour_type = 255;
3280
3281 pm->pending_len = 0;
3282 pm->pending_chunk = 0;
3283 pm->flush = 0;
3284 pm->buffer_count = 0;
3285 pm->buffer_position = 0;
3286
3287 return set_store_for_read(&pm->this, ppi, id, name);
3288 }
3289
3290
3291 /******************************** MODIFICATIONS *******************************/
3292 /* Standard modifications to add chunks. These do not require the _SUPPORTED
3293 * macros because the chunks can be there regardless of whether this specific
3294 * libpng supports them.
3295 */
3296 typedef struct gama_modification
3297 {
3298 png_modification this;
3299 png_fixed_point gamma;
3300 } gama_modification;
3301
3302 static int
gama_modify(png_modifier * pm,png_modification * me,int add)3303 gama_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
3304 {
3305 UNUSED(add)
3306 /* This simply dumps the given gamma value into the buffer. */
3307 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, 4);
3308 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, CHUNK_gAMA);
3309 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+8, ((gama_modification*)me)->gamma);
3310 return 1;
3311 }
3312
3313 static void
gama_modification_init(gama_modification * me,png_modifier * pm,double gammad)3314 gama_modification_init(gama_modification *me, png_modifier *pm, double gammad)
3315 {
3316 double g;
3317
3318 modification_init(&me->this);
3319 me->this.chunk = CHUNK_gAMA;
3320 me->this.modify_fn = gama_modify;
3321 me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
3322 g = fix(gammad);
3323 me->gamma = (png_fixed_point)g;
3324 me->this.next = pm->modifications;
3325 pm->modifications = &me->this;
3326 }
3327
3328 typedef struct chrm_modification
3329 {
3330 png_modification this;
3331 const color_encoding *encoding;
3332 png_fixed_point wx, wy, rx, ry, gx, gy, bx, by;
3333 } chrm_modification;
3334
3335 static int
chrm_modify(png_modifier * pm,png_modification * me,int add)3336 chrm_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
3337 {
3338 UNUSED(add)
3339 /* As with gAMA this just adds the required cHRM chunk to the buffer. */
3340 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer , 32);
3341 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+ 4, CHUNK_cHRM);
3342 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+ 8, ((chrm_modification*)me)->wx);
3343 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+12, ((chrm_modification*)me)->wy);
3344 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+16, ((chrm_modification*)me)->rx);
3345 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+20, ((chrm_modification*)me)->ry);
3346 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+24, ((chrm_modification*)me)->gx);
3347 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+28, ((chrm_modification*)me)->gy);
3348 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+32, ((chrm_modification*)me)->bx);
3349 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+36, ((chrm_modification*)me)->by);
3350 return 1;
3351 }
3352
3353 static void
chrm_modification_init(chrm_modification * me,png_modifier * pm,const color_encoding * encoding)3354 chrm_modification_init(chrm_modification *me, png_modifier *pm,
3355 const color_encoding *encoding)
3356 {
3357 CIE_color white = white_point(encoding);
3358
3359 /* Original end points: */
3360 me->encoding = encoding;
3361
3362 /* Chromaticities (in fixed point): */
3363 me->wx = fix(chromaticity_x(white));
3364 me->wy = fix(chromaticity_y(white));
3365
3366 me->rx = fix(chromaticity_x(encoding->red));
3367 me->ry = fix(chromaticity_y(encoding->red));
3368 me->gx = fix(chromaticity_x(encoding->green));
3369 me->gy = fix(chromaticity_y(encoding->green));
3370 me->bx = fix(chromaticity_x(encoding->blue));
3371 me->by = fix(chromaticity_y(encoding->blue));
3372
3373 modification_init(&me->this);
3374 me->this.chunk = CHUNK_cHRM;
3375 me->this.modify_fn = chrm_modify;
3376 me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
3377 me->this.next = pm->modifications;
3378 pm->modifications = &me->this;
3379 }
3380
3381 typedef struct srgb_modification
3382 {
3383 png_modification this;
3384 png_byte intent;
3385 } srgb_modification;
3386
3387 static int
srgb_modify(png_modifier * pm,png_modification * me,int add)3388 srgb_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
3389 {
3390 UNUSED(add)
3391 /* As above, ignore add and just make a new chunk */
3392 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, 1);
3393 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, CHUNK_sRGB);
3394 pm->buffer[8] = ((srgb_modification*)me)->intent;
3395 return 1;
3396 }
3397
3398 static void
srgb_modification_init(srgb_modification * me,png_modifier * pm,png_byte intent)3399 srgb_modification_init(srgb_modification *me, png_modifier *pm, png_byte intent)
3400 {
3401 modification_init(&me->this);
3402 me->this.chunk = CHUNK_sBIT;
3403
3404 if (intent <= 3) /* if valid, else *delete* sRGB chunks */
3405 {
3406 me->this.modify_fn = srgb_modify;
3407 me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
3408 me->intent = intent;
3409 }
3410
3411 else
3412 {
3413 me->this.modify_fn = 0;
3414 me->this.add = 0;
3415 me->intent = 0;
3416 }
3417
3418 me->this.next = pm->modifications;
3419 pm->modifications = &me->this;
3420 }
3421
3422 #ifdef PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED
3423 typedef struct sbit_modification
3424 {
3425 png_modification this;
3426 png_byte sbit;
3427 } sbit_modification;
3428
3429 static int
sbit_modify(png_modifier * pm,png_modification * me,int add)3430 sbit_modify(png_modifier *pm, png_modification *me, int add)
3431 {
3432 png_byte sbit = ((sbit_modification*)me)->sbit;
3433 if (pm->bit_depth > sbit)
3434 {
3435 int cb = 0;
3436 switch (pm->colour_type)
3437 {
3438 case 0:
3439 cb = 1;
3440 break;
3441
3442 case 2:
3443 case 3:
3444 cb = 3;
3445 break;
3446
3447 case 4:
3448 cb = 2;
3449 break;
3450
3451 case 6:
3452 cb = 4;
3453 break;
3454
3455 default:
3456 png_error(pm->this.pread,
3457 "unexpected colour type in sBIT modification");
3458 }
3459
3460 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer, cb);
3461 png_save_uint_32(pm->buffer+4, CHUNK_sBIT);
3462
3463 while (cb > 0)
3464 (pm->buffer+8)[--cb] = sbit;
3465
3466 return 1;
3467 }
3468 else if (!add)
3469 {
3470 /* Remove the sBIT chunk */
3471 pm->buffer_count = pm->buffer_position = 0;
3472 return 1;
3473 }
3474 else
3475 return 0; /* do nothing */
3476 }
3477
3478 static void
sbit_modification_init(sbit_modification * me,png_modifier * pm,png_byte sbit)3479 sbit_modification_init(sbit_modification *me, png_modifier *pm, png_byte sbit)
3480 {
3481 modification_init(&me->this);
3482 me->this.chunk = CHUNK_sBIT;
3483 me->this.modify_fn = sbit_modify;
3484 me->this.add = CHUNK_PLTE;
3485 me->sbit = sbit;
3486 me->this.next = pm->modifications;
3487 pm->modifications = &me->this;
3488 }
3489 #endif /* PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED */
3490 #endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
3491
3492 /***************************** STANDARD PNG FILES *****************************/
3493 /* Standard files - write and save standard files. */
3494 /* There are two basic forms of standard images. Those which attempt to have
3495 * all the possible pixel values (not possible for 16bpp images, but a range of
3496 * values are produced) and those which have a range of image sizes. The former
3497 * are used for testing transforms, in particular gamma correction and bit
3498 * reduction and increase. The latter are reserved for testing the behavior of
3499 * libpng with respect to 'odd' image sizes - particularly small images where
3500 * rows become 1 byte and interlace passes disappear.
3501 *
3502 * The first, most useful, set are the 'transform' images, the second set of
3503 * small images are the 'size' images.
3504 *
3505 * The transform files are constructed with rows which fit into a 1024 byte row
3506 * buffer. This makes allocation easier below. Further regardless of the file
3507 * format every row has 128 pixels (giving 1024 bytes for 64bpp formats).
3508 *
3509 * Files are stored with no gAMA or sBIT chunks, with a PLTE only when needed
3510 * and with an ID derived from the colour type, bit depth and interlace type
3511 * as above (FILEID). The width (128) and height (variable) are not stored in
3512 * the FILEID - instead the fields are set to 0, indicating a transform file.
3513 *
3514 * The size files ar constructed with rows a maximum of 128 bytes wide, allowing
3515 * a maximum width of 16 pixels (for the 64bpp case.) They also have a maximum
3516 * height of 16 rows. The width and height are stored in the FILEID and, being
3517 * non-zero, indicate a size file.
3518 *
3519 * Because the PNG filter code is typically the largest CPU consumer within
3520 * libpng itself there is a tendency to attempt to optimize it. This results in
3521 * special case code which needs to be validated. To cause this to happen the
3522 * 'size' images are made to use each possible filter, in so far as this is
3523 * possible for smaller images.
3524 *
3525 * For palette image (colour type 3) multiple transform images are stored with
3526 * the same bit depth to allow testing of more colour combinations -
3527 * particularly important for testing the gamma code because libpng uses a
3528 * different code path for palette images. For size images a single palette is
3529 * used.
3530 */
3531
3532 /* Make a 'standard' palette. Because there are only 256 entries in a palette
3533 * (maximum) this actually makes a random palette in the hope that enough tests
3534 * will catch enough errors. (Note that the same palette isn't produced every
3535 * time for the same test - it depends on what previous tests have been run -
3536 * but a given set of arguments to pngvalid will always produce the same palette
3537 * at the same test! This is why pseudo-random number generators are useful for
3538 * testing.)
3539 *
3540 * The store must be open for write when this is called, otherwise an internal
3541 * error will occur. This routine contains its own magic number seed, so the
3542 * palettes generated don't change if there are intervening errors (changing the
3543 * calls to the store_mark seed.)
3544 */
3545 static store_palette_entry *
make_standard_palette(png_store * ps,int npalette,int do_tRNS)3546 make_standard_palette(png_store* ps, int npalette, int do_tRNS)
3547 {
3548 static png_uint_32 palette_seed[2] = { 0x87654321, 9 };
3549
3550 int i = 0;
3551 png_byte values[256][4];
3552
3553 /* Always put in black and white plus the six primary and secondary colors.
3554 */
3555 for (; i<8; ++i)
3556 {
3557 values[i][1] = (png_byte)((i&1) ? 255U : 0U);
3558 values[i][2] = (png_byte)((i&2) ? 255U : 0U);
3559 values[i][3] = (png_byte)((i&4) ? 255U : 0U);
3560 }
3561
3562 /* Then add 62 grays (one quarter of the remaining 256 slots). */
3563 {
3564 int j = 0;
3565 png_byte random_bytes[4];
3566 png_byte need[256];
3567
3568 need[0] = 0; /*got black*/
3569 memset(need+1, 1, (sizeof need)-2); /*need these*/
3570 need[255] = 0; /*but not white*/
3571
3572 while (i<70)
3573 {
3574 png_byte b;
3575
3576 if (j==0)
3577 {
3578 make_four_random_bytes(palette_seed, random_bytes);
3579 j = 4;
3580 }
3581
3582 b = random_bytes[--j];
3583 if (need[b])
3584 {
3585 values[i][1] = b;
3586 values[i][2] = b;
3587 values[i++][3] = b;
3588 }
3589 }
3590 }
3591
3592 /* Finally add 192 colors at random - don't worry about matches to things we
3593 * already have, chance is less than 1/65536. Don't worry about grays,
3594 * chance is the same, so we get a duplicate or extra gray less than 1 time
3595 * in 170.
3596 */
3597 for (; i<256; ++i)
3598 make_four_random_bytes(palette_seed, values[i]);
3599
3600 /* Fill in the alpha values in the first byte. Just use all possible values
3601 * (0..255) in an apparently random order:
3602 */
3603 {
3604 store_palette_entry *palette;
3605 png_byte selector[4];
3606
3607 make_four_random_bytes(palette_seed, selector);
3608
3609 if (do_tRNS)
3610 for (i=0; i<256; ++i)
3611 values[i][0] = (png_byte)(i ^ selector[0]);
3612
3613 else
3614 for (i=0; i<256; ++i)
3615 values[i][0] = 255; /* no transparency/tRNS chunk */
3616
3617 /* 'values' contains 256 ARGB values, but we only need 'npalette'.
3618 * 'npalette' will always be a power of 2: 2, 4, 16 or 256. In the low
3619 * bit depth cases select colors at random, else it is difficult to have
3620 * a set of low bit depth palette test with any chance of a reasonable
3621 * range of colors. Do this by randomly permuting values into the low
3622 * 'npalette' entries using an XOR mask generated here. This also
3623 * permutes the npalette == 256 case in a potentially useful way (there is
3624 * no relationship between palette index and the color value therein!)
3625 */
3626 palette = store_write_palette(ps, npalette);
3627
3628 for (i=0; i<npalette; ++i)
3629 {
3630 palette[i].alpha = values[i ^ selector[1]][0];
3631 palette[i].red = values[i ^ selector[1]][1];
3632 palette[i].green = values[i ^ selector[1]][2];
3633 palette[i].blue = values[i ^ selector[1]][3];
3634 }
3635
3636 return palette;
3637 }
3638 }
3639
3640 /* Initialize a standard palette on a write stream. The 'do_tRNS' argument
3641 * indicates whether or not to also set the tRNS chunk.
3642 */
3643 /* TODO: the png_structp here can probably be 'const' in the future */
3644 static void
init_standard_palette(png_store * ps,png_structp pp,png_infop pi,int npalette,int do_tRNS)3645 init_standard_palette(png_store *ps, png_structp pp, png_infop pi, int npalette,
3646 int do_tRNS)
3647 {
3648 store_palette_entry *ppal = make_standard_palette(ps, npalette, do_tRNS);
3649
3650 {
3651 int i;
3652 png_color palette[256];
3653
3654 /* Set all entries to detect overread errors. */
3655 for (i=0; i<npalette; ++i)
3656 {
3657 palette[i].red = ppal[i].red;
3658 palette[i].green = ppal[i].green;
3659 palette[i].blue = ppal[i].blue;
3660 }
3661
3662 /* Just in case fill in the rest with detectable values: */
3663 for (; i<256; ++i)
3664 palette[i].red = palette[i].green = palette[i].blue = 42;
3665
3666 png_set_PLTE(pp, pi, palette, npalette);
3667 }
3668
3669 if (do_tRNS)
3670 {
3671 int i, j;
3672 png_byte tRNS[256];
3673
3674 /* Set all the entries, but skip trailing opaque entries */
3675 for (i=j=0; i<npalette; ++i)
3676 if ((tRNS[i] = ppal[i].alpha) < 255)
3677 j = i+1;
3678
3679 /* Fill in the remainder with a detectable value: */
3680 for (; i<256; ++i)
3681 tRNS[i] = 24;
3682
3683 #ifdef PNG_WRITE_tRNS_SUPPORTED
3684 if (j > 0)
3685 png_set_tRNS(pp, pi, tRNS, j, 0/*color*/);
3686 #endif
3687 }
3688 }
3689
3690 #ifdef PNG_WRITE_tRNS_SUPPORTED
3691 static void
set_random_tRNS(png_structp pp,png_infop pi,png_byte colour_type,int bit_depth)3692 set_random_tRNS(png_structp pp, png_infop pi, png_byte colour_type,
3693 int bit_depth)
3694 {
3695 /* To make this useful the tRNS color needs to match at least one pixel.
3696 * Random values are fine for gray, including the 16-bit case where we know
3697 * that the test image contains all the gray values. For RGB we need more
3698 * method as only 65536 different RGB values are generated.
3699 */
3700 png_color_16 tRNS;
3701 png_uint_16 mask = (png_uint_16)((1U << bit_depth)-1);
3702
3703 R8(tRNS); /* makes unset fields random */
3704
3705 if (colour_type & 2/*RGB*/)
3706 {
3707 if (bit_depth == 8)
3708 {
3709 tRNS.red = random_u16();
3710 tRNS.green = random_u16();
3711 tRNS.blue = tRNS.red ^ tRNS.green;
3712 tRNS.red &= mask;
3713 tRNS.green &= mask;
3714 tRNS.blue &= mask;
3715 }
3716
3717 else /* bit_depth == 16 */
3718 {
3719 tRNS.red = random_u16();
3720 tRNS.green = (png_uint_16)(tRNS.red * 257);
3721 tRNS.blue = (png_uint_16)(tRNS.green * 17);
3722 }
3723 }
3724
3725 else
3726 {
3727 tRNS.gray = random_u16();
3728 tRNS.gray &= mask;
3729 }
3730
3731 png_set_tRNS(pp, pi, NULL, 0, &tRNS);
3732 }
3733 #endif
3734
3735 /* The number of passes is related to the interlace type. There was no libpng
3736 * API to determine this prior to 1.5, so we need an inquiry function:
3737 */
3738 static int
npasses_from_interlace_type(png_const_structp pp,int interlace_type)3739 npasses_from_interlace_type(png_const_structp pp, int interlace_type)
3740 {
3741 switch (interlace_type)
3742 {
3743 default:
3744 png_error(pp, "invalid interlace type");
3745
3746 case PNG_INTERLACE_NONE:
3747 return 1;
3748
3749 case PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7:
3750 return PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7_PASSES;
3751 }
3752 }
3753
3754 static unsigned int
bit_size(png_const_structp pp,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)3755 bit_size(png_const_structp pp, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
3756 {
3757 switch (colour_type)
3758 {
3759 default: png_error(pp, "invalid color type");
3760
3761 case 0: return bit_depth;
3762
3763 case 2: return 3*bit_depth;
3764
3765 case 3: return bit_depth;
3766
3767 case 4: return 2*bit_depth;
3768
3769 case 6: return 4*bit_depth;
3770 }
3771 }
3772
3773 #define TRANSFORM_WIDTH 128U
3774 #define TRANSFORM_ROWMAX (TRANSFORM_WIDTH*8U)
3775 #define SIZE_ROWMAX (16*8U) /* 16 pixels, max 8 bytes each - 128 bytes */
3776 #define STANDARD_ROWMAX TRANSFORM_ROWMAX /* The larger of the two */
3777 #define SIZE_HEIGHTMAX 16 /* Maximum range of size images */
3778
3779 static size_t
transform_rowsize(png_const_structp pp,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)3780 transform_rowsize(png_const_structp pp, png_byte colour_type,
3781 png_byte bit_depth)
3782 {
3783 return (TRANSFORM_WIDTH * bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth)) / 8;
3784 }
3785
3786 /* transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth) current returns the same number
3787 * every time, so just use a macro:
3788 */
3789 #define transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth) TRANSFORM_WIDTH
3790
3791 static png_uint_32
transform_height(png_const_structp pp,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)3792 transform_height(png_const_structp pp, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
3793 {
3794 switch (bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
3795 {
3796 case 1:
3797 case 2:
3798 case 4:
3799 return 1; /* Total of 128 pixels */
3800
3801 case 8:
3802 return 2; /* Total of 256 pixels/bytes */
3803
3804 case 16:
3805 return 512; /* Total of 65536 pixels */
3806
3807 case 24:
3808 case 32:
3809 return 512; /* 65536 pixels */
3810
3811 case 48:
3812 case 64:
3813 return 2048;/* 4 x 65536 pixels. */
3814 # define TRANSFORM_HEIGHTMAX 2048
3815
3816 default:
3817 return 0; /* Error, will be caught later */
3818 }
3819 }
3820
3821 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
3822 /* The following can only be defined here, now we have the definitions
3823 * of the transform image sizes.
3824 */
3825 static png_uint_32
standard_width(png_const_structp pp,png_uint_32 id)3826 standard_width(png_const_structp pp, png_uint_32 id)
3827 {
3828 png_uint_32 width = WIDTH_FROM_ID(id);
3829 UNUSED(pp)
3830
3831 if (width == 0)
3832 width = transform_width(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id));
3833
3834 return width;
3835 }
3836
3837 static png_uint_32
standard_height(png_const_structp pp,png_uint_32 id)3838 standard_height(png_const_structp pp, png_uint_32 id)
3839 {
3840 png_uint_32 height = HEIGHT_FROM_ID(id);
3841
3842 if (height == 0)
3843 height = transform_height(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id));
3844
3845 return height;
3846 }
3847
3848 static png_uint_32
standard_rowsize(png_const_structp pp,png_uint_32 id)3849 standard_rowsize(png_const_structp pp, png_uint_32 id)
3850 {
3851 png_uint_32 width = standard_width(pp, id);
3852
3853 /* This won't overflow: */
3854 width *= bit_size(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id));
3855 return (width + 7) / 8;
3856 }
3857 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
3858
3859 static void
transform_row(png_const_structp pp,png_byte buffer[TRANSFORM_ROWMAX],png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth,png_uint_32 y)3860 transform_row(png_const_structp pp, png_byte buffer[TRANSFORM_ROWMAX],
3861 png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth, png_uint_32 y)
3862 {
3863 png_uint_32 v = y << 7;
3864 png_uint_32 i = 0;
3865
3866 switch (bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
3867 {
3868 case 1:
3869 while (i<128/8) buffer[i] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff), v += 17, ++i;
3870 return;
3871
3872 case 2:
3873 while (i<128/4) buffer[i] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff), v += 33, ++i;
3874 return;
3875
3876 case 4:
3877 while (i<128/2) buffer[i] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff), v += 65, ++i;
3878 return;
3879
3880 case 8:
3881 /* 256 bytes total, 128 bytes in each row set as follows: */
3882 while (i<128) buffer[i] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff), ++v, ++i;
3883 return;
3884
3885 case 16:
3886 /* Generate all 65536 pixel values in order, which includes the 8 bit
3887 * GA case as well as the 16 bit G case.
3888 */
3889 while (i<128)
3890 {
3891 buffer[2*i] = (png_byte)((v>>8) & 0xff);
3892 buffer[2*i+1] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff);
3893 ++v;
3894 ++i;
3895 }
3896
3897 return;
3898
3899 case 24:
3900 /* 65535 pixels, but rotate the values. */
3901 while (i<128)
3902 {
3903 /* Three bytes per pixel, r, g, b, make b by r^g */
3904 buffer[3*i+0] = (png_byte)((v >> 8) & 0xff);
3905 buffer[3*i+1] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff);
3906 buffer[3*i+2] = (png_byte)(((v >> 8) ^ v) & 0xff);
3907 ++v;
3908 ++i;
3909 }
3910
3911 return;
3912
3913 case 32:
3914 /* 65535 pixels, r, g, b, a; just replicate */
3915 while (i<128)
3916 {
3917 buffer[4*i+0] = (png_byte)((v >> 8) & 0xff);
3918 buffer[4*i+1] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff);
3919 buffer[4*i+2] = (png_byte)((v >> 8) & 0xff);
3920 buffer[4*i+3] = (png_byte)(v & 0xff);
3921 ++v;
3922 ++i;
3923 }
3924
3925 return;
3926
3927 case 48:
3928 /* y is maximum 2047, giving 4x65536 pixels, make 'r' increase by 1 at
3929 * each pixel, g increase by 257 (0x101) and 'b' by 0x1111:
3930 */
3931 while (i<128)
3932 {
3933 png_uint_32 t = v++;
3934 buffer[6*i+0] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
3935 buffer[6*i+1] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3936 t *= 257;
3937 buffer[6*i+2] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
3938 buffer[6*i+3] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3939 t *= 17;
3940 buffer[6*i+4] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
3941 buffer[6*i+5] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3942 ++i;
3943 }
3944
3945 return;
3946
3947 case 64:
3948 /* As above in the 32 bit case. */
3949 while (i<128)
3950 {
3951 png_uint_32 t = v++;
3952 buffer[8*i+0] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
3953 buffer[8*i+1] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3954 buffer[8*i+4] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
3955 buffer[8*i+5] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3956 t *= 257;
3957 buffer[8*i+2] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
3958 buffer[8*i+3] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3959 buffer[8*i+6] = (png_byte)((t >> 8) & 0xff);
3960 buffer[8*i+7] = (png_byte)(t & 0xff);
3961 ++i;
3962 }
3963 return;
3964
3965 default:
3966 break;
3967 }
3968
3969 png_error(pp, "internal error");
3970 }
3971
3972 /* This is just to do the right cast - could be changed to a function to check
3973 * 'bd' but there isn't much point.
3974 */
3975 #define DEPTH(bd) ((png_byte)(1U << (bd)))
3976
3977 /* This is just a helper for compiling on minimal systems with no write
3978 * interlacing support. If there is no write interlacing we can't generate test
3979 * cases with interlace:
3980 */
3981 #ifdef PNG_WRITE_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
3982 # define INTERLACE_LAST PNG_INTERLACE_LAST
3983 # define check_interlace_type(type) ((void)(type))
3984 # define set_write_interlace_handling(pp,type) png_set_interlace_handling(pp)
3985 # define do_own_interlace 0
3986 #elif PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
3987 # define set_write_interlace_handling(pp,type) (1)
3988 static void
check_interlace_type(int const interlace_type)3989 check_interlace_type(int const interlace_type)
3990 {
3991 /* Prior to 1.7.0 libpng does not support the write of an interlaced image
3992 * unless PNG_WRITE_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED, even with do_interlace so the
3993 * code here does the pixel interlace itself, so:
3994 */
3995 if (interlace_type != PNG_INTERLACE_NONE)
3996 {
3997 /* This is an internal error - --interlace tests should be skipped, not
3998 * attempted.
3999 */
4000 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: no interlace support\n");
4001 exit(99);
4002 }
4003 }
4004 # define INTERLACE_LAST (PNG_INTERLACE_NONE+1)
4005 # define do_own_interlace 0
4006 #else /* libpng 1.7+ */
4007 # define set_write_interlace_handling(pp,type)\
4008 npasses_from_interlace_type(pp,type)
4009 # define check_interlace_type(type) ((void)(type))
4010 # define INTERLACE_LAST PNG_INTERLACE_LAST
4011 # define do_own_interlace 1
4012 #endif /* WRITE_INTERLACING tests */
4013
4014 #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10700 || defined PNG_WRITE_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
4015 # define CAN_WRITE_INTERLACE 1
4016 #else
4017 # define CAN_WRITE_INTERLACE 0
4018 #endif
4019
4020 /* Do the same thing for read interlacing; this controls whether read tests do
4021 * their own de-interlace or use libpng.
4022 */
4023 #ifdef PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
4024 # define do_read_interlace 0
4025 #else /* no libpng read interlace support */
4026 # define do_read_interlace 1
4027 #endif
4028 /* The following two routines use the PNG interlace support macros from
4029 * png.h to interlace or deinterlace rows.
4030 */
4031 static void
interlace_row(png_bytep buffer,png_const_bytep imageRow,unsigned int pixel_size,png_uint_32 w,int pass,int littleendian)4032 interlace_row(png_bytep buffer, png_const_bytep imageRow,
4033 unsigned int pixel_size, png_uint_32 w, int pass, int littleendian)
4034 {
4035 png_uint_32 xin, xout, xstep;
4036
4037 /* Note that this can, trivially, be optimized to a memcpy on pass 7, the
4038 * code is presented this way to make it easier to understand. In practice
4039 * consult the code in the libpng source to see other ways of doing this.
4040 *
4041 * It is OK for buffer and imageRow to be identical, because 'xin' moves
4042 * faster than 'xout' and we copy up.
4043 */
4044 xin = PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass);
4045 xstep = 1U<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass);
4046
4047 for (xout=0; xin<w; xin+=xstep)
4048 {
4049 pixel_copy(buffer, xout, imageRow, xin, pixel_size, littleendian);
4050 ++xout;
4051 }
4052 }
4053
4054 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
4055 static void
deinterlace_row(png_bytep buffer,png_const_bytep row,unsigned int pixel_size,png_uint_32 w,int pass,int littleendian)4056 deinterlace_row(png_bytep buffer, png_const_bytep row,
4057 unsigned int pixel_size, png_uint_32 w, int pass, int littleendian)
4058 {
4059 /* The inverse of the above, 'row' is part of row 'y' of the output image,
4060 * in 'buffer'. The image is 'w' wide and this is pass 'pass', distribute
4061 * the pixels of row into buffer and return the number written (to allow
4062 * this to be checked).
4063 */
4064 png_uint_32 xin, xout, xstep;
4065
4066 xout = PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass);
4067 xstep = 1U<<PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass);
4068
4069 for (xin=0; xout<w; xout+=xstep)
4070 {
4071 pixel_copy(buffer, xout, row, xin, pixel_size, littleendian);
4072 ++xin;
4073 }
4074 }
4075 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
4076
4077 /* Make a standardized image given an image colour type, bit depth and
4078 * interlace type. The standard images have a very restricted range of
4079 * rows and heights and are used for testing transforms rather than image
4080 * layout details. See make_size_images below for a way to make images
4081 * that test odd sizes along with the libpng interlace handling.
4082 */
4083 #ifdef PNG_WRITE_FILTER_SUPPORTED
4084 static void
choose_random_filter(png_structp pp,int start)4085 choose_random_filter(png_structp pp, int start)
4086 {
4087 /* Choose filters randomly except that on the very first row ensure that
4088 * there is at least one previous row filter.
4089 */
4090 int filters = PNG_ALL_FILTERS & random_mod(256U);
4091
4092 /* There may be no filters; skip the setting. */
4093 if (filters != 0)
4094 {
4095 if (start && filters < PNG_FILTER_UP)
4096 filters |= PNG_FILTER_UP;
4097
4098 png_set_filter(pp, 0/*method*/, filters);
4099 }
4100 }
4101 #else /* !WRITE_FILTER */
4102 # define choose_random_filter(pp, start) ((void)0)
4103 #endif /* !WRITE_FILTER */
4104
4105 static void
make_transform_image(png_store * const ps,png_byte const colour_type,png_byte const bit_depth,unsigned int palette_number,int interlace_type,png_const_charp name)4106 make_transform_image(png_store* const ps, png_byte const colour_type,
4107 png_byte const bit_depth, unsigned int palette_number,
4108 int interlace_type, png_const_charp name)
4109 {
4110 context(ps, fault);
4111
4112 check_interlace_type(interlace_type);
4113
4114 Try
4115 {
4116 png_infop pi;
4117 png_structp pp = set_store_for_write(ps, &pi, name);
4118 png_uint_32 h, w;
4119
4120 /* In the event of a problem return control to the Catch statement below
4121 * to do the clean up - it is not possible to 'return' directly from a Try
4122 * block.
4123 */
4124 if (pp == NULL)
4125 Throw ps;
4126
4127 w = transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth);
4128 h = transform_height(pp, colour_type, bit_depth);
4129
4130 png_set_IHDR(pp, pi, w, h, bit_depth, colour_type, interlace_type,
4131 PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE, PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE);
4132
4133 #ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
4134 # if defined(PNG_READ_zTXt_SUPPORTED) && defined(PNG_WRITE_zTXt_SUPPORTED)
4135 # define TEXT_COMPRESSION PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_zTXt
4136 # else
4137 # define TEXT_COMPRESSION PNG_TEXT_COMPRESSION_NONE
4138 # endif
4139 {
4140 static char key[] = "image name"; /* must be writeable */
4141 size_t pos;
4142 png_text text;
4143 char copy[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
4144
4145 /* Use a compressed text string to test the correct interaction of text
4146 * compression and IDAT compression.
4147 */
4148 text.compression = TEXT_COMPRESSION;
4149 text.key = key;
4150 /* Yuck: the text must be writable! */
4151 pos = safecat(copy, sizeof copy, 0, ps->wname);
4152 text.text = copy;
4153 text.text_length = pos;
4154 text.itxt_length = 0;
4155 text.lang = 0;
4156 text.lang_key = 0;
4157
4158 png_set_text(pp, pi, &text, 1);
4159 }
4160 #endif
4161
4162 if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
4163 init_standard_palette(ps, pp, pi, 1U << bit_depth, 1/*do tRNS*/);
4164
4165 # ifdef PNG_WRITE_tRNS_SUPPORTED
4166 else if (palette_number)
4167 set_random_tRNS(pp, pi, colour_type, bit_depth);
4168 # endif
4169
4170 png_write_info(pp, pi);
4171
4172 if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) !=
4173 transform_rowsize(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
4174 png_error(pp, "transform row size incorrect");
4175
4176 else
4177 {
4178 /* Somewhat confusingly this must be called *after* png_write_info
4179 * because if it is called before, the information in *pp has not been
4180 * updated to reflect the interlaced image.
4181 */
4182 int npasses = set_write_interlace_handling(pp, interlace_type);
4183 int pass;
4184
4185 if (npasses != npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, interlace_type))
4186 png_error(pp, "write: png_set_interlace_handling failed");
4187
4188 for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
4189 {
4190 png_uint_32 y;
4191
4192 /* do_own_interlace is a pre-defined boolean (a #define) which is
4193 * set if we have to work out the interlaced rows here.
4194 */
4195 for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
4196 {
4197 png_byte buffer[TRANSFORM_ROWMAX];
4198
4199 transform_row(pp, buffer, colour_type, bit_depth, y);
4200
4201 # if do_own_interlace
4202 /* If do_own_interlace *and* the image is interlaced we need a
4203 * reduced interlace row; this may be reduced to empty.
4204 */
4205 if (interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7)
4206 {
4207 /* The row must not be written if it doesn't exist, notice
4208 * that there are two conditions here, either the row isn't
4209 * ever in the pass or the row would be but isn't wide
4210 * enough to contribute any pixels. In fact the wPass test
4211 * can be used to skip the whole y loop in this case.
4212 */
4213 if (PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass) &&
4214 PNG_PASS_COLS(w, pass) > 0)
4215 interlace_row(buffer, buffer,
4216 bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth), w, pass,
4217 0/*data always bigendian*/);
4218 else
4219 continue;
4220 }
4221 # endif /* do_own_interlace */
4222
4223 choose_random_filter(pp, pass == 0 && y == 0);
4224 png_write_row(pp, buffer);
4225 }
4226 }
4227 }
4228
4229 #ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
4230 {
4231 static char key[] = "end marker";
4232 static char comment[] = "end";
4233 png_text text;
4234
4235 /* Use a compressed text string to test the correct interaction of text
4236 * compression and IDAT compression.
4237 */
4238 text.compression = TEXT_COMPRESSION;
4239 text.key = key;
4240 text.text = comment;
4241 text.text_length = (sizeof comment)-1;
4242 text.itxt_length = 0;
4243 text.lang = 0;
4244 text.lang_key = 0;
4245
4246 png_set_text(pp, pi, &text, 1);
4247 }
4248 #endif
4249
4250 png_write_end(pp, pi);
4251
4252 /* And store this under the appropriate id, then clean up. */
4253 store_storefile(ps, FILEID(colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
4254 interlace_type, 0, 0, 0));
4255
4256 store_write_reset(ps);
4257 }
4258
4259 Catch(fault)
4260 {
4261 /* Use the png_store returned by the exception. This may help the compiler
4262 * because 'ps' is not used in this branch of the setjmp. Note that fault
4263 * and ps will always be the same value.
4264 */
4265 store_write_reset(fault);
4266 }
4267 }
4268
4269 static void
make_transform_images(png_modifier * pm)4270 make_transform_images(png_modifier *pm)
4271 {
4272 png_byte colour_type = 0;
4273 png_byte bit_depth = 0;
4274 unsigned int palette_number = 0;
4275
4276 /* This is in case of errors. */
4277 safecat(pm->this.test, sizeof pm->this.test, 0, "make standard images");
4278
4279 /* Use next_format to enumerate all the combinations we test, including
4280 * generating multiple low bit depth palette images. Non-A images (palette
4281 * and direct) are created with and without tRNS chunks.
4282 */
4283 while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number, 1, 1))
4284 {
4285 int interlace_type;
4286
4287 for (interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
4288 interlace_type < INTERLACE_LAST; ++interlace_type)
4289 {
4290 char name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
4291
4292 standard_name(name, sizeof name, 0, colour_type, bit_depth,
4293 palette_number, interlace_type, 0, 0, do_own_interlace);
4294 make_transform_image(&pm->this, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
4295 interlace_type, name);
4296 }
4297 }
4298 }
4299
4300 /* Build a single row for the 'size' test images; this fills in only the
4301 * first bit_width bits of the sample row.
4302 */
4303 static void
size_row(png_byte buffer[SIZE_ROWMAX],png_uint_32 bit_width,png_uint_32 y)4304 size_row(png_byte buffer[SIZE_ROWMAX], png_uint_32 bit_width, png_uint_32 y)
4305 {
4306 /* height is in the range 1 to 16, so: */
4307 y = ((y & 1) << 7) + ((y & 2) << 6) + ((y & 4) << 5) + ((y & 8) << 4);
4308 /* the following ensures bits are set in small images: */
4309 y ^= 0xA5;
4310
4311 while (bit_width >= 8)
4312 *buffer++ = (png_byte)y++, bit_width -= 8;
4313
4314 /* There may be up to 7 remaining bits, these go in the most significant
4315 * bits of the byte.
4316 */
4317 if (bit_width > 0)
4318 {
4319 png_uint_32 mask = (1U<<(8-bit_width))-1;
4320 *buffer = (png_byte)((*buffer & mask) | (y & ~mask));
4321 }
4322 }
4323
4324 static void
make_size_image(png_store * const ps,png_byte const colour_type,png_byte const bit_depth,int const interlace_type,png_uint_32 const w,png_uint_32 const h,int const do_interlace)4325 make_size_image(png_store* const ps, png_byte const colour_type,
4326 png_byte const bit_depth, int const interlace_type,
4327 png_uint_32 const w, png_uint_32 const h,
4328 int const do_interlace)
4329 {
4330 context(ps, fault);
4331
4332 check_interlace_type(interlace_type);
4333
4334 Try
4335 {
4336 png_infop pi;
4337 png_structp pp;
4338 unsigned int pixel_size;
4339
4340 /* Make a name and get an appropriate id for the store: */
4341 char name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
4342 png_uint_32 id = FILEID(colour_type, bit_depth, 0/*palette*/,
4343 interlace_type, w, h, do_interlace);
4344
4345 standard_name_from_id(name, sizeof name, 0, id);
4346 pp = set_store_for_write(ps, &pi, name);
4347
4348 /* In the event of a problem return control to the Catch statement below
4349 * to do the clean up - it is not possible to 'return' directly from a Try
4350 * block.
4351 */
4352 if (pp == NULL)
4353 Throw ps;
4354
4355 png_set_IHDR(pp, pi, w, h, bit_depth, colour_type, interlace_type,
4356 PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE, PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE);
4357
4358 #ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
4359 {
4360 static char key[] = "image name"; /* must be writeable */
4361 size_t pos;
4362 png_text text;
4363 char copy[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
4364
4365 /* Use a compressed text string to test the correct interaction of text
4366 * compression and IDAT compression.
4367 */
4368 text.compression = TEXT_COMPRESSION;
4369 text.key = key;
4370 /* Yuck: the text must be writable! */
4371 pos = safecat(copy, sizeof copy, 0, ps->wname);
4372 text.text = copy;
4373 text.text_length = pos;
4374 text.itxt_length = 0;
4375 text.lang = 0;
4376 text.lang_key = 0;
4377
4378 png_set_text(pp, pi, &text, 1);
4379 }
4380 #endif
4381
4382 if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
4383 init_standard_palette(ps, pp, pi, 1U << bit_depth, 0/*do tRNS*/);
4384
4385 png_write_info(pp, pi);
4386
4387 /* Calculate the bit size, divide by 8 to get the byte size - this won't
4388 * overflow because we know the w values are all small enough even for
4389 * a system where 'unsigned int' is only 16 bits.
4390 */
4391 pixel_size = bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth);
4392 if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) != ((w * pixel_size) + 7) / 8)
4393 png_error(pp, "size row size incorrect");
4394
4395 else
4396 {
4397 int npasses = npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, interlace_type);
4398 png_uint_32 y;
4399 int pass;
4400 png_byte image[16][SIZE_ROWMAX];
4401
4402 /* To help consistent error detection make the parts of this buffer
4403 * that aren't set below all '1':
4404 */
4405 memset(image, 0xff, sizeof image);
4406
4407 if (!do_interlace &&
4408 npasses != set_write_interlace_handling(pp, interlace_type))
4409 png_error(pp, "write: png_set_interlace_handling failed");
4410
4411 /* Prepare the whole image first to avoid making it 7 times: */
4412 for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
4413 size_row(image[y], w * pixel_size, y);
4414
4415 for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
4416 {
4417 /* The following two are for checking the macros: */
4418 png_uint_32 wPass = PNG_PASS_COLS(w, pass);
4419
4420 /* If do_interlace is set we don't call png_write_row for every
4421 * row because some of them are empty. In fact, for a 1x1 image,
4422 * most of them are empty!
4423 */
4424 for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
4425 {
4426 png_const_bytep row = image[y];
4427 png_byte tempRow[SIZE_ROWMAX];
4428
4429 /* If do_interlace *and* the image is interlaced we
4430 * need a reduced interlace row; this may be reduced
4431 * to empty.
4432 */
4433 if (do_interlace && interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7)
4434 {
4435 /* The row must not be written if it doesn't exist, notice
4436 * that there are two conditions here, either the row isn't
4437 * ever in the pass or the row would be but isn't wide
4438 * enough to contribute any pixels. In fact the wPass test
4439 * can be used to skip the whole y loop in this case.
4440 */
4441 if (PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass) && wPass > 0)
4442 {
4443 /* Set to all 1's for error detection (libpng tends to
4444 * set unset things to 0).
4445 */
4446 memset(tempRow, 0xff, sizeof tempRow);
4447 interlace_row(tempRow, row, pixel_size, w, pass,
4448 0/*data always bigendian*/);
4449 row = tempRow;
4450 }
4451 else
4452 continue;
4453 }
4454
4455 # ifdef PNG_WRITE_FILTER_SUPPORTED
4456 /* Only get to here if the row has some pixels in it, set the
4457 * filters to 'all' for the very first row and thereafter to a
4458 * single filter. It isn't well documented, but png_set_filter
4459 * does accept a filter number (per the spec) as well as a bit
4460 * mask.
4461 *
4462 * The code now uses filters at random, except that on the first
4463 * row of an image it ensures that a previous row filter is in
4464 * the set so that libpng allocates the row buffer.
4465 */
4466 {
4467 int filters = 8 << random_mod(PNG_FILTER_VALUE_LAST);
4468
4469 if (pass == 0 && y == 0 &&
4470 (filters < PNG_FILTER_UP || w == 1U))
4471 filters |= PNG_FILTER_UP;
4472
4473 png_set_filter(pp, 0/*method*/, filters);
4474 }
4475 # endif
4476
4477 png_write_row(pp, row);
4478 }
4479 }
4480 }
4481
4482 #ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
4483 {
4484 static char key[] = "end marker";
4485 static char comment[] = "end";
4486 png_text text;
4487
4488 /* Use a compressed text string to test the correct interaction of text
4489 * compression and IDAT compression.
4490 */
4491 text.compression = TEXT_COMPRESSION;
4492 text.key = key;
4493 text.text = comment;
4494 text.text_length = (sizeof comment)-1;
4495 text.itxt_length = 0;
4496 text.lang = 0;
4497 text.lang_key = 0;
4498
4499 png_set_text(pp, pi, &text, 1);
4500 }
4501 #endif
4502
4503 png_write_end(pp, pi);
4504
4505 /* And store this under the appropriate id, then clean up. */
4506 store_storefile(ps, id);
4507
4508 store_write_reset(ps);
4509 }
4510
4511 Catch(fault)
4512 {
4513 /* Use the png_store returned by the exception. This may help the compiler
4514 * because 'ps' is not used in this branch of the setjmp. Note that fault
4515 * and ps will always be the same value.
4516 */
4517 store_write_reset(fault);
4518 }
4519 }
4520
4521 static void
make_size(png_store * const ps,png_byte const colour_type,int bdlo,int const bdhi)4522 make_size(png_store* const ps, png_byte const colour_type, int bdlo,
4523 int const bdhi)
4524 {
4525 for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
4526 {
4527 png_uint_32 width;
4528
4529 for (width = 1; width <= 16; ++width)
4530 {
4531 png_uint_32 height;
4532
4533 for (height = 1; height <= 16; ++height)
4534 {
4535 /* The four combinations of DIY interlace and interlace or not -
4536 * no interlace + DIY should be identical to no interlace with
4537 * libpng doing it.
4538 */
4539 make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_NONE,
4540 width, height, 0);
4541 make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_NONE,
4542 width, height, 1);
4543 # ifdef PNG_WRITE_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
4544 make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7,
4545 width, height, 0);
4546 # endif
4547 # if CAN_WRITE_INTERLACE
4548 /* 1.7.0 removes the hack that prevented app write of an interlaced
4549 * image if WRITE_INTERLACE was not supported
4550 */
4551 make_size_image(ps, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7,
4552 width, height, 1);
4553 # endif
4554 }
4555 }
4556 }
4557 }
4558
4559 static void
make_size_images(png_store * ps)4560 make_size_images(png_store *ps)
4561 {
4562 /* This is in case of errors. */
4563 safecat(ps->test, sizeof ps->test, 0, "make size images");
4564
4565 /* Arguments are colour_type, low bit depth, high bit depth
4566 */
4567 make_size(ps, 0, 0, WRITE_BDHI);
4568 make_size(ps, 2, 3, WRITE_BDHI);
4569 make_size(ps, 3, 0, 3 /*palette: max 8 bits*/);
4570 make_size(ps, 4, 3, WRITE_BDHI);
4571 make_size(ps, 6, 3, WRITE_BDHI);
4572 }
4573
4574 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
4575 /* Return a row based on image id and 'y' for checking: */
4576 static void
standard_row(png_const_structp pp,png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX],png_uint_32 id,png_uint_32 y)4577 standard_row(png_const_structp pp, png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX],
4578 png_uint_32 id, png_uint_32 y)
4579 {
4580 if (WIDTH_FROM_ID(id) == 0)
4581 transform_row(pp, std, COL_FROM_ID(id), DEPTH_FROM_ID(id), y);
4582 else
4583 size_row(std, WIDTH_FROM_ID(id) * bit_size(pp, COL_FROM_ID(id),
4584 DEPTH_FROM_ID(id)), y);
4585 }
4586 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
4587
4588 /* Tests - individual test cases */
4589 /* Like 'make_standard' but errors are deliberately introduced into the calls
4590 * to ensure that they get detected - it should not be possible to write an
4591 * invalid image with libpng!
4592 */
4593 /* TODO: the 'set' functions can probably all be made to take a
4594 * png_const_structp rather than a modifiable one.
4595 */
4596 #ifdef PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED
4597 static void
sBIT0_error_fn(png_structp pp,png_infop pi)4598 sBIT0_error_fn(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
4599 {
4600 /* 0 is invalid... */
4601 png_color_8 bad;
4602 bad.red = bad.green = bad.blue = bad.gray = bad.alpha = 0;
4603 png_set_sBIT(pp, pi, &bad);
4604 }
4605
4606 static void
sBIT_error_fn(png_structp pp,png_infop pi)4607 sBIT_error_fn(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
4608 {
4609 png_byte bit_depth;
4610 png_color_8 bad;
4611
4612 if (png_get_color_type(pp, pi) == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
4613 bit_depth = 8;
4614
4615 else
4616 bit_depth = png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi);
4617
4618 /* Now we know the bit depth we can easily generate an invalid sBIT entry */
4619 bad.red = bad.green = bad.blue = bad.gray = bad.alpha =
4620 (png_byte)(bit_depth+1);
4621 png_set_sBIT(pp, pi, &bad);
4622 }
4623
4624 static const struct
4625 {
4626 void (*fn)(png_structp, png_infop);
4627 const char *msg;
4628 unsigned int warning :1; /* the error is a warning... */
4629 } error_test[] =
4630 {
4631 /* no warnings makes these errors undetectable prior to 1.7.0 */
4632 { sBIT0_error_fn, "sBIT(0): failed to detect error",
4633 PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700 },
4634
4635 { sBIT_error_fn, "sBIT(too big): failed to detect error",
4636 PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700 },
4637 };
4638
4639 static void
make_error(png_store * const ps,png_byte const colour_type,png_byte bit_depth,int interlace_type,int test,png_const_charp name)4640 make_error(png_store* const ps, png_byte const colour_type,
4641 png_byte bit_depth, int interlace_type, int test, png_const_charp name)
4642 {
4643 context(ps, fault);
4644
4645 check_interlace_type(interlace_type);
4646
4647 Try
4648 {
4649 png_infop pi;
4650 png_structp pp = set_store_for_write(ps, &pi, name);
4651 png_uint_32 w, h;
4652 gnu_volatile(pp)
4653
4654 if (pp == NULL)
4655 Throw ps;
4656
4657 w = transform_width(pp, colour_type, bit_depth);
4658 gnu_volatile(w)
4659 h = transform_height(pp, colour_type, bit_depth);
4660 gnu_volatile(h)
4661 png_set_IHDR(pp, pi, w, h, bit_depth, colour_type, interlace_type,
4662 PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE, PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE);
4663
4664 if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
4665 init_standard_palette(ps, pp, pi, 1U << bit_depth, 0/*do tRNS*/);
4666
4667 /* Time for a few errors; these are in various optional chunks, the
4668 * standard tests test the standard chunks pretty well.
4669 */
4670 # define exception__prev exception_prev_1
4671 # define exception__env exception_env_1
4672 Try
4673 {
4674 gnu_volatile(exception__prev)
4675
4676 /* Expect this to throw: */
4677 ps->expect_error = !error_test[test].warning;
4678 ps->expect_warning = error_test[test].warning;
4679 ps->saw_warning = 0;
4680 error_test[test].fn(pp, pi);
4681
4682 /* Normally the error is only detected here: */
4683 png_write_info(pp, pi);
4684
4685 /* And handle the case where it was only a warning: */
4686 if (ps->expect_warning && ps->saw_warning)
4687 Throw ps;
4688
4689 /* If we get here there is a problem, we have success - no error or
4690 * no warning - when we shouldn't have success. Log an error.
4691 */
4692 store_log(ps, pp, error_test[test].msg, 1 /*error*/);
4693 }
4694
4695 Catch (fault)
4696 { /* expected exit */
4697 }
4698 #undef exception__prev
4699 #undef exception__env
4700
4701 /* And clear these flags */
4702 ps->expect_warning = 0;
4703
4704 if (ps->expect_error)
4705 ps->expect_error = 0;
4706
4707 else
4708 {
4709 /* Now write the whole image, just to make sure that the detected, or
4710 * undetected, error has not created problems inside libpng. This
4711 * doesn't work if there was a png_error in png_write_info because that
4712 * can abort before PLTE was written.
4713 */
4714 if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) !=
4715 transform_rowsize(pp, colour_type, bit_depth))
4716 png_error(pp, "row size incorrect");
4717
4718 else
4719 {
4720 int npasses = set_write_interlace_handling(pp, interlace_type);
4721 int pass;
4722
4723 if (npasses != npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, interlace_type))
4724 png_error(pp, "write: png_set_interlace_handling failed");
4725
4726 for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
4727 {
4728 png_uint_32 y;
4729
4730 for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
4731 {
4732 png_byte buffer[TRANSFORM_ROWMAX];
4733
4734 transform_row(pp, buffer, colour_type, bit_depth, y);
4735
4736 # if do_own_interlace
4737 /* If do_own_interlace *and* the image is interlaced we
4738 * need a reduced interlace row; this may be reduced to
4739 * empty.
4740 */
4741 if (interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7)
4742 {
4743 /* The row must not be written if it doesn't exist,
4744 * notice that there are two conditions here, either the
4745 * row isn't ever in the pass or the row would be but
4746 * isn't wide enough to contribute any pixels. In fact
4747 * the wPass test can be used to skip the whole y loop
4748 * in this case.
4749 */
4750 if (PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass) &&
4751 PNG_PASS_COLS(w, pass) > 0)
4752 interlace_row(buffer, buffer,
4753 bit_size(pp, colour_type, bit_depth), w, pass,
4754 0/*data always bigendian*/);
4755 else
4756 continue;
4757 }
4758 # endif /* do_own_interlace */
4759
4760 png_write_row(pp, buffer);
4761 }
4762 }
4763 } /* image writing */
4764
4765 png_write_end(pp, pi);
4766 }
4767
4768 /* The following deletes the file that was just written. */
4769 store_write_reset(ps);
4770 }
4771
4772 Catch(fault)
4773 {
4774 store_write_reset(fault);
4775 }
4776 }
4777
4778 static int
make_errors(png_modifier * const pm,png_byte const colour_type,int bdlo,int const bdhi)4779 make_errors(png_modifier* const pm, png_byte const colour_type,
4780 int bdlo, int const bdhi)
4781 {
4782 for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
4783 {
4784 int interlace_type;
4785
4786 for (interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
4787 interlace_type < INTERLACE_LAST; ++interlace_type)
4788 {
4789 unsigned int test;
4790 char name[FILE_NAME_SIZE];
4791
4792 standard_name(name, sizeof name, 0, colour_type, 1<<bdlo, 0,
4793 interlace_type, 0, 0, do_own_interlace);
4794
4795 for (test=0; test<ARRAY_SIZE(error_test); ++test)
4796 {
4797 make_error(&pm->this, colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo), interlace_type,
4798 test, name);
4799
4800 if (fail(pm))
4801 return 0;
4802 }
4803 }
4804 }
4805
4806 return 1; /* keep going */
4807 }
4808 #endif /* PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED */
4809
4810 static void
perform_error_test(png_modifier * pm)4811 perform_error_test(png_modifier *pm)
4812 {
4813 #ifdef PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED /* else there are no cases that work! */
4814 /* Need to do this here because we just write in this test. */
4815 safecat(pm->this.test, sizeof pm->this.test, 0, "error test");
4816
4817 if (!make_errors(pm, 0, 0, WRITE_BDHI))
4818 return;
4819
4820 if (!make_errors(pm, 2, 3, WRITE_BDHI))
4821 return;
4822
4823 if (!make_errors(pm, 3, 0, 3))
4824 return;
4825
4826 if (!make_errors(pm, 4, 3, WRITE_BDHI))
4827 return;
4828
4829 if (!make_errors(pm, 6, 3, WRITE_BDHI))
4830 return;
4831 #else
4832 UNUSED(pm)
4833 #endif
4834 }
4835
4836 /* This is just to validate the internal PNG formatting code - if this fails
4837 * then the warning messages the library outputs will probably be garbage.
4838 */
4839 static void
perform_formatting_test(png_store * ps)4840 perform_formatting_test(png_store *ps)
4841 {
4842 #ifdef PNG_TIME_RFC1123_SUPPORTED
4843 /* The handle into the formatting code is the RFC1123 support; this test does
4844 * nothing if that is compiled out.
4845 */
4846 context(ps, fault);
4847
4848 Try
4849 {
4850 png_const_charp correct = "29 Aug 2079 13:53:60 +0000";
4851 png_const_charp result;
4852 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10600
4853 char timestring[29];
4854 # endif
4855 png_structp pp;
4856 png_time pt;
4857
4858 pp = set_store_for_write(ps, NULL, "libpng formatting test");
4859
4860 if (pp == NULL)
4861 Throw ps;
4862
4863
4864 /* Arbitrary settings: */
4865 pt.year = 2079;
4866 pt.month = 8;
4867 pt.day = 29;
4868 pt.hour = 13;
4869 pt.minute = 53;
4870 pt.second = 60; /* a leap second */
4871
4872 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10600
4873 result = png_convert_to_rfc1123(pp, &pt);
4874 # else
4875 if (png_convert_to_rfc1123_buffer(timestring, &pt))
4876 result = timestring;
4877
4878 else
4879 result = NULL;
4880 # endif
4881
4882 if (result == NULL)
4883 png_error(pp, "png_convert_to_rfc1123 failed");
4884
4885 if (strcmp(result, correct) != 0)
4886 {
4887 size_t pos = 0;
4888 char msg[128];
4889
4890 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "png_convert_to_rfc1123(");
4891 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, correct);
4892 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ") returned: '");
4893 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, result);
4894 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "'");
4895
4896 png_error(pp, msg);
4897 }
4898
4899 store_write_reset(ps);
4900 }
4901
4902 Catch(fault)
4903 {
4904 store_write_reset(fault);
4905 }
4906 #else
4907 UNUSED(ps)
4908 #endif
4909 }
4910
4911 #ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
4912 /* Because we want to use the same code in both the progressive reader and the
4913 * sequential reader it is necessary to deal with the fact that the progressive
4914 * reader callbacks only have one parameter (png_get_progressive_ptr()), so this
4915 * must contain all the test parameters and all the local variables directly
4916 * accessible to the sequential reader implementation.
4917 *
4918 * The technique adopted is to reinvent part of what Dijkstra termed a
4919 * 'display'; an array of pointers to the stack frames of enclosing functions so
4920 * that a nested function definition can access the local (C auto) variables of
4921 * the functions that contain its definition. In fact C provides the first
4922 * pointer (the local variables - the stack frame pointer) and the last (the
4923 * global variables - the BCPL global vector typically implemented as global
4924 * addresses), this code requires one more pointer to make the display - the
4925 * local variables (and function call parameters) of the function that actually
4926 * invokes either the progressive or sequential reader.
4927 *
4928 * Perhaps confusingly this technique is confounded with classes - the
4929 * 'standard_display' defined here is sub-classed as the 'gamma_display' below.
4930 * A gamma_display is a standard_display, taking advantage of the ANSI-C
4931 * requirement that the pointer to the first member of a structure must be the
4932 * same as the pointer to the structure. This allows us to reuse standard_
4933 * functions in the gamma test code; something that could not be done with
4934 * nested functions!
4935 */
4936 typedef struct standard_display
4937 {
4938 png_store* ps; /* Test parameters (passed to the function) */
4939 png_byte colour_type;
4940 png_byte bit_depth;
4941 png_byte red_sBIT; /* Input data sBIT values. */
4942 png_byte green_sBIT;
4943 png_byte blue_sBIT;
4944 png_byte alpha_sBIT;
4945 png_byte interlace_type;
4946 png_byte filler; /* Output has a filler */
4947 png_uint_32 id; /* Calculated file ID */
4948 png_uint_32 w; /* Width of image */
4949 png_uint_32 h; /* Height of image */
4950 int npasses; /* Number of interlaced passes */
4951 png_uint_32 pixel_size; /* Width of one pixel in bits */
4952 png_uint_32 bit_width; /* Width of output row in bits */
4953 size_t cbRow; /* Bytes in a row of the output image */
4954 int do_interlace; /* Do interlacing internally */
4955 int littleendian; /* App (row) data is little endian */
4956 int is_transparent; /* Transparency information was present. */
4957 int has_tRNS; /* color type GRAY or RGB with a tRNS chunk. */
4958 int speed; /* Doing a speed test */
4959 int use_update_info;/* Call update_info, not start_image */
4960 struct
4961 {
4962 png_uint_16 red;
4963 png_uint_16 green;
4964 png_uint_16 blue;
4965 } transparent; /* The transparent color, if set. */
4966 int npalette; /* Number of entries in the palette. */
4967 store_palette
4968 palette;
4969 } standard_display;
4970
4971 static void
standard_display_init(standard_display * dp,png_store * ps,png_uint_32 id,int do_interlace,int use_update_info)4972 standard_display_init(standard_display *dp, png_store* ps, png_uint_32 id,
4973 int do_interlace, int use_update_info)
4974 {
4975 memset(dp, 0, sizeof *dp);
4976
4977 dp->ps = ps;
4978 dp->colour_type = COL_FROM_ID(id);
4979 dp->bit_depth = DEPTH_FROM_ID(id);
4980 if (dp->bit_depth < 1 || dp->bit_depth > 16)
4981 internal_error(ps, "internal: bad bit depth");
4982 if (dp->colour_type == 3)
4983 dp->red_sBIT = dp->blue_sBIT = dp->green_sBIT = dp->alpha_sBIT = 8;
4984 else
4985 dp->red_sBIT = dp->blue_sBIT = dp->green_sBIT = dp->alpha_sBIT =
4986 dp->bit_depth;
4987 dp->interlace_type = INTERLACE_FROM_ID(id);
4988 check_interlace_type(dp->interlace_type);
4989 dp->id = id;
4990 /* All the rest are filled in after the read_info: */
4991 dp->w = 0;
4992 dp->h = 0;
4993 dp->npasses = 0;
4994 dp->pixel_size = 0;
4995 dp->bit_width = 0;
4996 dp->cbRow = 0;
4997 dp->do_interlace = do_interlace;
4998 dp->littleendian = 0;
4999 dp->is_transparent = 0;
5000 dp->speed = ps->speed;
5001 dp->use_update_info = use_update_info;
5002 dp->npalette = 0;
5003 /* Preset the transparent color to black: */
5004 memset(&dp->transparent, 0, sizeof dp->transparent);
5005 /* Preset the palette to full intensity/opaque throughout: */
5006 memset(dp->palette, 0xff, sizeof dp->palette);
5007 }
5008
5009 /* Initialize the palette fields - this must be done later because the palette
5010 * comes from the particular png_store_file that is selected.
5011 */
5012 static void
standard_palette_init(standard_display * dp)5013 standard_palette_init(standard_display *dp)
5014 {
5015 store_palette_entry *palette = store_current_palette(dp->ps, &dp->npalette);
5016
5017 /* The remaining entries remain white/opaque. */
5018 if (dp->npalette > 0)
5019 {
5020 int i = dp->npalette;
5021 memcpy(dp->palette, palette, i * sizeof *palette);
5022
5023 /* Check for a non-opaque palette entry: */
5024 while (--i >= 0)
5025 if (palette[i].alpha < 255)
5026 break;
5027
5028 # ifdef __GNUC__
5029 /* GCC can't handle the more obviously optimizable version. */
5030 if (i >= 0)
5031 dp->is_transparent = 1;
5032 else
5033 dp->is_transparent = 0;
5034 # else
5035 dp->is_transparent = (i >= 0);
5036 # endif
5037 }
5038 }
5039
5040 /* Utility to read the palette from the PNG file and convert it into
5041 * store_palette format. This returns 1 if there is any transparency in the
5042 * palette (it does not check for a transparent colour in the non-palette case.)
5043 */
5044 static int
read_palette(store_palette palette,int * npalette,png_const_structp pp,png_infop pi)5045 read_palette(store_palette palette, int *npalette, png_const_structp pp,
5046 png_infop pi)
5047 {
5048 png_colorp pal;
5049 png_bytep trans_alpha;
5050 int num;
5051
5052 pal = 0;
5053 *npalette = -1;
5054
5055 if (png_get_PLTE(pp, pi, &pal, npalette) & PNG_INFO_PLTE)
5056 {
5057 int i = *npalette;
5058
5059 if (i <= 0 || i > 256)
5060 png_error(pp, "validate: invalid PLTE count");
5061
5062 while (--i >= 0)
5063 {
5064 palette[i].red = pal[i].red;
5065 palette[i].green = pal[i].green;
5066 palette[i].blue = pal[i].blue;
5067 }
5068
5069 /* Mark the remainder of the entries with a flag value (other than
5070 * white/opaque which is the flag value stored above.)
5071 */
5072 memset(palette + *npalette, 126, (256-*npalette) * sizeof *palette);
5073 }
5074
5075 else /* !png_get_PLTE */
5076 {
5077 if (*npalette != (-1))
5078 png_error(pp, "validate: invalid PLTE result");
5079 /* But there is no palette, so record this: */
5080 *npalette = 0;
5081 memset(palette, 113, sizeof (store_palette));
5082 }
5083
5084 trans_alpha = 0;
5085 num = 2; /* force error below */
5086 if ((png_get_tRNS(pp, pi, &trans_alpha, &num, 0) & PNG_INFO_tRNS) != 0 &&
5087 (trans_alpha != NULL || num != 1/*returns 1 for a transparent color*/) &&
5088 /* Oops, if a palette tRNS gets expanded png_read_update_info (at least so
5089 * far as 1.5.4) does not remove the trans_alpha pointer, only num_trans,
5090 * so in the above call we get a success, we get a pointer (who knows what
5091 * to) and we get num_trans == 0:
5092 */
5093 !(trans_alpha != NULL && num == 0)) /* TODO: fix this in libpng. */
5094 {
5095 int i;
5096
5097 /* Any of these are crash-worthy - given the implementation of
5098 * png_get_tRNS up to 1.5 an app won't crash if it just checks the
5099 * result above and fails to check that the variables it passed have
5100 * actually been filled in! Note that if the app were to pass the
5101 * last, png_color_16p, variable too it couldn't rely on this.
5102 */
5103 if (trans_alpha == NULL || num <= 0 || num > 256 || num > *npalette)
5104 png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_tRNS (palette) result");
5105
5106 for (i=0; i<num; ++i)
5107 palette[i].alpha = trans_alpha[i];
5108
5109 for (num=*npalette; i<num; ++i)
5110 palette[i].alpha = 255;
5111
5112 for (; i<256; ++i)
5113 palette[i].alpha = 33; /* flag value */
5114
5115 return 1; /* transparency */
5116 }
5117
5118 else
5119 {
5120 /* No palette transparency - just set the alpha channel to opaque. */
5121 int i;
5122
5123 for (i=0, num=*npalette; i<num; ++i)
5124 palette[i].alpha = 255;
5125
5126 for (; i<256; ++i)
5127 palette[i].alpha = 55; /* flag value */
5128
5129 return 0; /* no transparency */
5130 }
5131 }
5132
5133 /* Utility to validate the palette if it should not have changed (the
5134 * non-transform case).
5135 */
5136 static void
standard_palette_validate(standard_display * dp,png_const_structp pp,png_infop pi)5137 standard_palette_validate(standard_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
5138 png_infop pi)
5139 {
5140 int npalette;
5141 store_palette palette;
5142
5143 if (read_palette(palette, &npalette, pp, pi) != dp->is_transparent)
5144 png_error(pp, "validate: palette transparency changed");
5145
5146 if (npalette != dp->npalette)
5147 {
5148 size_t pos = 0;
5149 char msg[64];
5150
5151 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "validate: palette size changed: ");
5152 pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, dp->npalette);
5153 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " -> ");
5154 pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, npalette);
5155 png_error(pp, msg);
5156 }
5157
5158 {
5159 int i = npalette; /* npalette is aliased */
5160
5161 while (--i >= 0)
5162 if (palette[i].red != dp->palette[i].red ||
5163 palette[i].green != dp->palette[i].green ||
5164 palette[i].blue != dp->palette[i].blue ||
5165 palette[i].alpha != dp->palette[i].alpha)
5166 png_error(pp, "validate: PLTE or tRNS chunk changed");
5167 }
5168 }
5169
5170 /* By passing a 'standard_display' the progressive callbacks can be used
5171 * directly by the sequential code, the functions suffixed "_imp" are the
5172 * implementations, the functions without the suffix are the callbacks.
5173 *
5174 * The code for the info callback is split into two because this callback calls
5175 * png_read_update_info or png_start_read_image and what gets called depends on
5176 * whether the info needs updating (we want to test both calls in pngvalid.)
5177 */
5178 static void
standard_info_part1(standard_display * dp,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)5179 standard_info_part1(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
5180 {
5181 if (png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi) != dp->bit_depth)
5182 png_error(pp, "validate: bit depth changed");
5183
5184 if (png_get_color_type(pp, pi) != dp->colour_type)
5185 png_error(pp, "validate: color type changed");
5186
5187 if (png_get_filter_type(pp, pi) != PNG_FILTER_TYPE_BASE)
5188 png_error(pp, "validate: filter type changed");
5189
5190 if (png_get_interlace_type(pp, pi) != dp->interlace_type)
5191 png_error(pp, "validate: interlacing changed");
5192
5193 if (png_get_compression_type(pp, pi) != PNG_COMPRESSION_TYPE_BASE)
5194 png_error(pp, "validate: compression type changed");
5195
5196 dp->w = png_get_image_width(pp, pi);
5197
5198 if (dp->w != standard_width(pp, dp->id))
5199 png_error(pp, "validate: image width changed");
5200
5201 dp->h = png_get_image_height(pp, pi);
5202
5203 if (dp->h != standard_height(pp, dp->id))
5204 png_error(pp, "validate: image height changed");
5205
5206 /* Record (but don't check at present) the input sBIT according to the colour
5207 * type information.
5208 */
5209 {
5210 png_color_8p sBIT = 0;
5211
5212 if (png_get_sBIT(pp, pi, &sBIT) & PNG_INFO_sBIT)
5213 {
5214 int sBIT_invalid = 0;
5215
5216 if (sBIT == 0)
5217 png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_sBIT result");
5218
5219 if (dp->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
5220 {
5221 if (sBIT->red == 0 || sBIT->red > dp->bit_depth)
5222 sBIT_invalid = 1;
5223 else
5224 dp->red_sBIT = sBIT->red;
5225
5226 if (sBIT->green == 0 || sBIT->green > dp->bit_depth)
5227 sBIT_invalid = 1;
5228 else
5229 dp->green_sBIT = sBIT->green;
5230
5231 if (sBIT->blue == 0 || sBIT->blue > dp->bit_depth)
5232 sBIT_invalid = 1;
5233 else
5234 dp->blue_sBIT = sBIT->blue;
5235 }
5236
5237 else /* !COLOR */
5238 {
5239 if (sBIT->gray == 0 || sBIT->gray > dp->bit_depth)
5240 sBIT_invalid = 1;
5241 else
5242 dp->blue_sBIT = dp->green_sBIT = dp->red_sBIT = sBIT->gray;
5243 }
5244
5245 /* All 8 bits in tRNS for a palette image are significant - see the
5246 * spec.
5247 */
5248 if (dp->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA)
5249 {
5250 if (sBIT->alpha == 0 || sBIT->alpha > dp->bit_depth)
5251 sBIT_invalid = 1;
5252 else
5253 dp->alpha_sBIT = sBIT->alpha;
5254 }
5255
5256 if (sBIT_invalid)
5257 png_error(pp, "validate: sBIT value out of range");
5258 }
5259 }
5260
5261 /* Important: this is validating the value *before* any transforms have been
5262 * put in place. It doesn't matter for the standard tests, where there are
5263 * no transforms, but it does for other tests where rowbytes may change after
5264 * png_read_update_info.
5265 */
5266 if (png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi) != standard_rowsize(pp, dp->id))
5267 png_error(pp, "validate: row size changed");
5268
5269 /* Validate the colour type 3 palette (this can be present on other color
5270 * types.)
5271 */
5272 standard_palette_validate(dp, pp, pi);
5273
5274 /* In any case always check for a transparent color (notice that the
5275 * colour type 3 case must not give a successful return on the get_tRNS call
5276 * with these arguments!)
5277 */
5278 {
5279 png_color_16p trans_color = 0;
5280
5281 if (png_get_tRNS(pp, pi, 0, 0, &trans_color) & PNG_INFO_tRNS)
5282 {
5283 if (trans_color == 0)
5284 png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_tRNS (color) result");
5285
5286 switch (dp->colour_type)
5287 {
5288 case 0:
5289 dp->transparent.red = dp->transparent.green = dp->transparent.blue =
5290 trans_color->gray;
5291 dp->has_tRNS = 1;
5292 break;
5293
5294 case 2:
5295 dp->transparent.red = trans_color->red;
5296 dp->transparent.green = trans_color->green;
5297 dp->transparent.blue = trans_color->blue;
5298 dp->has_tRNS = 1;
5299 break;
5300
5301 case 3:
5302 /* Not expected because it should result in the array case
5303 * above.
5304 */
5305 png_error(pp, "validate: unexpected png_get_tRNS result");
5306 break;
5307
5308 default:
5309 png_error(pp, "validate: invalid tRNS chunk with alpha image");
5310 }
5311 }
5312 }
5313
5314 /* Read the number of passes - expected to match the value used when
5315 * creating the image (interlaced or not). This has the side effect of
5316 * turning on interlace handling (if do_interlace is not set.)
5317 */
5318 dp->npasses = npasses_from_interlace_type(pp, dp->interlace_type);
5319 if (!dp->do_interlace)
5320 {
5321 # ifdef PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
5322 if (dp->npasses != png_set_interlace_handling(pp))
5323 png_error(pp, "validate: file changed interlace type");
5324 # else /* !READ_INTERLACING */
5325 /* This should never happen: the relevant tests (!do_interlace) should
5326 * not be run.
5327 */
5328 if (dp->npasses > 1)
5329 png_error(pp, "validate: no libpng interlace support");
5330 # endif /* !READ_INTERLACING */
5331 }
5332
5333 /* Caller calls png_read_update_info or png_start_read_image now, then calls
5334 * part2.
5335 */
5336 }
5337
5338 /* This must be called *after* the png_read_update_info call to get the correct
5339 * 'rowbytes' value, otherwise png_get_rowbytes will refer to the untransformed
5340 * image.
5341 */
5342 static void
standard_info_part2(standard_display * dp,png_const_structp pp,png_const_infop pi,int nImages)5343 standard_info_part2(standard_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
5344 png_const_infop pi, int nImages)
5345 {
5346 /* Record cbRow now that it can be found. */
5347 {
5348 png_byte ct = png_get_color_type(pp, pi);
5349 png_byte bd = png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi);
5350
5351 if (bd >= 8 && (ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB || ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY) &&
5352 dp->filler)
5353 ct |= 4; /* handle filler as faked alpha channel */
5354
5355 dp->pixel_size = bit_size(pp, ct, bd);
5356 }
5357 dp->bit_width = png_get_image_width(pp, pi) * dp->pixel_size;
5358 dp->cbRow = png_get_rowbytes(pp, pi);
5359
5360 /* Validate the rowbytes here again. */
5361 if (dp->cbRow != (dp->bit_width+7)/8)
5362 png_error(pp, "bad png_get_rowbytes calculation");
5363
5364 /* Then ensure there is enough space for the output image(s). */
5365 store_ensure_image(dp->ps, pp, nImages, dp->cbRow, dp->h);
5366 }
5367
5368 static void
standard_info_imp(standard_display * dp,png_structp pp,png_infop pi,int nImages)5369 standard_info_imp(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi,
5370 int nImages)
5371 {
5372 /* Note that the validation routine has the side effect of turning on
5373 * interlace handling in the subsequent code.
5374 */
5375 standard_info_part1(dp, pp, pi);
5376
5377 /* And the info callback has to call this (or png_read_update_info - see
5378 * below in the png_modifier code for that variant.
5379 */
5380 if (dp->use_update_info)
5381 {
5382 /* For debugging the effect of multiple calls: */
5383 int i = dp->use_update_info;
5384 while (i-- > 0)
5385 png_read_update_info(pp, pi);
5386 }
5387
5388 else
5389 png_start_read_image(pp);
5390
5391 /* Validate the height, width and rowbytes plus ensure that sufficient buffer
5392 * exists for decoding the image.
5393 */
5394 standard_info_part2(dp, pp, pi, nImages);
5395 }
5396
5397 static void PNGCBAPI
standard_info(png_structp pp,png_infop pi)5398 standard_info(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
5399 {
5400 standard_display *dp = voidcast(standard_display*,
5401 png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
5402
5403 /* Call with nImages==1 because the progressive reader can only produce one
5404 * image.
5405 */
5406 standard_info_imp(dp, pp, pi, 1 /*only one image*/);
5407 }
5408
5409 static void PNGCBAPI
progressive_row(png_structp ppIn,png_bytep new_row,png_uint_32 y,int pass)5410 progressive_row(png_structp ppIn, png_bytep new_row, png_uint_32 y, int pass)
5411 {
5412 png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
5413 const standard_display *dp = voidcast(standard_display*,
5414 png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
5415
5416 /* When handling interlacing some rows will be absent in each pass, the
5417 * callback still gets called, but with a NULL pointer. This is checked
5418 * in the 'else' clause below. We need our own 'cbRow', but we can't call
5419 * png_get_rowbytes because we got no info structure.
5420 */
5421 if (new_row != NULL)
5422 {
5423 png_bytep row;
5424
5425 /* In the case where the reader doesn't do the interlace it gives
5426 * us the y in the sub-image:
5427 */
5428 if (dp->do_interlace && dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7)
5429 {
5430 #ifdef PNG_USER_TRANSFORM_INFO_SUPPORTED
5431 /* Use this opportunity to validate the png 'current' APIs: */
5432 if (y != png_get_current_row_number(pp))
5433 png_error(pp, "png_get_current_row_number is broken");
5434
5435 if (pass != png_get_current_pass_number(pp))
5436 png_error(pp, "png_get_current_pass_number is broken");
5437 #endif /* USER_TRANSFORM_INFO */
5438
5439 y = PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(y, pass);
5440 }
5441
5442 /* Validate this just in case. */
5443 if (y >= dp->h)
5444 png_error(pp, "invalid y to progressive row callback");
5445
5446 row = store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, 0, y);
5447
5448 /* Combine the new row into the old: */
5449 #ifdef PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
5450 if (dp->do_interlace)
5451 #endif /* READ_INTERLACING */
5452 {
5453 if (dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7)
5454 deinterlace_row(row, new_row, dp->pixel_size, dp->w, pass,
5455 dp->littleendian);
5456 else
5457 row_copy(row, new_row, dp->pixel_size * dp->w, dp->littleendian);
5458 }
5459 #ifdef PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
5460 else
5461 png_progressive_combine_row(pp, row, new_row);
5462 #endif /* PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED */
5463 }
5464
5465 else if (dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7 &&
5466 PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass) &&
5467 PNG_PASS_COLS(dp->w, pass) > 0)
5468 png_error(pp, "missing row in progressive de-interlacing");
5469 }
5470
5471 static void
sequential_row(standard_display * dp,png_structp pp,png_infop pi,int iImage,int iDisplay)5472 sequential_row(standard_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi,
5473 int iImage, int iDisplay)
5474 {
5475 int npasses = dp->npasses;
5476 int do_interlace = dp->do_interlace &&
5477 dp->interlace_type == PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7;
5478 png_uint_32 height = standard_height(pp, dp->id);
5479 png_uint_32 width = standard_width(pp, dp->id);
5480 const png_store* ps = dp->ps;
5481 int pass;
5482
5483 for (pass=0; pass<npasses; ++pass)
5484 {
5485 png_uint_32 y;
5486 png_uint_32 wPass = PNG_PASS_COLS(width, pass);
5487
5488 for (y=0; y<height; ++y)
5489 {
5490 if (do_interlace)
5491 {
5492 /* wPass may be zero or this row may not be in this pass.
5493 * png_read_row must not be called in either case.
5494 */
5495 if (wPass > 0 && PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass))
5496 {
5497 /* Read the row into a pair of temporary buffers, then do the
5498 * merge here into the output rows.
5499 */
5500 png_byte row[STANDARD_ROWMAX], display[STANDARD_ROWMAX];
5501
5502 /* The following aids (to some extent) error detection - we can
5503 * see where png_read_row wrote. Use opposite values in row and
5504 * display to make this easier. Don't use 0xff (which is used in
5505 * the image write code to fill unused bits) or 0 (which is a
5506 * likely value to overwrite unused bits with).
5507 */
5508 memset(row, 0xc5, sizeof row);
5509 memset(display, 0x5c, sizeof display);
5510
5511 png_read_row(pp, row, display);
5512
5513 if (iImage >= 0)
5514 deinterlace_row(store_image_row(ps, pp, iImage, y), row,
5515 dp->pixel_size, dp->w, pass, dp->littleendian);
5516
5517 if (iDisplay >= 0)
5518 deinterlace_row(store_image_row(ps, pp, iDisplay, y), display,
5519 dp->pixel_size, dp->w, pass, dp->littleendian);
5520 }
5521 }
5522 else
5523 png_read_row(pp,
5524 iImage >= 0 ? store_image_row(ps, pp, iImage, y) : NULL,
5525 iDisplay >= 0 ? store_image_row(ps, pp, iDisplay, y) : NULL);
5526 }
5527 }
5528
5529 /* And finish the read operation (only really necessary if the caller wants
5530 * to find additional data in png_info from chunks after the last IDAT.)
5531 */
5532 png_read_end(pp, pi);
5533 }
5534
5535 #ifdef PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
5536 static void
standard_check_text(png_const_structp pp,png_const_textp tp,png_const_charp keyword,png_const_charp text)5537 standard_check_text(png_const_structp pp, png_const_textp tp,
5538 png_const_charp keyword, png_const_charp text)
5539 {
5540 char msg[1024];
5541 size_t pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, 0, "text: ");
5542 size_t ok;
5543
5544 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, keyword);
5545 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ": ");
5546 ok = pos;
5547
5548 if (tp->compression != TEXT_COMPRESSION)
5549 {
5550 char buf[64];
5551
5552 sprintf(buf, "compression [%d->%d], ", TEXT_COMPRESSION,
5553 tp->compression);
5554 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, buf);
5555 }
5556
5557 if (tp->key == NULL || strcmp(tp->key, keyword) != 0)
5558 {
5559 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "keyword \"");
5560 if (tp->key != NULL)
5561 {
5562 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, tp->key);
5563 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\", ");
5564 }
5565
5566 else
5567 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "null, ");
5568 }
5569
5570 if (tp->text == NULL)
5571 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "text lost, ");
5572
5573 else
5574 {
5575 if (tp->text_length != strlen(text))
5576 {
5577 char buf[64];
5578 sprintf(buf, "text length changed[%lu->%lu], ",
5579 (unsigned long)strlen(text), (unsigned long)tp->text_length);
5580 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, buf);
5581 }
5582
5583 if (strcmp(tp->text, text) != 0)
5584 {
5585 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "text becomes \"");
5586 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, tp->text);
5587 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\" (was \"");
5588 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, text);
5589 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\"), ");
5590 }
5591 }
5592
5593 if (tp->itxt_length != 0)
5594 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "iTXt length set, ");
5595
5596 if (tp->lang != NULL)
5597 {
5598 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "iTXt language \"");
5599 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, tp->lang);
5600 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\", ");
5601 }
5602
5603 if (tp->lang_key != NULL)
5604 {
5605 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "iTXt keyword \"");
5606 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, tp->lang_key);
5607 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\", ");
5608 }
5609
5610 if (pos > ok)
5611 {
5612 msg[pos-2] = '\0'; /* Remove the ", " at the end */
5613 png_error(pp, msg);
5614 }
5615 }
5616
5617 static void
standard_text_validate(standard_display * dp,png_const_structp pp,png_infop pi,int check_end)5618 standard_text_validate(standard_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
5619 png_infop pi, int check_end)
5620 {
5621 png_textp tp = NULL;
5622 png_uint_32 num_text = png_get_text(pp, pi, &tp, NULL);
5623
5624 if (num_text == 2 && tp != NULL)
5625 {
5626 standard_check_text(pp, tp, "image name", dp->ps->current->name);
5627
5628 /* This exists because prior to 1.5.18 the progressive reader left the
5629 * png_struct z_stream unreset at the end of the image, so subsequent
5630 * attempts to use it simply returns Z_STREAM_END.
5631 */
5632 if (check_end)
5633 standard_check_text(pp, tp+1, "end marker", "end");
5634 }
5635
5636 else
5637 {
5638 char msg[64];
5639
5640 sprintf(msg, "expected two text items, got %lu",
5641 (unsigned long)num_text);
5642 png_error(pp, msg);
5643 }
5644 }
5645 #else
5646 # define standard_text_validate(dp,pp,pi,check_end) ((void)0)
5647 #endif
5648
5649 static void
standard_row_validate(standard_display * dp,png_const_structp pp,int iImage,int iDisplay,png_uint_32 y)5650 standard_row_validate(standard_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
5651 int iImage, int iDisplay, png_uint_32 y)
5652 {
5653 int where;
5654 png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX];
5655
5656 /* The row must be pre-initialized to the magic number here for the size
5657 * tests to pass:
5658 */
5659 memset(std, 178, sizeof std);
5660 standard_row(pp, std, dp->id, y);
5661
5662 /* At the end both the 'row' and 'display' arrays should end up identical.
5663 * In earlier passes 'row' will be partially filled in, with only the pixels
5664 * that have been read so far, but 'display' will have those pixels
5665 * replicated to fill the unread pixels while reading an interlaced image.
5666 */
5667 if (iImage >= 0 &&
5668 (where = pixel_cmp(std, store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iImage, y),
5669 dp->bit_width)) != 0)
5670 {
5671 char msg[64];
5672 sprintf(msg, "PNG image row[%lu][%d] changed from %.2x to %.2x",
5673 (unsigned long)y, where-1, std[where-1],
5674 store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iImage, y)[where-1]);
5675 png_error(pp, msg);
5676 }
5677
5678 if (iDisplay >= 0 &&
5679 (where = pixel_cmp(std, store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iDisplay, y),
5680 dp->bit_width)) != 0)
5681 {
5682 char msg[64];
5683 sprintf(msg, "display row[%lu][%d] changed from %.2x to %.2x",
5684 (unsigned long)y, where-1, std[where-1],
5685 store_image_row(dp->ps, pp, iDisplay, y)[where-1]);
5686 png_error(pp, msg);
5687 }
5688 }
5689
5690 static void
standard_image_validate(standard_display * dp,png_const_structp pp,int iImage,int iDisplay)5691 standard_image_validate(standard_display *dp, png_const_structp pp, int iImage,
5692 int iDisplay)
5693 {
5694 png_uint_32 y;
5695
5696 if (iImage >= 0)
5697 store_image_check(dp->ps, pp, iImage);
5698
5699 if (iDisplay >= 0)
5700 store_image_check(dp->ps, pp, iDisplay);
5701
5702 for (y=0; y<dp->h; ++y)
5703 standard_row_validate(dp, pp, iImage, iDisplay, y);
5704
5705 /* This avoids false positives if the validation code is never called! */
5706 dp->ps->validated = 1;
5707 }
5708
5709 static void PNGCBAPI
standard_end(png_structp ppIn,png_infop pi)5710 standard_end(png_structp ppIn, png_infop pi)
5711 {
5712 png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
5713 standard_display *dp = voidcast(standard_display*,
5714 png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
5715
5716 UNUSED(pi)
5717
5718 /* Validate the image - progressive reading only produces one variant for
5719 * interlaced images.
5720 */
5721 standard_text_validate(dp, pp, pi,
5722 PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10518/*check_end: see comments above*/);
5723 standard_image_validate(dp, pp, 0, -1);
5724 }
5725
5726 /* A single test run checking the standard image to ensure it is not damaged. */
5727 static void
standard_test(png_store * const psIn,png_uint_32 const id,int do_interlace,int use_update_info)5728 standard_test(png_store* const psIn, png_uint_32 const id,
5729 int do_interlace, int use_update_info)
5730 {
5731 standard_display d;
5732 context(psIn, fault);
5733
5734 /* Set up the display (stack frame) variables from the arguments to the
5735 * function and initialize the locals that are filled in later.
5736 */
5737 standard_display_init(&d, psIn, id, do_interlace, use_update_info);
5738
5739 /* Everything is protected by a Try/Catch. The functions called also
5740 * typically have local Try/Catch blocks.
5741 */
5742 Try
5743 {
5744 png_structp pp;
5745 png_infop pi;
5746
5747 /* Get a png_struct for reading the image. This will throw an error if it
5748 * fails, so we don't need to check the result.
5749 */
5750 pp = set_store_for_read(d.ps, &pi, d.id,
5751 d.do_interlace ? (d.ps->progressive ?
5752 "pngvalid progressive deinterlacer" :
5753 "pngvalid sequential deinterlacer") : (d.ps->progressive ?
5754 "progressive reader" : "sequential reader"));
5755
5756 /* Initialize the palette correctly from the png_store_file. */
5757 standard_palette_init(&d);
5758
5759 /* Introduce the correct read function. */
5760 if (d.ps->progressive)
5761 {
5762 png_set_progressive_read_fn(pp, &d, standard_info, progressive_row,
5763 standard_end);
5764
5765 /* Now feed data into the reader until we reach the end: */
5766 store_progressive_read(d.ps, pp, pi);
5767 }
5768 else
5769 {
5770 /* Note that this takes the store, not the display. */
5771 png_set_read_fn(pp, d.ps, store_read);
5772
5773 /* Check the header values: */
5774 png_read_info(pp, pi);
5775
5776 /* The code tests both versions of the images that the sequential
5777 * reader can produce.
5778 */
5779 standard_info_imp(&d, pp, pi, 2 /*images*/);
5780
5781 /* Need the total bytes in the image below; we can't get to this point
5782 * unless the PNG file values have been checked against the expected
5783 * values.
5784 */
5785 {
5786 sequential_row(&d, pp, pi, 0, 1);
5787
5788 /* After the last pass loop over the rows again to check that the
5789 * image is correct.
5790 */
5791 if (!d.speed)
5792 {
5793 standard_text_validate(&d, pp, pi, 1/*check_end*/);
5794 standard_image_validate(&d, pp, 0, 1);
5795 }
5796 else
5797 d.ps->validated = 1;
5798 }
5799 }
5800
5801 /* Check for validation. */
5802 if (!d.ps->validated)
5803 png_error(pp, "image read failed silently");
5804
5805 /* Successful completion. */
5806 }
5807
5808 Catch(fault)
5809 d.ps = fault; /* make sure this hasn't been clobbered. */
5810
5811 /* In either case clean up the store. */
5812 store_read_reset(d.ps);
5813 }
5814
5815 static int
test_standard(png_modifier * const pm,png_byte const colour_type,int bdlo,int const bdhi)5816 test_standard(png_modifier* const pm, png_byte const colour_type,
5817 int bdlo, int const bdhi)
5818 {
5819 for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
5820 {
5821 int interlace_type;
5822
5823 for (interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_NONE;
5824 interlace_type < INTERLACE_LAST; ++interlace_type)
5825 {
5826 standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo),
5827 0/*palette*/, interlace_type, 0, 0, 0), do_read_interlace,
5828 pm->use_update_info);
5829
5830 if (fail(pm))
5831 return 0;
5832 }
5833 }
5834
5835 return 1; /* keep going */
5836 }
5837
5838 static void
perform_standard_test(png_modifier * pm)5839 perform_standard_test(png_modifier *pm)
5840 {
5841 /* Test each colour type over the valid range of bit depths (expressed as
5842 * log2(bit_depth) in turn, stop as soon as any error is detected.
5843 */
5844 if (!test_standard(pm, 0, 0, READ_BDHI))
5845 return;
5846
5847 if (!test_standard(pm, 2, 3, READ_BDHI))
5848 return;
5849
5850 if (!test_standard(pm, 3, 0, 3))
5851 return;
5852
5853 if (!test_standard(pm, 4, 3, READ_BDHI))
5854 return;
5855
5856 if (!test_standard(pm, 6, 3, READ_BDHI))
5857 return;
5858 }
5859
5860
5861 /********************************** SIZE TESTS ********************************/
5862 static int
test_size(png_modifier * const pm,png_byte const colour_type,int bdlo,int const bdhi)5863 test_size(png_modifier* const pm, png_byte const colour_type,
5864 int bdlo, int const bdhi)
5865 {
5866 /* Run the tests on each combination.
5867 *
5868 * NOTE: on my 32 bit x86 each of the following blocks takes
5869 * a total of 3.5 seconds if done across every combo of bit depth
5870 * width and height. This is a waste of time in practice, hence the
5871 * hinc and winc stuff:
5872 */
5873 static const png_byte hinc[] = {1, 3, 11, 1, 5};
5874 static const png_byte winc[] = {1, 9, 5, 7, 1};
5875 int save_bdlo = bdlo;
5876
5877 for (; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
5878 {
5879 png_uint_32 h, w;
5880
5881 for (h=1; h<=16; h+=hinc[bdlo])
5882 {
5883 for (w=1; w<=16; w+=winc[bdlo])
5884 {
5885 /* First test all the 'size' images against the sequential
5886 * reader using libpng to deinterlace (where required.) This
5887 * validates the write side of libpng. There are four possibilities
5888 * to validate.
5889 */
5890 standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo),
5891 0/*palette*/, PNG_INTERLACE_NONE, w, h, 0), 0/*do_interlace*/,
5892 pm->use_update_info);
5893
5894 if (fail(pm))
5895 return 0;
5896
5897 standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo),
5898 0/*palette*/, PNG_INTERLACE_NONE, w, h, 1), 0/*do_interlace*/,
5899 pm->use_update_info);
5900
5901 if (fail(pm))
5902 return 0;
5903
5904 /* Now validate the interlaced read side - do_interlace true,
5905 * in the progressive case this does actually make a difference
5906 * to the code used in the non-interlaced case too.
5907 */
5908 standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo),
5909 0/*palette*/, PNG_INTERLACE_NONE, w, h, 0), 1/*do_interlace*/,
5910 pm->use_update_info);
5911
5912 if (fail(pm))
5913 return 0;
5914
5915 # if CAN_WRITE_INTERLACE
5916 /* Validate the pngvalid code itself: */
5917 standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo),
5918 0/*palette*/, PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7, w, h, 1), 1/*do_interlace*/,
5919 pm->use_update_info);
5920
5921 if (fail(pm))
5922 return 0;
5923 # endif
5924 }
5925 }
5926 }
5927
5928 /* Now do the tests of libpng interlace handling, after we have made sure
5929 * that the pngvalid version works:
5930 */
5931 for (bdlo = save_bdlo; bdlo <= bdhi; ++bdlo)
5932 {
5933 png_uint_32 h, w;
5934
5935 for (h=1; h<=16; h+=hinc[bdlo])
5936 {
5937 for (w=1; w<=16; w+=winc[bdlo])
5938 {
5939 # ifdef PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
5940 /* Test with pngvalid generated interlaced images first; we have
5941 * already verify these are ok (unless pngvalid has self-consistent
5942 * read/write errors, which is unlikely), so this detects errors in
5943 * the read side first:
5944 */
5945 # if CAN_WRITE_INTERLACE
5946 standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo),
5947 0/*palette*/, PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7, w, h, 1), 0/*do_interlace*/,
5948 pm->use_update_info);
5949
5950 if (fail(pm))
5951 return 0;
5952 # endif
5953 # endif /* READ_INTERLACING */
5954
5955 # ifdef PNG_WRITE_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
5956 /* Test the libpng write side against the pngvalid read side: */
5957 standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo),
5958 0/*palette*/, PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7, w, h, 0), 1/*do_interlace*/,
5959 pm->use_update_info);
5960
5961 if (fail(pm))
5962 return 0;
5963 # endif
5964
5965 # ifdef PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
5966 # ifdef PNG_WRITE_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
5967 /* Test both together: */
5968 standard_test(&pm->this, FILEID(colour_type, DEPTH(bdlo),
5969 0/*palette*/, PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7, w, h, 0), 0/*do_interlace*/,
5970 pm->use_update_info);
5971
5972 if (fail(pm))
5973 return 0;
5974 # endif
5975 # endif /* READ_INTERLACING */
5976 }
5977 }
5978 }
5979
5980 return 1; /* keep going */
5981 }
5982
5983 static void
perform_size_test(png_modifier * pm)5984 perform_size_test(png_modifier *pm)
5985 {
5986 /* Test each colour type over the valid range of bit depths (expressed as
5987 * log2(bit_depth) in turn, stop as soon as any error is detected.
5988 */
5989 if (!test_size(pm, 0, 0, READ_BDHI))
5990 return;
5991
5992 if (!test_size(pm, 2, 3, READ_BDHI))
5993 return;
5994
5995 /* For the moment don't do the palette test - it's a waste of time when
5996 * compared to the grayscale test.
5997 */
5998 #if 0
5999 if (!test_size(pm, 3, 0, 3))
6000 return;
6001 #endif
6002
6003 if (!test_size(pm, 4, 3, READ_BDHI))
6004 return;
6005
6006 if (!test_size(pm, 6, 3, READ_BDHI))
6007 return;
6008 }
6009
6010
6011 /******************************* TRANSFORM TESTS ******************************/
6012 #ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
6013 /* A set of tests to validate libpng image transforms. The possibilities here
6014 * are legion because the transforms can be combined in a combinatorial
6015 * fashion. To deal with this some measure of restraint is required, otherwise
6016 * the tests would take forever.
6017 */
6018 typedef struct image_pixel
6019 {
6020 /* A local (pngvalid) representation of a PNG pixel, in all its
6021 * various forms.
6022 */
6023 unsigned int red, green, blue, alpha; /* For non-palette images. */
6024 unsigned int palette_index; /* For a palette image. */
6025 png_byte colour_type; /* As in the spec. */
6026 png_byte bit_depth; /* Defines bit size in row */
6027 png_byte sample_depth; /* Scale of samples */
6028 unsigned int have_tRNS :1; /* tRNS chunk may need processing */
6029 unsigned int swap_rgb :1; /* RGB swapped to BGR */
6030 unsigned int alpha_first :1; /* Alpha at start, not end */
6031 unsigned int alpha_inverted :1; /* Alpha channel inverted */
6032 unsigned int mono_inverted :1; /* Gray channel inverted */
6033 unsigned int swap16 :1; /* Byte swap 16-bit components */
6034 unsigned int littleendian :1; /* High bits on right */
6035 unsigned int sig_bits :1; /* Pixel shifted (sig bits only) */
6036
6037 /* For checking the code calculates double precision floating point values
6038 * along with an error value, accumulated from the transforms. Because an
6039 * sBIT setting allows larger error bounds (indeed, by the spec, apparently
6040 * up to just less than +/-1 in the scaled value) the *lowest* sBIT for each
6041 * channel is stored. This sBIT value is folded in to the stored error value
6042 * at the end of the application of the transforms to the pixel.
6043 *
6044 * If sig_bits is set above the red, green, blue and alpha values have been
6045 * scaled so they only contain the significant bits of the component values.
6046 */
6047 double redf, greenf, bluef, alphaf;
6048 double rede, greene, bluee, alphae;
6049 png_byte red_sBIT, green_sBIT, blue_sBIT, alpha_sBIT;
6050 } image_pixel;
6051
6052 /* Shared utility function, see below. */
6053 static void
image_pixel_setf(image_pixel * this,unsigned int rMax,unsigned int gMax,unsigned int bMax,unsigned int aMax)6054 image_pixel_setf(image_pixel *this, unsigned int rMax, unsigned int gMax,
6055 unsigned int bMax, unsigned int aMax)
6056 {
6057 this->redf = this->red / (double)rMax;
6058 this->greenf = this->green / (double)gMax;
6059 this->bluef = this->blue / (double)bMax;
6060 this->alphaf = this->alpha / (double)aMax;
6061
6062 if (this->red < rMax)
6063 this->rede = this->redf * DBL_EPSILON;
6064 else
6065 this->rede = 0;
6066 if (this->green < gMax)
6067 this->greene = this->greenf * DBL_EPSILON;
6068 else
6069 this->greene = 0;
6070 if (this->blue < bMax)
6071 this->bluee = this->bluef * DBL_EPSILON;
6072 else
6073 this->bluee = 0;
6074 if (this->alpha < aMax)
6075 this->alphae = this->alphaf * DBL_EPSILON;
6076 else
6077 this->alphae = 0;
6078 }
6079
6080 /* Initialize the structure for the next pixel - call this before doing any
6081 * transforms and call it for each pixel since all the fields may need to be
6082 * reset.
6083 */
6084 static void
image_pixel_init(image_pixel * this,png_const_bytep row,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth,png_uint_32 x,store_palette palette,const image_pixel * format)6085 image_pixel_init(image_pixel *this, png_const_bytep row, png_byte colour_type,
6086 png_byte bit_depth, png_uint_32 x, store_palette palette,
6087 const image_pixel *format /*from pngvalid transform of input*/)
6088 {
6089 png_byte sample_depth =
6090 (png_byte)(colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE ? 8 : bit_depth);
6091 unsigned int max = (1U<<sample_depth)-1;
6092 int swap16 = (format != 0 && format->swap16);
6093 int littleendian = (format != 0 && format->littleendian);
6094 int sig_bits = (format != 0 && format->sig_bits);
6095
6096 /* Initially just set everything to the same number and the alpha to opaque.
6097 * Note that this currently assumes a simple palette where entry x has colour
6098 * rgb(x,x,x)!
6099 */
6100 this->palette_index = this->red = this->green = this->blue =
6101 sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, 0, swap16, littleendian);
6102 this->alpha = max;
6103 this->red_sBIT = this->green_sBIT = this->blue_sBIT = this->alpha_sBIT =
6104 sample_depth;
6105
6106 /* Then override as appropriate: */
6107 if (colour_type == 3) /* palette */
6108 {
6109 /* This permits the caller to default to the sample value. */
6110 if (palette != 0)
6111 {
6112 unsigned int i = this->palette_index;
6113
6114 this->red = palette[i].red;
6115 this->green = palette[i].green;
6116 this->blue = palette[i].blue;
6117 this->alpha = palette[i].alpha;
6118 }
6119 }
6120
6121 else /* not palette */
6122 {
6123 unsigned int i = 0;
6124
6125 if ((colour_type & 4) != 0 && format != 0 && format->alpha_first)
6126 {
6127 this->alpha = this->red;
6128 /* This handles the gray case for 'AG' pixels */
6129 this->palette_index = this->red = this->green = this->blue =
6130 sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, 1, swap16, littleendian);
6131 i = 1;
6132 }
6133
6134 if (colour_type & 2)
6135 {
6136 /* Green is second for both BGR and RGB: */
6137 this->green = sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, ++i, swap16,
6138 littleendian);
6139
6140 if (format != 0 && format->swap_rgb) /* BGR */
6141 this->red = sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, ++i, swap16,
6142 littleendian);
6143 else
6144 this->blue = sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, ++i, swap16,
6145 littleendian);
6146 }
6147
6148 else /* grayscale */ if (format != 0 && format->mono_inverted)
6149 this->red = this->green = this->blue = this->red ^ max;
6150
6151 if ((colour_type & 4) != 0) /* alpha */
6152 {
6153 if (format == 0 || !format->alpha_first)
6154 this->alpha = sample(row, colour_type, bit_depth, x, ++i, swap16,
6155 littleendian);
6156
6157 if (format != 0 && format->alpha_inverted)
6158 this->alpha ^= max;
6159 }
6160 }
6161
6162 /* Calculate the scaled values, these are simply the values divided by
6163 * 'max' and the error is initialized to the double precision epsilon value
6164 * from the header file.
6165 */
6166 image_pixel_setf(this,
6167 sig_bits ? (1U << format->red_sBIT)-1 : max,
6168 sig_bits ? (1U << format->green_sBIT)-1 : max,
6169 sig_bits ? (1U << format->blue_sBIT)-1 : max,
6170 sig_bits ? (1U << format->alpha_sBIT)-1 : max);
6171
6172 /* Store the input information for use in the transforms - these will
6173 * modify the information.
6174 */
6175 this->colour_type = colour_type;
6176 this->bit_depth = bit_depth;
6177 this->sample_depth = sample_depth;
6178 this->have_tRNS = 0;
6179 this->swap_rgb = 0;
6180 this->alpha_first = 0;
6181 this->alpha_inverted = 0;
6182 this->mono_inverted = 0;
6183 this->swap16 = 0;
6184 this->littleendian = 0;
6185 this->sig_bits = 0;
6186 }
6187
6188 #if defined PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED || defined PNG_READ_GRAY_TO_RGB_SUPPORTED\
6189 || defined PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED || defined PNG_READ_EXPAND_16_SUPPORTED\
6190 || defined PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
6191 /* Convert a palette image to an rgb image. This necessarily converts the tRNS
6192 * chunk at the same time, because the tRNS will be in palette form. The way
6193 * palette validation works means that the original palette is never updated,
6194 * instead the image_pixel value from the row contains the RGB of the
6195 * corresponding palette entry and *this* is updated. Consequently this routine
6196 * only needs to change the colour type information.
6197 */
6198 static void
image_pixel_convert_PLTE(image_pixel * this)6199 image_pixel_convert_PLTE(image_pixel *this)
6200 {
6201 if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6202 {
6203 if (this->have_tRNS)
6204 {
6205 this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA;
6206 this->have_tRNS = 0;
6207 }
6208 else
6209 this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;
6210
6211 /* The bit depth of the row changes at this point too (notice that this is
6212 * the row format, not the sample depth, which is separate.)
6213 */
6214 this->bit_depth = 8;
6215 }
6216 }
6217
6218 /* Add an alpha channel; this will import the tRNS information because tRNS is
6219 * not valid in an alpha image. The bit depth will invariably be set to at
6220 * least 8 prior to 1.7.0. Palette images will be converted to alpha (using
6221 * the above API). With png_set_background the alpha channel is never expanded
6222 * but this routine is used by pngvalid to simplify code; 'for_background'
6223 * records this.
6224 */
6225 static void
image_pixel_add_alpha(image_pixel * this,const standard_display * display,int for_background)6226 image_pixel_add_alpha(image_pixel *this, const standard_display *display,
6227 int for_background)
6228 {
6229 if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6230 image_pixel_convert_PLTE(this);
6231
6232 if ((this->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0)
6233 {
6234 if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY)
6235 {
6236 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
6237 if (!for_background && this->bit_depth < 8)
6238 this->bit_depth = this->sample_depth = 8;
6239 # endif
6240
6241 if (this->have_tRNS)
6242 {
6243 /* After 1.7 the expansion of bit depth only happens if there is a
6244 * tRNS chunk to expand at this point.
6245 */
6246 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10700
6247 if (!for_background && this->bit_depth < 8)
6248 this->bit_depth = this->sample_depth = 8;
6249 # endif
6250
6251 this->have_tRNS = 0;
6252
6253 /* Check the input, original, channel value here against the
6254 * original tRNS gray chunk valie.
6255 */
6256 if (this->red == display->transparent.red)
6257 this->alphaf = 0;
6258 else
6259 this->alphaf = 1;
6260 }
6261 else
6262 this->alphaf = 1;
6263
6264 this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA;
6265 }
6266
6267 else if (this->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB)
6268 {
6269 if (this->have_tRNS)
6270 {
6271 this->have_tRNS = 0;
6272
6273 /* Again, check the exact input values, not the current transformed
6274 * value!
6275 */
6276 if (this->red == display->transparent.red &&
6277 this->green == display->transparent.green &&
6278 this->blue == display->transparent.blue)
6279 this->alphaf = 0;
6280 else
6281 this->alphaf = 1;
6282 }
6283 else
6284 this->alphaf = 1;
6285
6286 this->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA;
6287 }
6288
6289 /* The error in the alpha is zero and the sBIT value comes from the
6290 * original sBIT data (actually it will always be the original bit depth).
6291 */
6292 this->alphae = 0;
6293 this->alpha_sBIT = display->alpha_sBIT;
6294 }
6295 }
6296 #endif /* transforms that need image_pixel_add_alpha */
6297
6298 struct transform_display;
6299 typedef struct image_transform
6300 {
6301 /* The name of this transform: a string. */
6302 const char *name;
6303
6304 /* Each transform can be disabled from the command line: */
6305 int enable;
6306
6307 /* The global list of transforms; read only. */
6308 struct image_transform *const list;
6309
6310 /* The global count of the number of times this transform has been set on an
6311 * image.
6312 */
6313 unsigned int global_use;
6314
6315 /* The local count of the number of times this transform has been set. */
6316 unsigned int local_use;
6317
6318 /* The next transform in the list, each transform must call its own next
6319 * transform after it has processed the pixel successfully.
6320 */
6321 const struct image_transform *next;
6322
6323 /* A single transform for the image, expressed as a series of function
6324 * callbacks and some space for values.
6325 *
6326 * First a callback to add any required modifications to the png_modifier;
6327 * this gets called just before the modifier is set up for read.
6328 */
6329 void (*ini)(const struct image_transform *this,
6330 struct transform_display *that);
6331
6332 /* And a callback to set the transform on the current png_read_struct:
6333 */
6334 void (*set)(const struct image_transform *this,
6335 struct transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi);
6336
6337 /* Then a transform that takes an input pixel in one PNG format or another
6338 * and modifies it by a pngvalid implementation of the transform (thus
6339 * duplicating the libpng intent without, we hope, duplicating the bugs
6340 * in the libpng implementation!) The png_structp is solely to allow error
6341 * reporting via png_error and png_warning.
6342 */
6343 void (*mod)(const struct image_transform *this, image_pixel *that,
6344 png_const_structp pp, const struct transform_display *display);
6345
6346 /* Add this transform to the list and return true if the transform is
6347 * meaningful for this colour type and bit depth - if false then the
6348 * transform should have no effect on the image so there's not a lot of
6349 * point running it.
6350 */
6351 int (*add)(struct image_transform *this,
6352 const struct image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type,
6353 png_byte bit_depth);
6354 } image_transform;
6355
6356 typedef struct transform_display
6357 {
6358 standard_display this;
6359
6360 /* Parameters */
6361 png_modifier* pm;
6362 const image_transform* transform_list;
6363 unsigned int max_gamma_8;
6364
6365 /* Local variables */
6366 png_byte output_colour_type;
6367 png_byte output_bit_depth;
6368 png_byte unpacked;
6369
6370 /* Modifications (not necessarily used.) */
6371 gama_modification gama_mod;
6372 chrm_modification chrm_mod;
6373 srgb_modification srgb_mod;
6374 } transform_display;
6375
6376 /* Set sRGB, cHRM and gAMA transforms as required by the current encoding. */
6377 static void
transform_set_encoding(transform_display * this)6378 transform_set_encoding(transform_display *this)
6379 {
6380 /* Set up the png_modifier '_current' fields then use these to determine how
6381 * to add appropriate chunks.
6382 */
6383 png_modifier *pm = this->pm;
6384
6385 modifier_set_encoding(pm);
6386
6387 if (modifier_color_encoding_is_set(pm))
6388 {
6389 if (modifier_color_encoding_is_sRGB(pm))
6390 srgb_modification_init(&this->srgb_mod, pm, PNG_sRGB_INTENT_ABSOLUTE);
6391
6392 else
6393 {
6394 /* Set gAMA and cHRM separately. */
6395 gama_modification_init(&this->gama_mod, pm, pm->current_gamma);
6396
6397 if (pm->current_encoding != 0)
6398 chrm_modification_init(&this->chrm_mod, pm, pm->current_encoding);
6399 }
6400 }
6401 }
6402
6403 /* Three functions to end the list: */
6404 static void
image_transform_ini_end(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that)6405 image_transform_ini_end(const image_transform *this,
6406 transform_display *that)
6407 {
6408 UNUSED(this)
6409 UNUSED(that)
6410 }
6411
6412 static void
image_transform_set_end(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)6413 image_transform_set_end(const image_transform *this,
6414 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
6415 {
6416 UNUSED(this)
6417 UNUSED(that)
6418 UNUSED(pp)
6419 UNUSED(pi)
6420 }
6421
6422 /* At the end of the list recalculate the output image pixel value from the
6423 * double precision values set up by the preceding 'mod' calls:
6424 */
6425 static unsigned int
sample_scale(double sample_value,unsigned int scale)6426 sample_scale(double sample_value, unsigned int scale)
6427 {
6428 sample_value = floor(sample_value * scale + .5);
6429
6430 /* Return NaN as 0: */
6431 if (!(sample_value > 0))
6432 sample_value = 0;
6433 else if (sample_value > scale)
6434 sample_value = scale;
6435
6436 return (unsigned int)sample_value;
6437 }
6438
6439 static void
image_transform_mod_end(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)6440 image_transform_mod_end(const image_transform *this, image_pixel *that,
6441 png_const_structp pp, const transform_display *display)
6442 {
6443 unsigned int scale = (1U<<that->sample_depth)-1;
6444 int sig_bits = that->sig_bits;
6445
6446 UNUSED(this)
6447 UNUSED(pp)
6448 UNUSED(display)
6449
6450 /* At the end recalculate the digitized red green and blue values according
6451 * to the current sample_depth of the pixel.
6452 *
6453 * The sample value is simply scaled to the maximum, checking for over
6454 * and underflow (which can both happen for some image transforms,
6455 * including simple size scaling, though libpng doesn't do that at present.
6456 */
6457 that->red = sample_scale(that->redf, scale);
6458
6459 /* This is a bit bogus; really the above calculation should use the red_sBIT
6460 * value, not sample_depth, but because libpng does png_set_shift by just
6461 * shifting the bits we get errors if we don't do it the same way.
6462 */
6463 if (sig_bits && that->red_sBIT < that->sample_depth)
6464 that->red >>= that->sample_depth - that->red_sBIT;
6465
6466 /* The error value is increased, at the end, according to the lowest sBIT
6467 * value seen. Common sense tells us that the intermediate integer
6468 * representations are no more accurate than +/- 0.5 in the integral values,
6469 * the sBIT allows the implementation to be worse than this. In addition the
6470 * PNG specification actually permits any error within the range (-1..+1),
6471 * but that is ignored here. Instead the final digitized value is compared,
6472 * below to the digitized value of the error limits - this has the net effect
6473 * of allowing (almost) +/-1 in the output value. It's difficult to see how
6474 * any algorithm that digitizes intermediate results can be more accurate.
6475 */
6476 that->rede += 1./(2*((1U<<that->red_sBIT)-1));
6477
6478 if (that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
6479 {
6480 that->green = sample_scale(that->greenf, scale);
6481 if (sig_bits && that->green_sBIT < that->sample_depth)
6482 that->green >>= that->sample_depth - that->green_sBIT;
6483
6484 that->blue = sample_scale(that->bluef, scale);
6485 if (sig_bits && that->blue_sBIT < that->sample_depth)
6486 that->blue >>= that->sample_depth - that->blue_sBIT;
6487
6488 that->greene += 1./(2*((1U<<that->green_sBIT)-1));
6489 that->bluee += 1./(2*((1U<<that->blue_sBIT)-1));
6490 }
6491 else
6492 {
6493 that->blue = that->green = that->red;
6494 that->bluef = that->greenf = that->redf;
6495 that->bluee = that->greene = that->rede;
6496 }
6497
6498 if ((that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) ||
6499 that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6500 {
6501 that->alpha = sample_scale(that->alphaf, scale);
6502 that->alphae += 1./(2*((1U<<that->alpha_sBIT)-1));
6503 }
6504 else
6505 {
6506 that->alpha = scale; /* opaque */
6507 that->alphaf = 1; /* Override this. */
6508 that->alphae = 0; /* It's exact ;-) */
6509 }
6510
6511 if (sig_bits && that->alpha_sBIT < that->sample_depth)
6512 that->alpha >>= that->sample_depth - that->alpha_sBIT;
6513 }
6514
6515 /* Static 'end' structure: */
6516 static image_transform image_transform_end =
6517 {
6518 "(end)", /* name */
6519 1, /* enable */
6520 0, /* list */
6521 0, /* global_use */
6522 0, /* local_use */
6523 0, /* next */
6524 image_transform_ini_end,
6525 image_transform_set_end,
6526 image_transform_mod_end,
6527 0 /* never called, I want it to crash if it is! */
6528 };
6529
6530 /* Reader callbacks and implementations, where they differ from the standard
6531 * ones.
6532 */
6533 static void
transform_display_init(transform_display * dp,png_modifier * pm,png_uint_32 id,const image_transform * transform_list)6534 transform_display_init(transform_display *dp, png_modifier *pm, png_uint_32 id,
6535 const image_transform *transform_list)
6536 {
6537 memset(dp, 0, sizeof *dp);
6538
6539 /* Standard fields */
6540 standard_display_init(&dp->this, &pm->this, id, do_read_interlace,
6541 pm->use_update_info);
6542
6543 /* Parameter fields */
6544 dp->pm = pm;
6545 dp->transform_list = transform_list;
6546 dp->max_gamma_8 = 16;
6547
6548 /* Local variable fields */
6549 dp->output_colour_type = 255; /* invalid */
6550 dp->output_bit_depth = 255; /* invalid */
6551 dp->unpacked = 0; /* not unpacked */
6552 }
6553
6554 static void
transform_info_imp(transform_display * dp,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)6555 transform_info_imp(transform_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
6556 {
6557 /* Reuse the standard stuff as appropriate. */
6558 standard_info_part1(&dp->this, pp, pi);
6559
6560 /* Now set the list of transforms. */
6561 dp->transform_list->set(dp->transform_list, dp, pp, pi);
6562
6563 /* Update the info structure for these transforms: */
6564 {
6565 int i = dp->this.use_update_info;
6566 /* Always do one call, even if use_update_info is 0. */
6567 do
6568 png_read_update_info(pp, pi);
6569 while (--i > 0);
6570 }
6571
6572 /* And get the output information into the standard_display */
6573 standard_info_part2(&dp->this, pp, pi, 1/*images*/);
6574
6575 /* Plus the extra stuff we need for the transform tests: */
6576 dp->output_colour_type = png_get_color_type(pp, pi);
6577 dp->output_bit_depth = png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi);
6578
6579 /* If png_set_filler is in action then fake the output color type to include
6580 * an alpha channel where appropriate.
6581 */
6582 if (dp->output_bit_depth >= 8 &&
6583 (dp->output_colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB ||
6584 dp->output_colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY) && dp->this.filler)
6585 dp->output_colour_type |= 4;
6586
6587 /* Validate the combination of colour type and bit depth that we are getting
6588 * out of libpng; the semantics of something not in the PNG spec are, at
6589 * best, unclear.
6590 */
6591 switch (dp->output_colour_type)
6592 {
6593 case PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE:
6594 if (dp->output_bit_depth > 8) goto error;
6595 /* FALLTHROUGH */
6596 case PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY:
6597 if (dp->output_bit_depth == 1 || dp->output_bit_depth == 2 ||
6598 dp->output_bit_depth == 4)
6599 break;
6600 /* FALLTHROUGH */
6601 default:
6602 if (dp->output_bit_depth == 8 || dp->output_bit_depth == 16)
6603 break;
6604 /* FALLTHROUGH */
6605 error:
6606 {
6607 char message[128];
6608 size_t pos;
6609
6610 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0,
6611 "invalid final bit depth: colour type(");
6612 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_colour_type);
6613 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ") with bit depth: ");
6614 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_bit_depth);
6615
6616 png_error(pp, message);
6617 }
6618 }
6619
6620 /* Use a test pixel to check that the output agrees with what we expect -
6621 * this avoids running the whole test if the output is unexpected. This also
6622 * checks for internal errors.
6623 */
6624 {
6625 image_pixel test_pixel;
6626
6627 memset(&test_pixel, 0, sizeof test_pixel);
6628 test_pixel.colour_type = dp->this.colour_type; /* input */
6629 test_pixel.bit_depth = dp->this.bit_depth;
6630 if (test_pixel.colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6631 test_pixel.sample_depth = 8;
6632 else
6633 test_pixel.sample_depth = test_pixel.bit_depth;
6634 /* Don't need sBIT here, but it must be set to non-zero to avoid
6635 * arithmetic overflows.
6636 */
6637 test_pixel.have_tRNS = dp->this.is_transparent != 0;
6638 test_pixel.red_sBIT = test_pixel.green_sBIT = test_pixel.blue_sBIT =
6639 test_pixel.alpha_sBIT = test_pixel.sample_depth;
6640
6641 dp->transform_list->mod(dp->transform_list, &test_pixel, pp, dp);
6642
6643 if (test_pixel.colour_type != dp->output_colour_type)
6644 {
6645 char message[128];
6646 size_t pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0, "colour type ");
6647
6648 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_colour_type);
6649 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected ");
6650 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, test_pixel.colour_type);
6651
6652 png_error(pp, message);
6653 }
6654
6655 if (test_pixel.bit_depth != dp->output_bit_depth)
6656 {
6657 char message[128];
6658 size_t pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0, "bit depth ");
6659
6660 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_bit_depth);
6661 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected ");
6662 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, test_pixel.bit_depth);
6663
6664 png_error(pp, message);
6665 }
6666
6667 /* If both bit depth and colour type are correct check the sample depth.
6668 */
6669 if (test_pixel.colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE &&
6670 test_pixel.sample_depth != 8) /* oops - internal error! */
6671 png_error(pp, "pngvalid: internal: palette sample depth not 8");
6672 else if (dp->unpacked && test_pixel.bit_depth != 8)
6673 png_error(pp, "pngvalid: internal: bad unpacked pixel depth");
6674 else if (!dp->unpacked && test_pixel.colour_type != PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE
6675 && test_pixel.bit_depth != test_pixel.sample_depth)
6676 {
6677 char message[128];
6678 size_t pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0,
6679 "internal: sample depth ");
6680
6681 /* Because unless something has set 'unpacked' or the image is palette
6682 * mapped we expect the transform to keep sample depth and bit depth
6683 * the same.
6684 */
6685 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, test_pixel.sample_depth);
6686 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected ");
6687 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, test_pixel.bit_depth);
6688
6689 png_error(pp, message);
6690 }
6691 else if (test_pixel.bit_depth != dp->output_bit_depth)
6692 {
6693 /* This could be a libpng error too; libpng has not produced what we
6694 * expect for the output bit depth.
6695 */
6696 char message[128];
6697 size_t pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0,
6698 "internal: bit depth ");
6699
6700 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, dp->output_bit_depth);
6701 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected ");
6702 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, test_pixel.bit_depth);
6703
6704 png_error(pp, message);
6705 }
6706 }
6707 }
6708
6709 static void PNGCBAPI
transform_info(png_structp pp,png_infop pi)6710 transform_info(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
6711 {
6712 transform_info_imp(voidcast(transform_display*, png_get_progressive_ptr(pp)),
6713 pp, pi);
6714 }
6715
6716 static void
transform_range_check(png_const_structp pp,unsigned int r,unsigned int g,unsigned int b,unsigned int a,unsigned int in_digitized,double in,unsigned int out,png_byte sample_depth,double err,double limit,const char * name,double digitization_error)6717 transform_range_check(png_const_structp pp, unsigned int r, unsigned int g,
6718 unsigned int b, unsigned int a, unsigned int in_digitized, double in,
6719 unsigned int out, png_byte sample_depth, double err, double limit,
6720 const char *name, double digitization_error)
6721 {
6722 /* Compare the scaled, digitzed, values of our local calculation (in+-err)
6723 * with the digitized values libpng produced; 'sample_depth' is the actual
6724 * digitization depth of the libpng output colors (the bit depth except for
6725 * palette images where it is always 8.) The check on 'err' is to detect
6726 * internal errors in pngvalid itself.
6727 */
6728 unsigned int max = (1U<<sample_depth)-1;
6729 double in_min = ceil((in-err)*max - digitization_error);
6730 double in_max = floor((in+err)*max + digitization_error);
6731 if (debugonly(err > limit ||) !(out >= in_min && out <= in_max))
6732 {
6733 char message[256];
6734 size_t pos;
6735
6736 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, 0, name);
6737 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " output value error: rgba(");
6738 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, r);
6739 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ",");
6740 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, g);
6741 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ",");
6742 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, b);
6743 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ",");
6744 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, a);
6745 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, "): ");
6746 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, out);
6747 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " expected: ");
6748 pos = safecatn(message, sizeof message, pos, in_digitized);
6749 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, " (");
6750 pos = safecatd(message, sizeof message, pos, (in-err)*max, 3);
6751 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, "..");
6752 pos = safecatd(message, sizeof message, pos, (in+err)*max, 3);
6753 pos = safecat(message, sizeof message, pos, ")");
6754
6755 png_error(pp, message);
6756 }
6757
6758 UNUSED(limit)
6759 }
6760
6761 static void
transform_image_validate(transform_display * dp,png_const_structp pp,png_infop pi)6762 transform_image_validate(transform_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
6763 png_infop pi)
6764 {
6765 /* Constants for the loop below: */
6766 const png_store* const ps = dp->this.ps;
6767 png_byte in_ct = dp->this.colour_type;
6768 png_byte in_bd = dp->this.bit_depth;
6769 png_uint_32 w = dp->this.w;
6770 png_uint_32 h = dp->this.h;
6771 png_byte out_ct = dp->output_colour_type;
6772 png_byte out_bd = dp->output_bit_depth;
6773 png_byte sample_depth =
6774 (png_byte)(out_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE ? 8 : out_bd);
6775 png_byte red_sBIT = dp->this.red_sBIT;
6776 png_byte green_sBIT = dp->this.green_sBIT;
6777 png_byte blue_sBIT = dp->this.blue_sBIT;
6778 png_byte alpha_sBIT = dp->this.alpha_sBIT;
6779 int have_tRNS = dp->this.is_transparent;
6780 double digitization_error;
6781
6782 store_palette out_palette;
6783 png_uint_32 y;
6784
6785 UNUSED(pi)
6786
6787 /* Check for row overwrite errors */
6788 store_image_check(dp->this.ps, pp, 0);
6789
6790 /* Read the palette corresponding to the output if the output colour type
6791 * indicates a palette, otherwise set out_palette to garbage.
6792 */
6793 if (out_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6794 {
6795 /* Validate that the palette count itself has not changed - this is not
6796 * expected.
6797 */
6798 int npalette = (-1);
6799
6800 (void)read_palette(out_palette, &npalette, pp, pi);
6801 if (npalette != dp->this.npalette)
6802 png_error(pp, "unexpected change in palette size");
6803
6804 digitization_error = .5;
6805 }
6806 else
6807 {
6808 png_byte in_sample_depth;
6809
6810 memset(out_palette, 0x5e, sizeof out_palette);
6811
6812 /* use-input-precision means assume that if the input has 8 bit (or less)
6813 * samples and the output has 16 bit samples the calculations will be done
6814 * with 8 bit precision, not 16.
6815 */
6816 if (in_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE || in_bd < 16)
6817 in_sample_depth = 8;
6818 else
6819 in_sample_depth = in_bd;
6820
6821 if (sample_depth != 16 || in_sample_depth > 8 ||
6822 !dp->pm->calculations_use_input_precision)
6823 digitization_error = .5;
6824
6825 /* Else calculations are at 8 bit precision, and the output actually
6826 * consists of scaled 8-bit values, so scale .5 in 8 bits to the 16 bits:
6827 */
6828 else
6829 digitization_error = .5 * 257;
6830 }
6831
6832 for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
6833 {
6834 png_const_bytep const pRow = store_image_row(ps, pp, 0, y);
6835 png_uint_32 x;
6836
6837 /* The original, standard, row pre-transforms. */
6838 png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX];
6839
6840 transform_row(pp, std, in_ct, in_bd, y);
6841
6842 /* Go through each original pixel transforming it and comparing with what
6843 * libpng did to the same pixel.
6844 */
6845 for (x=0; x<w; ++x)
6846 {
6847 image_pixel in_pixel, out_pixel;
6848 unsigned int r, g, b, a;
6849
6850 /* Find out what we think the pixel should be: */
6851 image_pixel_init(&in_pixel, std, in_ct, in_bd, x, dp->this.palette,
6852 NULL);
6853
6854 in_pixel.red_sBIT = red_sBIT;
6855 in_pixel.green_sBIT = green_sBIT;
6856 in_pixel.blue_sBIT = blue_sBIT;
6857 in_pixel.alpha_sBIT = alpha_sBIT;
6858 in_pixel.have_tRNS = have_tRNS != 0;
6859
6860 /* For error detection, below. */
6861 r = in_pixel.red;
6862 g = in_pixel.green;
6863 b = in_pixel.blue;
6864 a = in_pixel.alpha;
6865
6866 /* This applies the transforms to the input data, including output
6867 * format operations which must be used when reading the output
6868 * pixel that libpng produces.
6869 */
6870 dp->transform_list->mod(dp->transform_list, &in_pixel, pp, dp);
6871
6872 /* Read the output pixel and compare it to what we got, we don't
6873 * use the error field here, so no need to update sBIT. in_pixel
6874 * says whether we expect libpng to change the output format.
6875 */
6876 image_pixel_init(&out_pixel, pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, out_palette,
6877 &in_pixel);
6878
6879 /* We don't expect changes to the index here even if the bit depth is
6880 * changed.
6881 */
6882 if (in_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE &&
6883 out_ct == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
6884 {
6885 if (in_pixel.palette_index != out_pixel.palette_index)
6886 png_error(pp, "unexpected transformed palette index");
6887 }
6888
6889 /* Check the colours for palette images too - in fact the palette could
6890 * be separately verified itself in most cases.
6891 */
6892 if (in_pixel.red != out_pixel.red)
6893 transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.red, in_pixel.redf,
6894 out_pixel.red, sample_depth, in_pixel.rede,
6895 dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.red_sBIT)-1)), "red/gray",
6896 digitization_error);
6897
6898 if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0 &&
6899 in_pixel.green != out_pixel.green)
6900 transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.green,
6901 in_pixel.greenf, out_pixel.green, sample_depth, in_pixel.greene,
6902 dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.green_sBIT)-1)), "green",
6903 digitization_error);
6904
6905 if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0 &&
6906 in_pixel.blue != out_pixel.blue)
6907 transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.blue, in_pixel.bluef,
6908 out_pixel.blue, sample_depth, in_pixel.bluee,
6909 dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.blue_sBIT)-1)), "blue",
6910 digitization_error);
6911
6912 if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0 &&
6913 in_pixel.alpha != out_pixel.alpha)
6914 transform_range_check(pp, r, g, b, a, in_pixel.alpha,
6915 in_pixel.alphaf, out_pixel.alpha, sample_depth, in_pixel.alphae,
6916 dp->pm->limit + 1./(2*((1U<<in_pixel.alpha_sBIT)-1)), "alpha",
6917 digitization_error);
6918 } /* pixel (x) loop */
6919 } /* row (y) loop */
6920
6921 /* Record that something was actually checked to avoid a false positive. */
6922 dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
6923 }
6924
6925 static void PNGCBAPI
transform_end(png_structp ppIn,png_infop pi)6926 transform_end(png_structp ppIn, png_infop pi)
6927 {
6928 png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
6929 transform_display *dp = voidcast(transform_display*,
6930 png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
6931
6932 if (!dp->this.speed)
6933 transform_image_validate(dp, pp, pi);
6934 else
6935 dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
6936 }
6937
6938 /* A single test run. */
6939 static void
transform_test(png_modifier * pmIn,png_uint_32 idIn,const image_transform * transform_listIn,const char * const name)6940 transform_test(png_modifier *pmIn, png_uint_32 idIn,
6941 const image_transform* transform_listIn, const char * const name)
6942 {
6943 transform_display d;
6944 context(&pmIn->this, fault);
6945
6946 transform_display_init(&d, pmIn, idIn, transform_listIn);
6947
6948 Try
6949 {
6950 size_t pos = 0;
6951 png_structp pp;
6952 png_infop pi;
6953 char full_name[256];
6954
6955 /* Make sure the encoding fields are correct and enter the required
6956 * modifications.
6957 */
6958 transform_set_encoding(&d);
6959
6960 /* Add any modifications required by the transform list. */
6961 d.transform_list->ini(d.transform_list, &d);
6962
6963 /* Add the color space information, if any, to the name. */
6964 pos = safecat(full_name, sizeof full_name, pos, name);
6965 pos = safecat_current_encoding(full_name, sizeof full_name, pos, d.pm);
6966
6967 /* Get a png_struct for reading the image. */
6968 pp = set_modifier_for_read(d.pm, &pi, d.this.id, full_name);
6969 standard_palette_init(&d.this);
6970
6971 # if 0
6972 /* Logging (debugging only) */
6973 {
6974 char buffer[256];
6975
6976 (void)store_message(&d.pm->this, pp, buffer, sizeof buffer, 0,
6977 "running test");
6978
6979 fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", buffer);
6980 }
6981 # endif
6982
6983 /* Introduce the correct read function. */
6984 if (d.pm->this.progressive)
6985 {
6986 /* Share the row function with the standard implementation. */
6987 png_set_progressive_read_fn(pp, &d, transform_info, progressive_row,
6988 transform_end);
6989
6990 /* Now feed data into the reader until we reach the end: */
6991 modifier_progressive_read(d.pm, pp, pi);
6992 }
6993 else
6994 {
6995 /* modifier_read expects a png_modifier* */
6996 png_set_read_fn(pp, d.pm, modifier_read);
6997
6998 /* Check the header values: */
6999 png_read_info(pp, pi);
7000
7001 /* Process the 'info' requirements. Only one image is generated */
7002 transform_info_imp(&d, pp, pi);
7003
7004 sequential_row(&d.this, pp, pi, -1, 0);
7005
7006 if (!d.this.speed)
7007 transform_image_validate(&d, pp, pi);
7008 else
7009 d.this.ps->validated = 1;
7010 }
7011
7012 modifier_reset(d.pm);
7013 }
7014
7015 Catch(fault)
7016 {
7017 modifier_reset(voidcast(png_modifier*,(void*)fault));
7018 }
7019 }
7020
7021 /* The transforms: */
7022 #define ITSTRUCT(name) image_transform_##name
7023 #define ITDATA(name) image_transform_data_##name
7024 #define image_transform_ini image_transform_default_ini
7025 #define IT(name)\
7026 static image_transform ITSTRUCT(name) =\
7027 {\
7028 #name,\
7029 1, /*enable*/\
7030 &PT, /*list*/\
7031 0, /*global_use*/\
7032 0, /*local_use*/\
7033 0, /*next*/\
7034 image_transform_ini,\
7035 image_transform_png_set_##name##_set,\
7036 image_transform_png_set_##name##_mod,\
7037 image_transform_png_set_##name##_add\
7038 }
7039 #define PT ITSTRUCT(end) /* stores the previous transform */
7040
7041 /* To save code: */
7042 extern void image_transform_default_ini(const image_transform *this,
7043 transform_display *that); /* silence GCC warnings */
7044
7045 void /* private, but almost always needed */
image_transform_default_ini(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that)7046 image_transform_default_ini(const image_transform *this,
7047 transform_display *that)
7048 {
7049 this->next->ini(this->next, that);
7050 }
7051
7052 #ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
7053 static int
image_transform_default_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)7054 image_transform_default_add(image_transform *this,
7055 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
7056 {
7057 UNUSED(colour_type)
7058 UNUSED(bit_depth)
7059
7060 this->next = *that;
7061 *that = this;
7062
7063 return 1;
7064 }
7065 #endif
7066
7067 #ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
7068 /* png_set_palette_to_rgb */
7069 static void
image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)7070 image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_set(const image_transform *this,
7071 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
7072 {
7073 png_set_palette_to_rgb(pp);
7074 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
7075 }
7076
7077 static void
image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)7078 image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_mod(const image_transform *this,
7079 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
7080 const transform_display *display)
7081 {
7082 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
7083 image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
7084
7085 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
7086 }
7087
7088 static int
image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)7089 image_transform_png_set_palette_to_rgb_add(image_transform *this,
7090 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
7091 {
7092 UNUSED(bit_depth)
7093
7094 this->next = *that;
7095 *that = this;
7096
7097 return colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE;
7098 }
7099
7100 IT(palette_to_rgb);
7101 #undef PT
7102 #define PT ITSTRUCT(palette_to_rgb)
7103 #endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */
7104
7105 #ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
7106 /* png_set_tRNS_to_alpha */
7107 static void
image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)7108 image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_set(const image_transform *this,
7109 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
7110 {
7111 png_set_tRNS_to_alpha(pp);
7112
7113 /* If there was a tRNS chunk that would get expanded and add an alpha
7114 * channel is_transparent must be updated:
7115 */
7116 if (that->this.has_tRNS)
7117 that->this.is_transparent = 1;
7118
7119 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
7120 }
7121
7122 static void
image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)7123 image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_mod(const image_transform *this,
7124 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
7125 const transform_display *display)
7126 {
7127 #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
7128 /* LIBPNG BUG: this always forces palette images to RGB. */
7129 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
7130 image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
7131 #endif
7132
7133 /* This effectively does an 'expand' only if there is some transparency to
7134 * convert to an alpha channel.
7135 */
7136 if (that->have_tRNS)
7137 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10700
7138 if (that->colour_type != PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE &&
7139 (that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0)
7140 # endif
7141 image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this, 0/*!for background*/);
7142
7143 #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
7144 /* LIBPNG BUG: otherwise libpng still expands to 8 bits! */
7145 else
7146 {
7147 if (that->bit_depth < 8)
7148 that->bit_depth =8;
7149 if (that->sample_depth < 8)
7150 that->sample_depth = 8;
7151 }
7152 #endif
7153
7154 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
7155 }
7156
7157 static int
image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)7158 image_transform_png_set_tRNS_to_alpha_add(image_transform *this,
7159 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
7160 {
7161 UNUSED(bit_depth)
7162
7163 this->next = *that;
7164 *that = this;
7165
7166 /* We don't know yet whether there will be a tRNS chunk, but we know that
7167 * this transformation should do nothing if there already is an alpha
7168 * channel. In addition, after the bug fix in 1.7.0, there is no longer
7169 * any action on a palette image.
7170 */
7171 return
7172 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10700
7173 colour_type != PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE &&
7174 # endif
7175 (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0;
7176 }
7177
7178 IT(tRNS_to_alpha);
7179 #undef PT
7180 #define PT ITSTRUCT(tRNS_to_alpha)
7181 #endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */
7182
7183 #ifdef PNG_READ_GRAY_TO_RGB_SUPPORTED
7184 /* png_set_gray_to_rgb */
7185 static void
image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)7186 image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_set(const image_transform *this,
7187 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
7188 {
7189 png_set_gray_to_rgb(pp);
7190 /* NOTE: this doesn't result in tRNS expansion. */
7191 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
7192 }
7193
7194 static void
image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)7195 image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_mod(const image_transform *this,
7196 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
7197 const transform_display *display)
7198 {
7199 /* NOTE: we can actually pend the tRNS processing at this point because we
7200 * can correctly recognize the original pixel value even though we have
7201 * mapped the one gray channel to the three RGB ones, but in fact libpng
7202 * doesn't do this, so we don't either.
7203 */
7204 if ((that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) == 0 && that->have_tRNS)
7205 image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this, 0/*!for background*/);
7206
7207 /* Simply expand the bit depth and alter the colour type as required. */
7208 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY)
7209 {
7210 /* RGB images have a bit depth at least equal to '8' */
7211 if (that->bit_depth < 8)
7212 that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
7213
7214 /* And just changing the colour type works here because the green and blue
7215 * channels are being maintained in lock-step with the red/gray:
7216 */
7217 that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;
7218 }
7219
7220 else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA)
7221 that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA;
7222
7223 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
7224 }
7225
7226 static int
image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)7227 image_transform_png_set_gray_to_rgb_add(image_transform *this,
7228 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
7229 {
7230 UNUSED(bit_depth)
7231
7232 this->next = *that;
7233 *that = this;
7234
7235 return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) == 0;
7236 }
7237
7238 IT(gray_to_rgb);
7239 #undef PT
7240 #define PT ITSTRUCT(gray_to_rgb)
7241 #endif /* PNG_READ_GRAY_TO_RGB_SUPPORTED */
7242
7243 #ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
7244 /* png_set_expand */
7245 static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)7246 image_transform_png_set_expand_set(const image_transform *this,
7247 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
7248 {
7249 png_set_expand(pp);
7250
7251 if (that->this.has_tRNS)
7252 that->this.is_transparent = 1;
7253
7254 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
7255 }
7256
7257 static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)7258 image_transform_png_set_expand_mod(const image_transform *this,
7259 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
7260 const transform_display *display)
7261 {
7262 /* The general expand case depends on what the colour type is: */
7263 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
7264 image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
7265 else if (that->bit_depth < 8) /* grayscale */
7266 that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
7267
7268 if (that->have_tRNS)
7269 image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this, 0/*!for background*/);
7270
7271 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
7272 }
7273
7274 static int
image_transform_png_set_expand_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)7275 image_transform_png_set_expand_add(image_transform *this,
7276 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
7277 {
7278 UNUSED(bit_depth)
7279
7280 this->next = *that;
7281 *that = this;
7282
7283 /* 'expand' should do nothing for RGBA or GA input - no tRNS and the bit
7284 * depth is at least 8 already.
7285 */
7286 return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0;
7287 }
7288
7289 IT(expand);
7290 #undef PT
7291 #define PT ITSTRUCT(expand)
7292 #endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */
7293
7294 #ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
7295 /* png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8
7296 * Pre 1.7.0 LIBPNG BUG: this just does an 'expand'
7297 */
7298 static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)7299 image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_set(
7300 const image_transform *this, transform_display *that, png_structp pp,
7301 png_infop pi)
7302 {
7303 png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8(pp);
7304 /* NOTE: don't expect this to expand tRNS */
7305 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
7306 }
7307
7308 static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)7309 image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_mod(
7310 const image_transform *this, image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
7311 const transform_display *display)
7312 {
7313 #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
7314 image_transform_png_set_expand_mod(this, that, pp, display);
7315 #else
7316 /* Only expand grayscale of bit depth less than 8: */
7317 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY &&
7318 that->bit_depth < 8)
7319 that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
7320
7321 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
7322 #endif /* 1.7 or later */
7323 }
7324
7325 static int
image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)7326 image_transform_png_set_expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8_add(image_transform *this,
7327 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
7328 {
7329 #if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
7330 return image_transform_png_set_expand_add(this, that, colour_type,
7331 bit_depth);
7332 #else
7333 UNUSED(bit_depth)
7334
7335 this->next = *that;
7336 *that = this;
7337
7338 /* This should do nothing unless the color type is gray and the bit depth is
7339 * less than 8:
7340 */
7341 return colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY && bit_depth < 8;
7342 #endif /* 1.7 or later */
7343 }
7344
7345 IT(expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8);
7346 #undef PT
7347 #define PT ITSTRUCT(expand_gray_1_2_4_to_8)
7348 #endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED */
7349
7350 #ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_16_SUPPORTED
7351 /* png_set_expand_16 */
7352 static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_16_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)7353 image_transform_png_set_expand_16_set(const image_transform *this,
7354 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
7355 {
7356 png_set_expand_16(pp);
7357
7358 /* NOTE: prior to 1.7 libpng does SET_EXPAND as well, so tRNS is expanded. */
7359 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
7360 if (that->this.has_tRNS)
7361 that->this.is_transparent = 1;
7362 # endif
7363
7364 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
7365 }
7366
7367 static void
image_transform_png_set_expand_16_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)7368 image_transform_png_set_expand_16_mod(const image_transform *this,
7369 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
7370 const transform_display *display)
7371 {
7372 /* Expect expand_16 to expand everything to 16 bits as a result of also
7373 * causing 'expand' to happen.
7374 */
7375 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
7376 image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
7377
7378 if (that->have_tRNS)
7379 image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this, 0/*!for background*/);
7380
7381 if (that->bit_depth < 16)
7382 that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 16;
7383
7384 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
7385 }
7386
7387 static int
image_transform_png_set_expand_16_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)7388 image_transform_png_set_expand_16_add(image_transform *this,
7389 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
7390 {
7391 UNUSED(colour_type)
7392
7393 this->next = *that;
7394 *that = this;
7395
7396 /* expand_16 does something unless the bit depth is already 16. */
7397 return bit_depth < 16;
7398 }
7399
7400 IT(expand_16);
7401 #undef PT
7402 #define PT ITSTRUCT(expand_16)
7403 #endif /* PNG_READ_EXPAND_16_SUPPORTED */
7404
7405 #ifdef PNG_READ_SCALE_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED /* API added in 1.5.4 */
7406 /* png_set_scale_16 */
7407 static void
image_transform_png_set_scale_16_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)7408 image_transform_png_set_scale_16_set(const image_transform *this,
7409 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
7410 {
7411 png_set_scale_16(pp);
7412 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
7413 /* libpng will limit the gamma table size: */
7414 that->max_gamma_8 = PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8;
7415 # endif
7416 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
7417 }
7418
7419 static void
image_transform_png_set_scale_16_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)7420 image_transform_png_set_scale_16_mod(const image_transform *this,
7421 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
7422 const transform_display *display)
7423 {
7424 if (that->bit_depth == 16)
7425 {
7426 that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
7427 if (that->red_sBIT > 8) that->red_sBIT = 8;
7428 if (that->green_sBIT > 8) that->green_sBIT = 8;
7429 if (that->blue_sBIT > 8) that->blue_sBIT = 8;
7430 if (that->alpha_sBIT > 8) that->alpha_sBIT = 8;
7431 }
7432
7433 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
7434 }
7435
7436 static int
image_transform_png_set_scale_16_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)7437 image_transform_png_set_scale_16_add(image_transform *this,
7438 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
7439 {
7440 UNUSED(colour_type)
7441
7442 this->next = *that;
7443 *that = this;
7444
7445 return bit_depth > 8;
7446 }
7447
7448 IT(scale_16);
7449 #undef PT
7450 #define PT ITSTRUCT(scale_16)
7451 #endif /* PNG_READ_SCALE_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED (1.5.4 on) */
7452
7453 #ifdef PNG_READ_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED /* the default before 1.5.4 */
7454 /* png_set_strip_16 */
7455 static void
image_transform_png_set_strip_16_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)7456 image_transform_png_set_strip_16_set(const image_transform *this,
7457 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
7458 {
7459 png_set_strip_16(pp);
7460 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
7461 /* libpng will limit the gamma table size: */
7462 that->max_gamma_8 = PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8;
7463 # endif
7464 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
7465 }
7466
7467 static void
image_transform_png_set_strip_16_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)7468 image_transform_png_set_strip_16_mod(const image_transform *this,
7469 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
7470 const transform_display *display)
7471 {
7472 if (that->bit_depth == 16)
7473 {
7474 that->sample_depth = that->bit_depth = 8;
7475 if (that->red_sBIT > 8) that->red_sBIT = 8;
7476 if (that->green_sBIT > 8) that->green_sBIT = 8;
7477 if (that->blue_sBIT > 8) that->blue_sBIT = 8;
7478 if (that->alpha_sBIT > 8) that->alpha_sBIT = 8;
7479
7480 /* Prior to 1.5.4 png_set_strip_16 would use an 'accurate' method if this
7481 * configuration option is set. From 1.5.4 the flag is never set and the
7482 * 'scale' API (above) must be used.
7483 */
7484 # ifdef PNG_READ_ACCURATE_SCALE_SUPPORTED
7485 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10504
7486 # error PNG_READ_ACCURATE_SCALE should not be set
7487 # endif
7488
7489 /* The strip 16 algorithm drops the low 8 bits rather than calculating
7490 * 1/257, so we need to adjust the permitted errors appropriately:
7491 * Notice that this is only relevant prior to the addition of the
7492 * png_set_scale_16 API in 1.5.4 (but 1.5.4+ always defines the above!)
7493 */
7494 {
7495 const double d = (255-128.5)/65535;
7496 that->rede += d;
7497 that->greene += d;
7498 that->bluee += d;
7499 that->alphae += d;
7500 }
7501 # endif
7502 }
7503
7504 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
7505 }
7506
7507 static int
image_transform_png_set_strip_16_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)7508 image_transform_png_set_strip_16_add(image_transform *this,
7509 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
7510 {
7511 UNUSED(colour_type)
7512
7513 this->next = *that;
7514 *that = this;
7515
7516 return bit_depth > 8;
7517 }
7518
7519 IT(strip_16);
7520 #undef PT
7521 #define PT ITSTRUCT(strip_16)
7522 #endif /* PNG_READ_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED */
7523
7524 #ifdef PNG_READ_STRIP_ALPHA_SUPPORTED
7525 /* png_set_strip_alpha */
7526 static void
image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)7527 image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_set(const image_transform *this,
7528 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
7529 {
7530 png_set_strip_alpha(pp);
7531 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
7532 }
7533
7534 static void
image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)7535 image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_mod(const image_transform *this,
7536 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
7537 const transform_display *display)
7538 {
7539 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA)
7540 that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY;
7541 else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA)
7542 that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;
7543
7544 that->have_tRNS = 0;
7545 that->alphaf = 1;
7546
7547 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
7548 }
7549
7550 static int
image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)7551 image_transform_png_set_strip_alpha_add(image_transform *this,
7552 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
7553 {
7554 UNUSED(bit_depth)
7555
7556 this->next = *that;
7557 *that = this;
7558
7559 return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0;
7560 }
7561
7562 IT(strip_alpha);
7563 #undef PT
7564 #define PT ITSTRUCT(strip_alpha)
7565 #endif /* PNG_READ_STRIP_ALPHA_SUPPORTED */
7566
7567 #ifdef PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED
7568 /* png_set_rgb_to_gray(png_structp, int err_action, double red, double green)
7569 * png_set_rgb_to_gray_fixed(png_structp, int err_action, png_fixed_point red,
7570 * png_fixed_point green)
7571 * png_get_rgb_to_gray_status
7572 *
7573 * The 'default' test here uses values known to be used inside libpng prior to
7574 * 1.7.0:
7575 *
7576 * red: 6968
7577 * green: 23434
7578 * blue: 2366
7579 *
7580 * These values are being retained for compatibility, along with the somewhat
7581 * broken truncation calculation in the fast-and-inaccurate code path. Older
7582 * versions of libpng will fail the accuracy tests below because they use the
7583 * truncation algorithm everywhere.
7584 */
7585 #define data ITDATA(rgb_to_gray)
7586 static struct
7587 {
7588 double gamma; /* File gamma to use in processing */
7589
7590 /* The following are the parameters for png_set_rgb_to_gray: */
7591 # ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
7592 double red_to_set;
7593 double green_to_set;
7594 # else
7595 png_fixed_point red_to_set;
7596 png_fixed_point green_to_set;
7597 # endif
7598
7599 /* The actual coefficients: */
7600 double red_coefficient;
7601 double green_coefficient;
7602 double blue_coefficient;
7603
7604 /* Set if the coeefficients have been overridden. */
7605 int coefficients_overridden;
7606 } data;
7607
7608 #undef image_transform_ini
7609 #define image_transform_ini image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_ini
7610 static void
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_ini(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that)7611 image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_ini(const image_transform *this,
7612 transform_display *that)
7613 {
7614 png_modifier *pm = that->pm;
7615 const color_encoding *e = pm->current_encoding;
7616
7617 UNUSED(this)
7618
7619 /* Since we check the encoding this flag must be set: */
7620 pm->test_uses_encoding = 1;
7621
7622 /* If 'e' is not NULL chromaticity information is present and either a cHRM
7623 * or an sRGB chunk will be inserted.
7624 */
7625 if (e != 0)
7626 {
7627 /* Coefficients come from the encoding, but may need to be normalized to a
7628 * white point Y of 1.0
7629 */
7630 const double whiteY = e->red.Y + e->green.Y + e->blue.Y;
7631
7632 data.red_coefficient = e->red.Y;
7633 data.green_coefficient = e->green.Y;
7634 data.blue_coefficient = e->blue.Y;
7635
7636 if (whiteY != 1)
7637 {
7638 data.red_coefficient /= whiteY;
7639 data.green_coefficient /= whiteY;
7640 data.blue_coefficient /= whiteY;
7641 }
7642 }
7643
7644 else
7645 {
7646 /* The default (built in) coefficients, as above: */
7647 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
7648 data.red_coefficient = 6968 / 32768.;
7649 data.green_coefficient = 23434 / 32768.;
7650 data.blue_coefficient = 2366 / 32768.;
7651 # else
7652 data.red_coefficient = .2126;
7653 data.green_coefficient = .7152;
7654 data.blue_coefficient = .0722;
7655 # endif
7656 }
7657
7658 data.gamma = pm->current_gamma;
7659
7660 /* If not set then the calculations assume linear encoding (implicitly): */
7661 if (data.gamma == 0)
7662 data.gamma = 1;
7663
7664 /* The arguments to png_set_rgb_to_gray can override the coefficients implied
7665 * by the color space encoding. If doing exhaustive checks do the override
7666 * in each case, otherwise do it randomly.
7667 */
7668 if (pm->test_exhaustive)
7669 {
7670 /* First time in coefficients_overridden is 0, the following sets it to 1,
7671 * so repeat if it is set. If a test fails this may mean we subsequently
7672 * skip a non-override test, ignore that.
7673 */
7674 data.coefficients_overridden = !data.coefficients_overridden;
7675 pm->repeat = data.coefficients_overridden != 0;
7676 }
7677
7678 else
7679 data.coefficients_overridden = random_choice();
7680
7681 if (data.coefficients_overridden)
7682 {
7683 /* These values override the color encoding defaults, simply use random
7684 * numbers.
7685 */
7686 png_uint_32 ru;
7687 double total;
7688
7689 ru = random_u32();
7690 data.green_coefficient = total = (ru & 0xffff) / 65535.;
7691 ru >>= 16;
7692 data.red_coefficient = (1 - total) * (ru & 0xffff) / 65535.;
7693 total += data.red_coefficient;
7694 data.blue_coefficient = 1 - total;
7695
7696 # ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
7697 data.red_to_set = data.red_coefficient;
7698 data.green_to_set = data.green_coefficient;
7699 # else
7700 data.red_to_set = fix(data.red_coefficient);
7701 data.green_to_set = fix(data.green_coefficient);
7702 # endif
7703
7704 /* The following just changes the error messages: */
7705 pm->encoding_ignored = 1;
7706 }
7707
7708 else
7709 {
7710 data.red_to_set = -1;
7711 data.green_to_set = -1;
7712 }
7713
7714 /* Adjust the error limit in the png_modifier because of the larger errors
7715 * produced in the digitization during the gamma handling.
7716 */
7717 if (data.gamma != 1) /* Use gamma tables */
7718 {
7719 if (that->this.bit_depth == 16 || pm->assume_16_bit_calculations)
7720 {
7721 /* The computations have the form:
7722 *
7723 * r * rc + g * gc + b * bc
7724 *
7725 * Each component of which is +/-1/65535 from the gamma_to_1 table
7726 * lookup, resulting in a base error of +/-6. The gamma_from_1
7727 * conversion adds another +/-2 in the 16-bit case and
7728 * +/-(1<<(15-PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8)) in the 8-bit case.
7729 */
7730 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
7731 if (that->this.bit_depth < 16)
7732 that->max_gamma_8 = PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8;
7733 # endif
7734 that->pm->limit += pow(
7735 (that->this.bit_depth == 16 || that->max_gamma_8 > 14 ?
7736 8. :
7737 6. + (1<<(15-that->max_gamma_8))
7738 )/65535, data.gamma);
7739 }
7740
7741 else
7742 {
7743 /* Rounding to 8 bits in the linear space causes massive errors which
7744 * will trigger the error check in transform_range_check. Fix that
7745 * here by taking the gamma encoding into account.
7746 *
7747 * When DIGITIZE is set because a pre-1.7 version of libpng is being
7748 * tested allow a bigger slack.
7749 *
7750 * NOTE: this number only affects the internal limit check in pngvalid,
7751 * it has no effect on the limits applied to the libpng values.
7752 */
7753 #if DIGITIZE
7754 that->pm->limit += pow( 2.0/255, data.gamma);
7755 #else
7756 that->pm->limit += pow( 1.0/255, data.gamma);
7757 #endif
7758 }
7759 }
7760
7761 else
7762 {
7763 /* With no gamma correction a large error comes from the truncation of the
7764 * calculation in the 8 bit case, allow for that here.
7765 */
7766 if (that->this.bit_depth != 16 && !pm->assume_16_bit_calculations)
7767 that->pm->limit += 4E-3;
7768 }
7769 }
7770
7771 static void
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)7772 image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_set(const image_transform *this,
7773 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
7774 {
7775 int error_action = 1; /* no error, no defines in png.h */
7776
7777 # ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
7778 png_set_rgb_to_gray(pp, error_action, data.red_to_set, data.green_to_set);
7779 # else
7780 png_set_rgb_to_gray_fixed(pp, error_action, data.red_to_set,
7781 data.green_to_set);
7782 # endif
7783
7784 # ifdef PNG_READ_cHRM_SUPPORTED
7785 if (that->pm->current_encoding != 0)
7786 {
7787 /* We have an encoding so a cHRM chunk may have been set; if so then
7788 * check that the libpng APIs give the correct (X,Y,Z) values within
7789 * some margin of error for the round trip through the chromaticity
7790 * form.
7791 */
7792 # ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
7793 # define API_function png_get_cHRM_XYZ
7794 # define API_form "FP"
7795 # define API_type double
7796 # define API_cvt(x) (x)
7797 # else
7798 # define API_function png_get_cHRM_XYZ_fixed
7799 # define API_form "fixed"
7800 # define API_type png_fixed_point
7801 # define API_cvt(x) ((double)(x)/PNG_FP_1)
7802 # endif
7803
7804 API_type rX, gX, bX;
7805 API_type rY, gY, bY;
7806 API_type rZ, gZ, bZ;
7807
7808 if ((API_function(pp, pi, &rX, &rY, &rZ, &gX, &gY, &gZ, &bX, &bY, &bZ)
7809 & PNG_INFO_cHRM) != 0)
7810 {
7811 double maxe;
7812 const char *el;
7813 color_encoding e, o;
7814
7815 /* Expect libpng to return a normalized result, but the original
7816 * color space encoding may not be normalized.
7817 */
7818 modifier_current_encoding(that->pm, &o);
7819 normalize_color_encoding(&o);
7820
7821 /* Sanity check the pngvalid code - the coefficients should match
7822 * the normalized Y values of the encoding unless they were
7823 * overridden.
7824 */
7825 if (data.red_to_set == -1 && data.green_to_set == -1 &&
7826 (fabs(o.red.Y - data.red_coefficient) > DBL_EPSILON ||
7827 fabs(o.green.Y - data.green_coefficient) > DBL_EPSILON ||
7828 fabs(o.blue.Y - data.blue_coefficient) > DBL_EPSILON))
7829 png_error(pp, "internal pngvalid cHRM coefficient error");
7830
7831 /* Generate a colour space encoding. */
7832 e.gamma = o.gamma; /* not used */
7833 e.red.X = API_cvt(rX);
7834 e.red.Y = API_cvt(rY);
7835 e.red.Z = API_cvt(rZ);
7836 e.green.X = API_cvt(gX);
7837 e.green.Y = API_cvt(gY);
7838 e.green.Z = API_cvt(gZ);
7839 e.blue.X = API_cvt(bX);
7840 e.blue.Y = API_cvt(bY);
7841 e.blue.Z = API_cvt(bZ);
7842
7843 /* This should match the original one from the png_modifier, within
7844 * the range permitted by the libpng fixed point representation.
7845 */
7846 maxe = 0;
7847 el = "-"; /* Set to element name with error */
7848
7849 # define CHECK(col,x)\
7850 {\
7851 double err = fabs(o.col.x - e.col.x);\
7852 if (err > maxe)\
7853 {\
7854 maxe = err;\
7855 el = #col "(" #x ")";\
7856 }\
7857 }
7858
7859 CHECK(red,X)
7860 CHECK(red,Y)
7861 CHECK(red,Z)
7862 CHECK(green,X)
7863 CHECK(green,Y)
7864 CHECK(green,Z)
7865 CHECK(blue,X)
7866 CHECK(blue,Y)
7867 CHECK(blue,Z)
7868
7869 /* Here in both fixed and floating cases to check the values read
7870 * from the cHRm chunk. PNG uses fixed point in the cHRM chunk, so
7871 * we can't expect better than +/-.5E-5 on the result, allow 1E-5.
7872 */
7873 if (maxe >= 1E-5)
7874 {
7875 size_t pos = 0;
7876 char buffer[256];
7877
7878 pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, API_form);
7879 pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " cHRM ");
7880 pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, el);
7881 pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " error: ");
7882 pos = safecatd(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, maxe, 7);
7883 pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " ");
7884 /* Print the color space without the gamma value: */
7885 pos = safecat_color_encoding(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, &o, 0);
7886 pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " -> ");
7887 pos = safecat_color_encoding(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, &e, 0);
7888
7889 png_error(pp, buffer);
7890 }
7891 }
7892 }
7893 # endif /* READ_cHRM */
7894
7895 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
7896 }
7897
7898 static void
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)7899 image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_mod(const image_transform *this,
7900 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
7901 const transform_display *display)
7902 {
7903 if ((that->colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0)
7904 {
7905 double gray, err;
7906
7907 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
7908 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
7909 image_pixel_convert_PLTE(that);
7910 # endif
7911
7912 /* Image now has RGB channels... */
7913 # if DIGITIZE
7914 {
7915 png_modifier *pm = display->pm;
7916 unsigned int sample_depth = that->sample_depth;
7917 unsigned int calc_depth = (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations ? 16 :
7918 sample_depth);
7919 unsigned int gamma_depth =
7920 (sample_depth == 16 ?
7921 display->max_gamma_8 :
7922 (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations ?
7923 display->max_gamma_8 :
7924 sample_depth));
7925 int isgray;
7926 double r, g, b;
7927 double rlo, rhi, glo, ghi, blo, bhi, graylo, grayhi;
7928
7929 /* Do this using interval arithmetic, otherwise it is too difficult to
7930 * handle the errors correctly.
7931 *
7932 * To handle the gamma correction work out the upper and lower bounds
7933 * of the digitized value. Assume rounding here - normally the values
7934 * will be identical after this operation if there is only one
7935 * transform, feel free to delete the png_error checks on this below in
7936 * the future (this is just me trying to ensure it works!)
7937 *
7938 * Interval arithmetic is exact, but to implement it it must be
7939 * possible to control the floating point implementation rounding mode.
7940 * This cannot be done in ANSI-C, so instead I reduce the 'lo' values
7941 * by DBL_EPSILON and increase the 'hi' values by the same.
7942 */
7943 # define DD(v,d,r) (digitize(v*(1-DBL_EPSILON), d, r) * (1-DBL_EPSILON))
7944 # define DU(v,d,r) (digitize(v*(1+DBL_EPSILON), d, r) * (1+DBL_EPSILON))
7945
7946 r = rlo = rhi = that->redf;
7947 rlo -= that->rede;
7948 rlo = DD(rlo, calc_depth, 1/*round*/);
7949 rhi += that->rede;
7950 rhi = DU(rhi, calc_depth, 1/*round*/);
7951
7952 g = glo = ghi = that->greenf;
7953 glo -= that->greene;
7954 glo = DD(glo, calc_depth, 1/*round*/);
7955 ghi += that->greene;
7956 ghi = DU(ghi, calc_depth, 1/*round*/);
7957
7958 b = blo = bhi = that->bluef;
7959 blo -= that->bluee;
7960 blo = DD(blo, calc_depth, 1/*round*/);
7961 bhi += that->bluee;
7962 bhi = DU(bhi, calc_depth, 1/*round*/);
7963
7964 isgray = r==g && g==b;
7965
7966 if (data.gamma != 1)
7967 {
7968 const double power = 1/data.gamma;
7969 const double abse = .5/(sample_depth == 16 ? 65535 : 255);
7970
7971 /* If a gamma calculation is done it is done using lookup tables of
7972 * precision gamma_depth, so the already digitized value above may
7973 * need to be further digitized here.
7974 */
7975 if (gamma_depth != calc_depth)
7976 {
7977 rlo = DD(rlo, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
7978 rhi = DU(rhi, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
7979 glo = DD(glo, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
7980 ghi = DU(ghi, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
7981 blo = DD(blo, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
7982 bhi = DU(bhi, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
7983 }
7984
7985 /* 'abse' is the error in the gamma table calculation itself. */
7986 r = pow(r, power);
7987 rlo = DD(pow(rlo, power)-abse, calc_depth, 1);
7988 rhi = DU(pow(rhi, power)+abse, calc_depth, 1);
7989
7990 g = pow(g, power);
7991 glo = DD(pow(glo, power)-abse, calc_depth, 1);
7992 ghi = DU(pow(ghi, power)+abse, calc_depth, 1);
7993
7994 b = pow(b, power);
7995 blo = DD(pow(blo, power)-abse, calc_depth, 1);
7996 bhi = DU(pow(bhi, power)+abse, calc_depth, 1);
7997 }
7998
7999 /* Now calculate the actual gray values. Although the error in the
8000 * coefficients depends on whether they were specified on the command
8001 * line (in which case truncation to 15 bits happened) or not (rounding
8002 * was used) the maximum error in an individual coefficient is always
8003 * 2/32768, because even in the rounding case the requirement that
8004 * coefficients add up to 32768 can cause a larger rounding error.
8005 *
8006 * The only time when rounding doesn't occur in 1.5.5 and later is when
8007 * the non-gamma code path is used for less than 16 bit data.
8008 */
8009 gray = r * data.red_coefficient + g * data.green_coefficient +
8010 b * data.blue_coefficient;
8011
8012 {
8013 int do_round = data.gamma != 1 || calc_depth == 16;
8014 const double ce = 2. / 32768;
8015
8016 graylo = DD(rlo * (data.red_coefficient-ce) +
8017 glo * (data.green_coefficient-ce) +
8018 blo * (data.blue_coefficient-ce), calc_depth, do_round);
8019 if (graylo > gray) /* always accept the right answer */
8020 graylo = gray;
8021
8022 grayhi = DU(rhi * (data.red_coefficient+ce) +
8023 ghi * (data.green_coefficient+ce) +
8024 bhi * (data.blue_coefficient+ce), calc_depth, do_round);
8025 if (grayhi < gray)
8026 grayhi = gray;
8027 }
8028
8029 /* And invert the gamma. */
8030 if (data.gamma != 1)
8031 {
8032 const double power = data.gamma;
8033
8034 /* And this happens yet again, shifting the values once more. */
8035 if (gamma_depth != sample_depth)
8036 {
8037 rlo = DD(rlo, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
8038 rhi = DU(rhi, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
8039 glo = DD(glo, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
8040 ghi = DU(ghi, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
8041 blo = DD(blo, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
8042 bhi = DU(bhi, gamma_depth, 0/*truncate*/);
8043 }
8044
8045 gray = pow(gray, power);
8046 graylo = DD(pow(graylo, power), sample_depth, 1);
8047 grayhi = DU(pow(grayhi, power), sample_depth, 1);
8048 }
8049
8050 # undef DD
8051 # undef DU
8052
8053 /* Now the error can be calculated.
8054 *
8055 * If r==g==b because there is no overall gamma correction libpng
8056 * currently preserves the original value.
8057 */
8058 if (isgray)
8059 err = (that->rede + that->greene + that->bluee)/3;
8060
8061 else
8062 {
8063 err = fabs(grayhi-gray);
8064
8065 if (fabs(gray - graylo) > err)
8066 err = fabs(graylo-gray);
8067
8068 #if !RELEASE_BUILD
8069 /* Check that this worked: */
8070 if (err > pm->limit)
8071 {
8072 size_t pos = 0;
8073 char buffer[128];
8074
8075 pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, "rgb_to_gray error ");
8076 pos = safecatd(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, err, 6);
8077 pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " exceeds limit ");
8078 pos = safecatd(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, pm->limit, 6);
8079 png_warning(pp, buffer);
8080 pm->limit = err;
8081 }
8082 #endif /* !RELEASE_BUILD */
8083 }
8084 }
8085 # else /* !DIGITIZE */
8086 {
8087 double r = that->redf;
8088 double re = that->rede;
8089 double g = that->greenf;
8090 double ge = that->greene;
8091 double b = that->bluef;
8092 double be = that->bluee;
8093
8094 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
8095 /* The true gray case involves no math in earlier versions (not
8096 * true, there was some if gamma correction was happening too.)
8097 */
8098 if (r == g && r == b)
8099 {
8100 gray = r;
8101 err = re;
8102 if (err < ge) err = ge;
8103 if (err < be) err = be;
8104 }
8105
8106 else
8107 # endif /* before 1.7 */
8108 if (data.gamma == 1)
8109 {
8110 /* There is no need to do the conversions to and from linear space,
8111 * so the calculation should be a lot more accurate. There is a
8112 * built in error in the coefficients because they only have 15 bits
8113 * and are adjusted to make sure they add up to 32768. This
8114 * involves a integer calculation with truncation of the form:
8115 *
8116 * ((int)(coefficient * 100000) * 32768)/100000
8117 *
8118 * This is done to the red and green coefficients (the ones
8119 * provided to the API) then blue is calculated from them so the
8120 * result adds up to 32768. In the worst case this can result in
8121 * a -1 error in red and green and a +2 error in blue. Consequently
8122 * the worst case in the calculation below is 2/32768 error.
8123 *
8124 * TODO: consider fixing this in libpng by rounding the calculation
8125 * limiting the error to 1/32768.
8126 *
8127 * Handling this by adding 2/32768 here avoids needing to increase
8128 * the global error limits to take this into account.)
8129 */
8130 gray = r * data.red_coefficient + g * data.green_coefficient +
8131 b * data.blue_coefficient;
8132 err = re * data.red_coefficient + ge * data.green_coefficient +
8133 be * data.blue_coefficient + 2./32768 + gray * 5 * DBL_EPSILON;
8134 }
8135
8136 else
8137 {
8138 /* The calculation happens in linear space, and this produces much
8139 * wider errors in the encoded space. These are handled here by
8140 * factoring the errors in to the calculation. There are two table
8141 * lookups in the calculation and each introduces a quantization
8142 * error defined by the table size.
8143 */
8144 png_modifier *pm = display->pm;
8145 double in_qe = (that->sample_depth > 8 ? .5/65535 : .5/255);
8146 double out_qe = (that->sample_depth > 8 ? .5/65535 :
8147 (pm->assume_16_bit_calculations ? .5/(1<<display->max_gamma_8) :
8148 .5/255));
8149 double rhi, ghi, bhi, grayhi;
8150 double g1 = 1/data.gamma;
8151
8152 rhi = r + re + in_qe; if (rhi > 1) rhi = 1;
8153 r -= re + in_qe; if (r < 0) r = 0;
8154 ghi = g + ge + in_qe; if (ghi > 1) ghi = 1;
8155 g -= ge + in_qe; if (g < 0) g = 0;
8156 bhi = b + be + in_qe; if (bhi > 1) bhi = 1;
8157 b -= be + in_qe; if (b < 0) b = 0;
8158
8159 r = pow(r, g1)*(1-DBL_EPSILON); rhi = pow(rhi, g1)*(1+DBL_EPSILON);
8160 g = pow(g, g1)*(1-DBL_EPSILON); ghi = pow(ghi, g1)*(1+DBL_EPSILON);
8161 b = pow(b, g1)*(1-DBL_EPSILON); bhi = pow(bhi, g1)*(1+DBL_EPSILON);
8162
8163 /* Work out the lower and upper bounds for the gray value in the
8164 * encoded space, then work out an average and error. Remove the
8165 * previously added input quantization error at this point.
8166 */
8167 gray = r * data.red_coefficient + g * data.green_coefficient +
8168 b * data.blue_coefficient - 2./32768 - out_qe;
8169 if (gray <= 0)
8170 gray = 0;
8171 else
8172 {
8173 gray *= (1 - 6 * DBL_EPSILON);
8174 gray = pow(gray, data.gamma) * (1-DBL_EPSILON);
8175 }
8176
8177 grayhi = rhi * data.red_coefficient + ghi * data.green_coefficient +
8178 bhi * data.blue_coefficient + 2./32768 + out_qe;
8179 grayhi *= (1 + 6 * DBL_EPSILON);
8180 if (grayhi >= 1)
8181 grayhi = 1;
8182 else
8183 grayhi = pow(grayhi, data.gamma) * (1+DBL_EPSILON);
8184
8185 err = (grayhi - gray) / 2;
8186 gray = (grayhi + gray) / 2;
8187
8188 if (err <= in_qe)
8189 err = gray * DBL_EPSILON;
8190
8191 else
8192 err -= in_qe;
8193
8194 #if !RELEASE_BUILD
8195 /* Validate that the error is within limits (this has caused
8196 * problems before, it's much easier to detect them here.)
8197 */
8198 if (err > pm->limit)
8199 {
8200 size_t pos = 0;
8201 char buffer[128];
8202
8203 pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, "rgb_to_gray error ");
8204 pos = safecatd(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, err, 6);
8205 pos = safecat(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, " exceeds limit ");
8206 pos = safecatd(buffer, sizeof buffer, pos, pm->limit, 6);
8207 png_warning(pp, buffer);
8208 pm->limit = err;
8209 }
8210 #endif /* !RELEASE_BUILD */
8211 }
8212 }
8213 # endif /* !DIGITIZE */
8214
8215 that->bluef = that->greenf = that->redf = gray;
8216 that->bluee = that->greene = that->rede = err;
8217
8218 /* The sBIT is the minimum of the three colour channel sBITs. */
8219 if (that->red_sBIT > that->green_sBIT)
8220 that->red_sBIT = that->green_sBIT;
8221 if (that->red_sBIT > that->blue_sBIT)
8222 that->red_sBIT = that->blue_sBIT;
8223 that->blue_sBIT = that->green_sBIT = that->red_sBIT;
8224
8225 /* And remove the colour bit in the type: */
8226 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB)
8227 that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY;
8228 else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA)
8229 that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA;
8230 }
8231
8232 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8233 }
8234
8235 static int
image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8236 image_transform_png_set_rgb_to_gray_add(image_transform *this,
8237 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8238 {
8239 UNUSED(bit_depth)
8240
8241 this->next = *that;
8242 *that = this;
8243
8244 return (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) != 0;
8245 }
8246
8247 #undef data
8248 IT(rgb_to_gray);
8249 #undef PT
8250 #define PT ITSTRUCT(rgb_to_gray)
8251 #undef image_transform_ini
8252 #define image_transform_ini image_transform_default_ini
8253 #endif /* PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED */
8254
8255 #ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
8256 /* png_set_background(png_structp, png_const_color_16p background_color,
8257 * int background_gamma_code, int need_expand, double background_gamma)
8258 * png_set_background_fixed(png_structp, png_const_color_16p background_color,
8259 * int background_gamma_code, int need_expand,
8260 * png_fixed_point background_gamma)
8261 *
8262 * This ignores the gamma (at present.)
8263 */
8264 #define data ITDATA(background)
8265 static image_pixel data;
8266
8267 static void
image_transform_png_set_background_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8268 image_transform_png_set_background_set(const image_transform *this,
8269 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8270 {
8271 png_byte colour_type, bit_depth;
8272 png_byte random_bytes[8]; /* 8 bytes - 64 bits - the biggest pixel */
8273 int expand;
8274 png_color_16 back;
8275
8276 /* We need a background colour, because we don't know exactly what transforms
8277 * have been set we have to supply the colour in the original file format and
8278 * so we need to know what that is! The background colour is stored in the
8279 * transform_display.
8280 */
8281 R8(random_bytes);
8282
8283 /* Read the random value, for colour type 3 the background colour is actually
8284 * expressed as a 24bit rgb, not an index.
8285 */
8286 colour_type = that->this.colour_type;
8287 if (colour_type == 3)
8288 {
8289 colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;
8290 bit_depth = 8;
8291 expand = 0; /* passing in an RGB not a pixel index */
8292 }
8293
8294 else
8295 {
8296 if (that->this.has_tRNS)
8297 that->this.is_transparent = 1;
8298
8299 bit_depth = that->this.bit_depth;
8300 expand = 1;
8301 }
8302
8303 image_pixel_init(&data, random_bytes, colour_type,
8304 bit_depth, 0/*x*/, 0/*unused: palette*/, NULL/*format*/);
8305
8306 /* Extract the background colour from this image_pixel, but make sure the
8307 * unused fields of 'back' are garbage.
8308 */
8309 R8(back);
8310
8311 if (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
8312 {
8313 back.red = (png_uint_16)data.red;
8314 back.green = (png_uint_16)data.green;
8315 back.blue = (png_uint_16)data.blue;
8316 }
8317
8318 else
8319 back.gray = (png_uint_16)data.red;
8320
8321 #ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
8322 png_set_background(pp, &back, PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE, expand, 0);
8323 #else
8324 png_set_background_fixed(pp, &back, PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE, expand, 0);
8325 #endif
8326
8327 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8328 }
8329
8330 static void
image_transform_png_set_background_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8331 image_transform_png_set_background_mod(const image_transform *this,
8332 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8333 const transform_display *display)
8334 {
8335 /* Check for tRNS first: */
8336 if (that->have_tRNS && that->colour_type != PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
8337 image_pixel_add_alpha(that, &display->this, 1/*for background*/);
8338
8339 /* This is only necessary if the alpha value is less than 1. */
8340 if (that->alphaf < 1)
8341 {
8342 /* Now we do the background calculation without any gamma correction. */
8343 if (that->alphaf <= 0)
8344 {
8345 that->redf = data.redf;
8346 that->greenf = data.greenf;
8347 that->bluef = data.bluef;
8348
8349 that->rede = data.rede;
8350 that->greene = data.greene;
8351 that->bluee = data.bluee;
8352
8353 that->red_sBIT= data.red_sBIT;
8354 that->green_sBIT= data.green_sBIT;
8355 that->blue_sBIT= data.blue_sBIT;
8356 }
8357
8358 else /* 0 < alpha < 1 */
8359 {
8360 double alf = 1 - that->alphaf;
8361
8362 that->redf = that->redf * that->alphaf + data.redf * alf;
8363 that->rede = that->rede * that->alphaf + data.rede * alf +
8364 DBL_EPSILON;
8365 that->greenf = that->greenf * that->alphaf + data.greenf * alf;
8366 that->greene = that->greene * that->alphaf + data.greene * alf +
8367 DBL_EPSILON;
8368 that->bluef = that->bluef * that->alphaf + data.bluef * alf;
8369 that->bluee = that->bluee * that->alphaf + data.bluee * alf +
8370 DBL_EPSILON;
8371 }
8372
8373 /* Remove the alpha type and set the alpha (not in that order.) */
8374 that->alphaf = 1;
8375 that->alphae = 0;
8376 }
8377
8378 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB_ALPHA)
8379 that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB;
8380 else if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY_ALPHA)
8381 that->colour_type = PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY;
8382 /* PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE is not changed */
8383
8384 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8385 }
8386
8387 #define image_transform_png_set_background_add image_transform_default_add
8388
8389 #undef data
8390 IT(background);
8391 #undef PT
8392 #define PT ITSTRUCT(background)
8393 #endif /* PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED */
8394
8395 /* png_set_quantize(png_structp, png_colorp palette, int num_palette,
8396 * int maximum_colors, png_const_uint_16p histogram, int full_quantize)
8397 *
8398 * Very difficult to validate this!
8399 */
8400 /*NOTE: TBD NYI */
8401
8402 /* The data layout transforms are handled by swapping our own channel data,
8403 * necessarily these need to happen at the end of the transform list because the
8404 * semantic of the channels changes after these are executed. Some of these,
8405 * like set_shift and set_packing, can't be done at present because they change
8406 * the layout of the data at the sub-sample level so sample() won't get the
8407 * right answer.
8408 */
8409 /* png_set_invert_alpha */
8410 #ifdef PNG_READ_INVERT_ALPHA_SUPPORTED
8411 /* Invert the alpha channel
8412 *
8413 * png_set_invert_alpha(png_structrp png_ptr)
8414 */
8415 static void
image_transform_png_set_invert_alpha_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8416 image_transform_png_set_invert_alpha_set(const image_transform *this,
8417 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8418 {
8419 png_set_invert_alpha(pp);
8420 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8421 }
8422
8423 static void
image_transform_png_set_invert_alpha_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8424 image_transform_png_set_invert_alpha_mod(const image_transform *this,
8425 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8426 const transform_display *display)
8427 {
8428 if (that->colour_type & 4)
8429 that->alpha_inverted = 1;
8430
8431 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8432 }
8433
8434 static int
image_transform_png_set_invert_alpha_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8435 image_transform_png_set_invert_alpha_add(image_transform *this,
8436 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8437 {
8438 UNUSED(bit_depth)
8439
8440 this->next = *that;
8441 *that = this;
8442
8443 /* Only has an effect on pixels with alpha: */
8444 return (colour_type & 4) != 0;
8445 }
8446
8447 IT(invert_alpha);
8448 #undef PT
8449 #define PT ITSTRUCT(invert_alpha)
8450
8451 #endif /* PNG_READ_INVERT_ALPHA_SUPPORTED */
8452
8453 /* png_set_bgr */
8454 #ifdef PNG_READ_BGR_SUPPORTED
8455 /* Swap R,G,B channels to order B,G,R.
8456 *
8457 * png_set_bgr(png_structrp png_ptr)
8458 *
8459 * This only has an effect on RGB and RGBA pixels.
8460 */
8461 static void
image_transform_png_set_bgr_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8462 image_transform_png_set_bgr_set(const image_transform *this,
8463 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8464 {
8465 png_set_bgr(pp);
8466 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8467 }
8468
8469 static void
image_transform_png_set_bgr_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8470 image_transform_png_set_bgr_mod(const image_transform *this,
8471 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8472 const transform_display *display)
8473 {
8474 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB ||
8475 that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGBA)
8476 that->swap_rgb = 1;
8477
8478 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8479 }
8480
8481 static int
image_transform_png_set_bgr_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8482 image_transform_png_set_bgr_add(image_transform *this,
8483 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8484 {
8485 UNUSED(bit_depth)
8486
8487 this->next = *that;
8488 *that = this;
8489
8490 return colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB ||
8491 colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGBA;
8492 }
8493
8494 IT(bgr);
8495 #undef PT
8496 #define PT ITSTRUCT(bgr)
8497
8498 #endif /* PNG_READ_BGR_SUPPORTED */
8499
8500 /* png_set_swap_alpha */
8501 #ifdef PNG_READ_SWAP_ALPHA_SUPPORTED
8502 /* Put the alpha channel first.
8503 *
8504 * png_set_swap_alpha(png_structrp png_ptr)
8505 *
8506 * This only has an effect on GA and RGBA pixels.
8507 */
8508 static void
image_transform_png_set_swap_alpha_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8509 image_transform_png_set_swap_alpha_set(const image_transform *this,
8510 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8511 {
8512 png_set_swap_alpha(pp);
8513 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8514 }
8515
8516 static void
image_transform_png_set_swap_alpha_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8517 image_transform_png_set_swap_alpha_mod(const image_transform *this,
8518 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8519 const transform_display *display)
8520 {
8521 if (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GA ||
8522 that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGBA)
8523 that->alpha_first = 1;
8524
8525 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8526 }
8527
8528 static int
image_transform_png_set_swap_alpha_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8529 image_transform_png_set_swap_alpha_add(image_transform *this,
8530 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8531 {
8532 UNUSED(bit_depth)
8533
8534 this->next = *that;
8535 *that = this;
8536
8537 return colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GA ||
8538 colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGBA;
8539 }
8540
8541 IT(swap_alpha);
8542 #undef PT
8543 #define PT ITSTRUCT(swap_alpha)
8544
8545 #endif /* PNG_READ_SWAP_ALPHA_SUPPORTED */
8546
8547 /* png_set_swap */
8548 #ifdef PNG_READ_SWAP_SUPPORTED
8549 /* Byte swap 16-bit components.
8550 *
8551 * png_set_swap(png_structrp png_ptr)
8552 */
8553 static void
image_transform_png_set_swap_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8554 image_transform_png_set_swap_set(const image_transform *this,
8555 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8556 {
8557 png_set_swap(pp);
8558 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8559 }
8560
8561 static void
image_transform_png_set_swap_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8562 image_transform_png_set_swap_mod(const image_transform *this,
8563 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8564 const transform_display *display)
8565 {
8566 if (that->bit_depth == 16)
8567 that->swap16 = 1;
8568
8569 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8570 }
8571
8572 static int
image_transform_png_set_swap_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8573 image_transform_png_set_swap_add(image_transform *this,
8574 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8575 {
8576 UNUSED(colour_type)
8577
8578 this->next = *that;
8579 *that = this;
8580
8581 return bit_depth == 16;
8582 }
8583
8584 IT(swap);
8585 #undef PT
8586 #define PT ITSTRUCT(swap)
8587
8588 #endif /* PNG_READ_SWAP_SUPPORTED */
8589
8590 #ifdef PNG_READ_FILLER_SUPPORTED
8591 /* Add a filler byte to 8-bit Gray or 24-bit RGB images.
8592 *
8593 * png_set_filler, (png_structp png_ptr, png_uint_32 filler, int flags));
8594 *
8595 * Flags:
8596 *
8597 * PNG_FILLER_BEFORE
8598 * PNG_FILLER_AFTER
8599 */
8600 #define data ITDATA(filler)
8601 static struct
8602 {
8603 png_uint_32 filler;
8604 int flags;
8605 } data;
8606
8607 static void
image_transform_png_set_filler_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8608 image_transform_png_set_filler_set(const image_transform *this,
8609 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8610 {
8611 /* Need a random choice for 'before' and 'after' as well as for the
8612 * filler. The 'filler' value has all 32 bits set, but only bit_depth
8613 * will be used. At this point we don't know bit_depth.
8614 */
8615 data.filler = random_u32();
8616 data.flags = random_choice();
8617
8618 png_set_filler(pp, data.filler, data.flags);
8619
8620 /* The standard display handling stuff also needs to know that
8621 * there is a filler, so set that here.
8622 */
8623 that->this.filler = 1;
8624
8625 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8626 }
8627
8628 static void
image_transform_png_set_filler_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8629 image_transform_png_set_filler_mod(const image_transform *this,
8630 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8631 const transform_display *display)
8632 {
8633 if (that->bit_depth >= 8 &&
8634 (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB ||
8635 that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY))
8636 {
8637 unsigned int max = (1U << that->bit_depth)-1;
8638 that->alpha = data.filler & max;
8639 that->alphaf = ((double)that->alpha) / max;
8640 that->alphae = 0;
8641
8642 /* The filler has been stored in the alpha channel, we must record
8643 * that this has been done for the checking later on, the color
8644 * type is faked to have an alpha channel, but libpng won't report
8645 * this; the app has to know the extra channel is there and this
8646 * was recording in standard_display::filler above.
8647 */
8648 that->colour_type |= 4; /* alpha added */
8649 that->alpha_first = data.flags == PNG_FILLER_BEFORE;
8650 }
8651
8652 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8653 }
8654
8655 static int
image_transform_png_set_filler_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8656 image_transform_png_set_filler_add(image_transform *this,
8657 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8658 {
8659 this->next = *that;
8660 *that = this;
8661
8662 return bit_depth >= 8 && (colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB ||
8663 colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY);
8664 }
8665
8666 #undef data
8667 IT(filler);
8668 #undef PT
8669 #define PT ITSTRUCT(filler)
8670
8671 /* png_set_add_alpha, (png_structp png_ptr, png_uint_32 filler, int flags)); */
8672 /* Add an alpha byte to 8-bit Gray or 24-bit RGB images. */
8673 #define data ITDATA(add_alpha)
8674 static struct
8675 {
8676 png_uint_32 filler;
8677 int flags;
8678 } data;
8679
8680 static void
image_transform_png_set_add_alpha_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8681 image_transform_png_set_add_alpha_set(const image_transform *this,
8682 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8683 {
8684 /* Need a random choice for 'before' and 'after' as well as for the
8685 * filler. The 'filler' value has all 32 bits set, but only bit_depth
8686 * will be used. At this point we don't know bit_depth.
8687 */
8688 data.filler = random_u32();
8689 data.flags = random_choice();
8690
8691 png_set_add_alpha(pp, data.filler, data.flags);
8692 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8693 }
8694
8695 static void
image_transform_png_set_add_alpha_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8696 image_transform_png_set_add_alpha_mod(const image_transform *this,
8697 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8698 const transform_display *display)
8699 {
8700 if (that->bit_depth >= 8 &&
8701 (that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB ||
8702 that->colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY))
8703 {
8704 unsigned int max = (1U << that->bit_depth)-1;
8705 that->alpha = data.filler & max;
8706 that->alphaf = ((double)that->alpha) / max;
8707 that->alphae = 0;
8708
8709 that->colour_type |= 4; /* alpha added */
8710 that->alpha_first = data.flags == PNG_FILLER_BEFORE;
8711 }
8712
8713 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8714 }
8715
8716 static int
image_transform_png_set_add_alpha_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8717 image_transform_png_set_add_alpha_add(image_transform *this,
8718 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8719 {
8720 this->next = *that;
8721 *that = this;
8722
8723 return bit_depth >= 8 && (colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_RGB ||
8724 colour_type == PNG_COLOR_TYPE_GRAY);
8725 }
8726
8727 #undef data
8728 IT(add_alpha);
8729 #undef PT
8730 #define PT ITSTRUCT(add_alpha)
8731
8732 #endif /* PNG_READ_FILLER_SUPPORTED */
8733
8734 /* png_set_packing */
8735 #ifdef PNG_READ_PACK_SUPPORTED
8736 /* Use 1 byte per pixel in 1, 2, or 4-bit depth files.
8737 *
8738 * png_set_packing(png_structrp png_ptr)
8739 *
8740 * This should only affect grayscale and palette images with less than 8 bits
8741 * per pixel.
8742 */
8743 static void
image_transform_png_set_packing_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8744 image_transform_png_set_packing_set(const image_transform *this,
8745 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8746 {
8747 png_set_packing(pp);
8748 that->unpacked = 1;
8749 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8750 }
8751
8752 static void
image_transform_png_set_packing_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8753 image_transform_png_set_packing_mod(const image_transform *this,
8754 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8755 const transform_display *display)
8756 {
8757 /* The general expand case depends on what the colour type is,
8758 * low bit-depth pixel values are unpacked into bytes without
8759 * scaling, so sample_depth is not changed.
8760 */
8761 if (that->bit_depth < 8) /* grayscale or palette */
8762 that->bit_depth = 8;
8763
8764 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8765 }
8766
8767 static int
image_transform_png_set_packing_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8768 image_transform_png_set_packing_add(image_transform *this,
8769 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8770 {
8771 UNUSED(colour_type)
8772
8773 this->next = *that;
8774 *that = this;
8775
8776 /* Nothing should happen unless the bit depth is less than 8: */
8777 return bit_depth < 8;
8778 }
8779
8780 IT(packing);
8781 #undef PT
8782 #define PT ITSTRUCT(packing)
8783
8784 #endif /* PNG_READ_PACK_SUPPORTED */
8785
8786 /* png_set_packswap */
8787 #ifdef PNG_READ_PACKSWAP_SUPPORTED
8788 /* Swap pixels packed into bytes; reverses the order on screen so that
8789 * the high order bits correspond to the rightmost pixels.
8790 *
8791 * png_set_packswap(png_structrp png_ptr)
8792 */
8793 static void
image_transform_png_set_packswap_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8794 image_transform_png_set_packswap_set(const image_transform *this,
8795 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8796 {
8797 png_set_packswap(pp);
8798 that->this.littleendian = 1;
8799 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8800 }
8801
8802 static void
image_transform_png_set_packswap_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8803 image_transform_png_set_packswap_mod(const image_transform *this,
8804 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8805 const transform_display *display)
8806 {
8807 if (that->bit_depth < 8)
8808 that->littleendian = 1;
8809
8810 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8811 }
8812
8813 static int
image_transform_png_set_packswap_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8814 image_transform_png_set_packswap_add(image_transform *this,
8815 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8816 {
8817 UNUSED(colour_type)
8818
8819 this->next = *that;
8820 *that = this;
8821
8822 return bit_depth < 8;
8823 }
8824
8825 IT(packswap);
8826 #undef PT
8827 #define PT ITSTRUCT(packswap)
8828
8829 #endif /* PNG_READ_PACKSWAP_SUPPORTED */
8830
8831
8832 /* png_set_invert_mono */
8833 #ifdef PNG_READ_INVERT_MONO_SUPPORTED
8834 /* Invert the gray channel
8835 *
8836 * png_set_invert_mono(png_structrp png_ptr)
8837 */
8838 static void
image_transform_png_set_invert_mono_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8839 image_transform_png_set_invert_mono_set(const image_transform *this,
8840 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8841 {
8842 png_set_invert_mono(pp);
8843 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8844 }
8845
8846 static void
image_transform_png_set_invert_mono_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8847 image_transform_png_set_invert_mono_mod(const image_transform *this,
8848 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8849 const transform_display *display)
8850 {
8851 if (that->colour_type & 4)
8852 that->mono_inverted = 1;
8853
8854 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8855 }
8856
8857 static int
image_transform_png_set_invert_mono_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8858 image_transform_png_set_invert_mono_add(image_transform *this,
8859 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8860 {
8861 UNUSED(bit_depth)
8862
8863 this->next = *that;
8864 *that = this;
8865
8866 /* Only has an effect on pixels with no colour: */
8867 return (colour_type & 2) == 0;
8868 }
8869
8870 IT(invert_mono);
8871 #undef PT
8872 #define PT ITSTRUCT(invert_mono)
8873
8874 #endif /* PNG_READ_INVERT_MONO_SUPPORTED */
8875
8876 #ifdef PNG_READ_SHIFT_SUPPORTED
8877 /* png_set_shift(png_structp, png_const_color_8p true_bits)
8878 *
8879 * The output pixels will be shifted by the given true_bits
8880 * values.
8881 */
8882 #define data ITDATA(shift)
8883 static png_color_8 data;
8884
8885 static void
image_transform_png_set_shift_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8886 image_transform_png_set_shift_set(const image_transform *this,
8887 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8888 {
8889 /* Get a random set of shifts. The shifts need to do something
8890 * to test the transform, so they are limited to the bit depth
8891 * of the input image. Notice that in the following the 'gray'
8892 * field is randomized independently. This acts as a check that
8893 * libpng does use the correct field.
8894 */
8895 unsigned int depth = that->this.bit_depth;
8896
8897 data.red = (png_byte)/*SAFE*/(random_mod(depth)+1);
8898 data.green = (png_byte)/*SAFE*/(random_mod(depth)+1);
8899 data.blue = (png_byte)/*SAFE*/(random_mod(depth)+1);
8900 data.gray = (png_byte)/*SAFE*/(random_mod(depth)+1);
8901 data.alpha = (png_byte)/*SAFE*/(random_mod(depth)+1);
8902
8903 png_set_shift(pp, &data);
8904 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8905 }
8906
8907 static void
image_transform_png_set_shift_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8908 image_transform_png_set_shift_mod(const image_transform *this,
8909 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8910 const transform_display *display)
8911 {
8912 /* Copy the correct values into the sBIT fields, libpng does not do
8913 * anything to palette data:
8914 */
8915 if (that->colour_type != PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE)
8916 {
8917 that->sig_bits = 1;
8918
8919 /* The sBIT fields are reset to the values previously sent to
8920 * png_set_shift according to the colour type.
8921 * does.
8922 */
8923 if (that->colour_type & 2) /* RGB channels */
8924 {
8925 that->red_sBIT = data.red;
8926 that->green_sBIT = data.green;
8927 that->blue_sBIT = data.blue;
8928 }
8929
8930 else /* One grey channel */
8931 that->red_sBIT = that->green_sBIT = that->blue_sBIT = data.gray;
8932
8933 that->alpha_sBIT = data.alpha;
8934 }
8935
8936 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8937 }
8938
8939 static int
image_transform_png_set_shift_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8940 image_transform_png_set_shift_add(image_transform *this,
8941 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8942 {
8943 UNUSED(bit_depth)
8944
8945 this->next = *that;
8946 *that = this;
8947
8948 return colour_type != PNG_COLOR_TYPE_PALETTE;
8949 }
8950
8951 IT(shift);
8952 #undef PT
8953 #define PT ITSTRUCT(shift)
8954
8955 #endif /* PNG_READ_SHIFT_SUPPORTED */
8956
8957 #ifdef THIS_IS_THE_PROFORMA
8958 static void
_set(const image_transform * this,transform_display * that,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)8959 image_transform_png_set_@_set(const image_transform *this,
8960 transform_display *that, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
8961 {
8962 png_set_@(pp);
8963 this->next->set(this->next, that, pp, pi);
8964 }
8965
8966 static void
_mod(const image_transform * this,image_pixel * that,png_const_structp pp,const transform_display * display)8967 image_transform_png_set_@_mod(const image_transform *this,
8968 image_pixel *that, png_const_structp pp,
8969 const transform_display *display)
8970 {
8971 this->next->mod(this->next, that, pp, display);
8972 }
8973
8974 static int
_add(image_transform * this,const image_transform ** that,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)8975 image_transform_png_set_@_add(image_transform *this,
8976 const image_transform **that, png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
8977 {
8978 this->next = *that;
8979 *that = this;
8980
8981 return 1;
8982 }
8983
8984 IT(@);
8985 #endif
8986
8987
8988 /* This may just be 'end' if all the transforms are disabled! */
8989 static image_transform *const image_transform_first = &PT;
8990
8991 static void
transform_enable(const char * name)8992 transform_enable(const char *name)
8993 {
8994 /* Everything starts out enabled, so if we see an 'enable' disabled
8995 * everything else the first time round.
8996 */
8997 static int all_disabled = 0;
8998 int found_it = 0;
8999 image_transform *list = image_transform_first;
9000
9001 while (list != &image_transform_end)
9002 {
9003 if (strcmp(list->name, name) == 0)
9004 {
9005 list->enable = 1;
9006 found_it = 1;
9007 }
9008 else if (!all_disabled)
9009 list->enable = 0;
9010
9011 list = list->list;
9012 }
9013
9014 all_disabled = 1;
9015
9016 if (!found_it)
9017 {
9018 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: --transform-enable=%s: unknown transform\n",
9019 name);
9020 exit(99);
9021 }
9022 }
9023
9024 static void
transform_disable(const char * name)9025 transform_disable(const char *name)
9026 {
9027 image_transform *list = image_transform_first;
9028
9029 while (list != &image_transform_end)
9030 {
9031 if (strcmp(list->name, name) == 0)
9032 {
9033 list->enable = 0;
9034 return;
9035 }
9036
9037 list = list->list;
9038 }
9039
9040 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: --transform-disable=%s: unknown transform\n",
9041 name);
9042 exit(99);
9043 }
9044
9045 static void
image_transform_reset_count(void)9046 image_transform_reset_count(void)
9047 {
9048 image_transform *next = image_transform_first;
9049 int count = 0;
9050
9051 while (next != &image_transform_end)
9052 {
9053 next->local_use = 0;
9054 next->next = 0;
9055 next = next->list;
9056 ++count;
9057 }
9058
9059 /* This can only happen if we every have more than 32 transforms (excluding
9060 * the end) in the list.
9061 */
9062 if (count > 32) abort();
9063 }
9064
9065 static int
image_transform_test_counter(png_uint_32 counter,unsigned int max)9066 image_transform_test_counter(png_uint_32 counter, unsigned int max)
9067 {
9068 /* Test the list to see if there is any point contining, given a current
9069 * counter and a 'max' value.
9070 */
9071 image_transform *next = image_transform_first;
9072
9073 while (next != &image_transform_end)
9074 {
9075 /* For max 0 or 1 continue until the counter overflows: */
9076 counter >>= 1;
9077
9078 /* Continue if any entry hasn't reacked the max. */
9079 if (max > 1 && next->local_use < max)
9080 return 1;
9081 next = next->list;
9082 }
9083
9084 return max <= 1 && counter == 0;
9085 }
9086
9087 static png_uint_32
image_transform_add(const image_transform ** this,unsigned int max,png_uint_32 counter,char * name,size_t sizeof_name,size_t * pos,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth)9088 image_transform_add(const image_transform **this, unsigned int max,
9089 png_uint_32 counter, char *name, size_t sizeof_name, size_t *pos,
9090 png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth)
9091 {
9092 for (;;) /* until we manage to add something */
9093 {
9094 png_uint_32 mask;
9095 image_transform *list;
9096
9097 /* Find the next counter value, if the counter is zero this is the start
9098 * of the list. This routine always returns the current counter (not the
9099 * next) so it returns 0 at the end and expects 0 at the beginning.
9100 */
9101 if (counter == 0) /* first time */
9102 {
9103 image_transform_reset_count();
9104 if (max <= 1)
9105 counter = 1;
9106 else
9107 counter = random_32();
9108 }
9109 else /* advance the counter */
9110 {
9111 switch (max)
9112 {
9113 case 0: ++counter; break;
9114 case 1: counter <<= 1; break;
9115 default: counter = random_32(); break;
9116 }
9117 }
9118
9119 /* Now add all these items, if possible */
9120 *this = &image_transform_end;
9121 list = image_transform_first;
9122 mask = 1;
9123
9124 /* Go through the whole list adding anything that the counter selects: */
9125 while (list != &image_transform_end)
9126 {
9127 if ((counter & mask) != 0 && list->enable &&
9128 (max == 0 || list->local_use < max))
9129 {
9130 /* Candidate to add: */
9131 if (list->add(list, this, colour_type, bit_depth) || max == 0)
9132 {
9133 /* Added, so add to the name too. */
9134 *pos = safecat(name, sizeof_name, *pos, " +");
9135 *pos = safecat(name, sizeof_name, *pos, list->name);
9136 }
9137
9138 else
9139 {
9140 /* Not useful and max>0, so remove it from *this: */
9141 *this = list->next;
9142 list->next = 0;
9143
9144 /* And, since we know it isn't useful, stop it being added again
9145 * in this run:
9146 */
9147 list->local_use = max;
9148 }
9149 }
9150
9151 mask <<= 1;
9152 list = list->list;
9153 }
9154
9155 /* Now if anything was added we have something to do. */
9156 if (*this != &image_transform_end)
9157 return counter;
9158
9159 /* Nothing added, but was there anything in there to add? */
9160 if (!image_transform_test_counter(counter, max))
9161 return 0;
9162 }
9163 }
9164
9165 static void
perform_transform_test(png_modifier * pm)9166 perform_transform_test(png_modifier *pm)
9167 {
9168 png_byte colour_type = 0;
9169 png_byte bit_depth = 0;
9170 unsigned int palette_number = 0;
9171
9172 while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number, pm->test_lbg,
9173 pm->test_tRNS))
9174 {
9175 png_uint_32 counter = 0;
9176 size_t base_pos;
9177 char name[64];
9178
9179 base_pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, 0, "transform:");
9180
9181 for (;;)
9182 {
9183 size_t pos = base_pos;
9184 const image_transform *list = 0;
9185
9186 /* 'max' is currently hardwired to '1'; this should be settable on the
9187 * command line.
9188 */
9189 counter = image_transform_add(&list, 1/*max*/, counter,
9190 name, sizeof name, &pos, colour_type, bit_depth);
9191
9192 if (counter == 0)
9193 break;
9194
9195 /* The command line can change this to checking interlaced images. */
9196 do
9197 {
9198 pm->repeat = 0;
9199 transform_test(pm, FILEID(colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
9200 pm->interlace_type, 0, 0, 0), list, name);
9201
9202 if (fail(pm))
9203 return;
9204 }
9205 while (pm->repeat);
9206 }
9207 }
9208 }
9209 #endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
9210
9211 /********************************* GAMMA TESTS ********************************/
9212 #ifdef PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED
9213 /* Reader callbacks and implementations, where they differ from the standard
9214 * ones.
9215 */
9216 typedef struct gamma_display
9217 {
9218 standard_display this;
9219
9220 /* Parameters */
9221 png_modifier* pm;
9222 double file_gamma;
9223 double screen_gamma;
9224 double background_gamma;
9225 png_byte sbit;
9226 int threshold_test;
9227 int use_input_precision;
9228 int scale16;
9229 int expand16;
9230 int do_background;
9231 png_color_16 background_color;
9232
9233 /* Local variables */
9234 double maxerrout;
9235 double maxerrpc;
9236 double maxerrabs;
9237 } gamma_display;
9238
9239 #define ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET 4
9240
9241 static void
gamma_display_init(gamma_display * dp,png_modifier * pm,png_uint_32 id,double file_gamma,double screen_gamma,png_byte sbit,int threshold_test,int use_input_precision,int scale16,int expand16,int do_background,const png_color_16 * pointer_to_the_background_color,double background_gamma)9242 gamma_display_init(gamma_display *dp, png_modifier *pm, png_uint_32 id,
9243 double file_gamma, double screen_gamma, png_byte sbit, int threshold_test,
9244 int use_input_precision, int scale16, int expand16,
9245 int do_background, const png_color_16 *pointer_to_the_background_color,
9246 double background_gamma)
9247 {
9248 /* Standard fields */
9249 standard_display_init(&dp->this, &pm->this, id, do_read_interlace,
9250 pm->use_update_info);
9251
9252 /* Parameter fields */
9253 dp->pm = pm;
9254 dp->file_gamma = file_gamma;
9255 dp->screen_gamma = screen_gamma;
9256 dp->background_gamma = background_gamma;
9257 dp->sbit = sbit;
9258 dp->threshold_test = threshold_test;
9259 dp->use_input_precision = use_input_precision;
9260 dp->scale16 = scale16;
9261 dp->expand16 = expand16;
9262 dp->do_background = do_background;
9263 if (do_background && pointer_to_the_background_color != 0)
9264 dp->background_color = *pointer_to_the_background_color;
9265 else
9266 memset(&dp->background_color, 0, sizeof dp->background_color);
9267
9268 /* Local variable fields */
9269 dp->maxerrout = dp->maxerrpc = dp->maxerrabs = 0;
9270 }
9271
9272 static void
gamma_info_imp(gamma_display * dp,png_structp pp,png_infop pi)9273 gamma_info_imp(gamma_display *dp, png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
9274 {
9275 /* Reuse the standard stuff as appropriate. */
9276 standard_info_part1(&dp->this, pp, pi);
9277
9278 /* If requested strip 16 to 8 bits - this is handled automagically below
9279 * because the output bit depth is read from the library. Note that there
9280 * are interactions with sBIT but, internally, libpng makes sbit at most
9281 * PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8 prior to 1.7 when doing the following.
9282 */
9283 if (dp->scale16)
9284 # ifdef PNG_READ_SCALE_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED
9285 png_set_scale_16(pp);
9286 # else
9287 /* The following works both in 1.5.4 and earlier versions: */
9288 # ifdef PNG_READ_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED
9289 png_set_strip_16(pp);
9290 # else
9291 png_error(pp, "scale16 (16 to 8 bit conversion) not supported");
9292 # endif
9293 # endif
9294
9295 if (dp->expand16)
9296 # ifdef PNG_READ_EXPAND_16_SUPPORTED
9297 png_set_expand_16(pp);
9298 # else
9299 png_error(pp, "expand16 (8 to 16 bit conversion) not supported");
9300 # endif
9301
9302 if (dp->do_background >= ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET)
9303 {
9304 # ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
9305 {
9306 /* This tests the alpha mode handling, if supported. */
9307 int mode = dp->do_background - ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET;
9308
9309 /* The gamma value is the output gamma, and is in the standard,
9310 * non-inverted, representation. It provides a default for the PNG file
9311 * gamma, but since the file has a gAMA chunk this does not matter.
9312 */
9313 const double sg = dp->screen_gamma;
9314 # ifndef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
9315 png_fixed_point g = fix(sg);
9316 # endif
9317
9318 # ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
9319 png_set_alpha_mode(pp, mode, sg);
9320 # else
9321 png_set_alpha_mode_fixed(pp, mode, g);
9322 # endif
9323
9324 /* However, for the standard Porter-Duff algorithm the output defaults
9325 * to be linear, so if the test requires non-linear output it must be
9326 * corrected here.
9327 */
9328 if (mode == PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD && sg != 1)
9329 {
9330 # ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
9331 png_set_gamma(pp, sg, dp->file_gamma);
9332 # else
9333 png_fixed_point f = fix(dp->file_gamma);
9334 png_set_gamma_fixed(pp, g, f);
9335 # endif
9336 }
9337 }
9338 # else
9339 png_error(pp, "alpha mode handling not supported");
9340 # endif
9341 }
9342
9343 else
9344 {
9345 /* Set up gamma processing. */
9346 # ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
9347 png_set_gamma(pp, dp->screen_gamma, dp->file_gamma);
9348 # else
9349 {
9350 png_fixed_point s = fix(dp->screen_gamma);
9351 png_fixed_point f = fix(dp->file_gamma);
9352 png_set_gamma_fixed(pp, s, f);
9353 }
9354 # endif
9355
9356 if (dp->do_background)
9357 {
9358 # ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
9359 /* NOTE: this assumes the caller provided the correct background gamma!
9360 */
9361 const double bg = dp->background_gamma;
9362 # ifndef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
9363 png_fixed_point g = fix(bg);
9364 # endif
9365
9366 # ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
9367 png_set_background(pp, &dp->background_color, dp->do_background,
9368 0/*need_expand*/, bg);
9369 # else
9370 png_set_background_fixed(pp, &dp->background_color,
9371 dp->do_background, 0/*need_expand*/, g);
9372 # endif
9373 # else
9374 png_error(pp, "png_set_background not supported");
9375 # endif
9376 }
9377 }
9378
9379 {
9380 int i = dp->this.use_update_info;
9381 /* Always do one call, even if use_update_info is 0. */
9382 do
9383 png_read_update_info(pp, pi);
9384 while (--i > 0);
9385 }
9386
9387 /* Now we may get a different cbRow: */
9388 standard_info_part2(&dp->this, pp, pi, 1 /*images*/);
9389 }
9390
9391 static void PNGCBAPI
gamma_info(png_structp pp,png_infop pi)9392 gamma_info(png_structp pp, png_infop pi)
9393 {
9394 gamma_info_imp(voidcast(gamma_display*, png_get_progressive_ptr(pp)), pp,
9395 pi);
9396 }
9397
9398 /* Validate a single component value - the routine gets the input and output
9399 * sample values as unscaled PNG component values along with a cache of all the
9400 * information required to validate the values.
9401 */
9402 typedef struct validate_info
9403 {
9404 png_const_structp pp;
9405 gamma_display *dp;
9406 png_byte sbit;
9407 int use_input_precision;
9408 int do_background;
9409 int scale16;
9410 unsigned int sbit_max;
9411 unsigned int isbit_shift;
9412 unsigned int outmax;
9413
9414 double gamma_correction; /* Overall correction required. */
9415 double file_inverse; /* Inverse of file gamma. */
9416 double screen_gamma;
9417 double screen_inverse; /* Inverse of screen gamma. */
9418
9419 double background_red; /* Linear background value, red or gray. */
9420 double background_green;
9421 double background_blue;
9422
9423 double maxabs;
9424 double maxpc;
9425 double maxcalc;
9426 double maxout;
9427 double maxout_total; /* Total including quantization error */
9428 double outlog;
9429 int outquant;
9430 }
9431 validate_info;
9432
9433 static void
init_validate_info(validate_info * vi,gamma_display * dp,png_const_structp pp,int in_depth,int out_depth)9434 init_validate_info(validate_info *vi, gamma_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
9435 int in_depth, int out_depth)
9436 {
9437 unsigned int outmax = (1U<<out_depth)-1;
9438
9439 vi->pp = pp;
9440 vi->dp = dp;
9441
9442 if (dp->sbit > 0 && dp->sbit < in_depth)
9443 {
9444 vi->sbit = dp->sbit;
9445 vi->isbit_shift = in_depth - dp->sbit;
9446 }
9447
9448 else
9449 {
9450 vi->sbit = (png_byte)in_depth;
9451 vi->isbit_shift = 0;
9452 }
9453
9454 vi->sbit_max = (1U << vi->sbit)-1;
9455
9456 /* This mimics the libpng threshold test, '0' is used to prevent gamma
9457 * correction in the validation test.
9458 */
9459 vi->screen_gamma = dp->screen_gamma;
9460 if (fabs(vi->screen_gamma-1) < PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
9461 vi->screen_gamma = vi->screen_inverse = 0;
9462 else
9463 vi->screen_inverse = 1/vi->screen_gamma;
9464
9465 vi->use_input_precision = dp->use_input_precision;
9466 vi->outmax = outmax;
9467 vi->maxabs = abserr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
9468 vi->maxpc = pcerr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
9469 vi->maxcalc = calcerr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
9470 vi->maxout = outerr(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
9471 vi->outquant = output_quantization_factor(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
9472 vi->maxout_total = vi->maxout + vi->outquant * .5;
9473 vi->outlog = outlog(dp->pm, in_depth, out_depth);
9474
9475 if ((dp->this.colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0 ||
9476 (dp->this.colour_type == 3 && dp->this.is_transparent) ||
9477 ((dp->this.colour_type == 0 || dp->this.colour_type == 2) &&
9478 dp->this.has_tRNS))
9479 {
9480 vi->do_background = dp->do_background;
9481
9482 if (vi->do_background != 0)
9483 {
9484 const double bg_inverse = 1/dp->background_gamma;
9485 double r, g, b;
9486
9487 /* Caller must at least put the gray value into the red channel */
9488 r = dp->background_color.red; r /= outmax;
9489 g = dp->background_color.green; g /= outmax;
9490 b = dp->background_color.blue; b /= outmax;
9491
9492 # if 0
9493 /* libpng doesn't do this optimization, if we do pngvalid will fail.
9494 */
9495 if (fabs(bg_inverse-1) >= PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
9496 # endif
9497 {
9498 r = pow(r, bg_inverse);
9499 g = pow(g, bg_inverse);
9500 b = pow(b, bg_inverse);
9501 }
9502
9503 vi->background_red = r;
9504 vi->background_green = g;
9505 vi->background_blue = b;
9506 }
9507 }
9508 else /* Do not expect any background processing */
9509 vi->do_background = 0;
9510
9511 if (vi->do_background == 0)
9512 vi->background_red = vi->background_green = vi->background_blue = 0;
9513
9514 vi->gamma_correction = 1/(dp->file_gamma*dp->screen_gamma);
9515 if (fabs(vi->gamma_correction-1) < PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
9516 vi->gamma_correction = 0;
9517
9518 vi->file_inverse = 1/dp->file_gamma;
9519 if (fabs(vi->file_inverse-1) < PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
9520 vi->file_inverse = 0;
9521
9522 vi->scale16 = dp->scale16;
9523 }
9524
9525 /* This function handles composition of a single non-alpha component. The
9526 * argument is the input sample value, in the range 0..1, and the alpha value.
9527 * The result is the composed, linear, input sample. If alpha is less than zero
9528 * this is the alpha component and the function should not be called!
9529 */
9530 static double
gamma_component_compose(int do_background,double input_sample,double alpha,double background,int * compose)9531 gamma_component_compose(int do_background, double input_sample, double alpha,
9532 double background, int *compose)
9533 {
9534 switch (do_background)
9535 {
9536 #ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
9537 case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_SCREEN:
9538 case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE:
9539 case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE:
9540 /* Standard PNG background processing. */
9541 if (alpha < 1)
9542 {
9543 if (alpha > 0)
9544 {
9545 input_sample = input_sample * alpha + background * (1-alpha);
9546 if (compose != NULL)
9547 *compose = 1;
9548 }
9549
9550 else
9551 input_sample = background;
9552 }
9553 break;
9554 #endif
9555
9556 #ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
9557 case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD:
9558 case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN:
9559 /* The components are premultiplied in either case and the output is
9560 * gamma encoded (to get standard Porter-Duff we expect the output
9561 * gamma to be set to 1.0!)
9562 */
9563 case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED:
9564 /* The optimization is that the partial-alpha entries are linear
9565 * while the opaque pixels are gamma encoded, but this only affects the
9566 * output encoding.
9567 */
9568 if (alpha < 1)
9569 {
9570 if (alpha > 0)
9571 {
9572 input_sample *= alpha;
9573 if (compose != NULL)
9574 *compose = 1;
9575 }
9576
9577 else
9578 input_sample = 0;
9579 }
9580 break;
9581 #endif
9582
9583 default:
9584 /* Standard cases where no compositing is done (so the component
9585 * value is already correct.)
9586 */
9587 UNUSED(alpha)
9588 UNUSED(background)
9589 UNUSED(compose)
9590 break;
9591 }
9592
9593 return input_sample;
9594 }
9595
9596 /* This API returns the encoded *input* component, in the range 0..1 */
9597 static double
gamma_component_validate(const char * name,const validate_info * vi,unsigned int id,unsigned int od,const double alpha,const double background)9598 gamma_component_validate(const char *name, const validate_info *vi,
9599 unsigned int id, unsigned int od,
9600 const double alpha /* <0 for the alpha channel itself */,
9601 const double background /* component background value */)
9602 {
9603 unsigned int isbit = id >> vi->isbit_shift;
9604 unsigned int sbit_max = vi->sbit_max;
9605 unsigned int outmax = vi->outmax;
9606 int do_background = vi->do_background;
9607
9608 double i;
9609
9610 /* First check on the 'perfect' result obtained from the digitized input
9611 * value, id, and compare this against the actual digitized result, 'od'.
9612 * 'i' is the input result in the range 0..1:
9613 */
9614 i = isbit; i /= sbit_max;
9615
9616 /* Check for the fast route: if we don't do any background composition or if
9617 * this is the alpha channel ('alpha' < 0) or if the pixel is opaque then
9618 * just use the gamma_correction field to correct to the final output gamma.
9619 */
9620 if (alpha == 1 /* opaque pixel component */ || !do_background
9621 #ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
9622 || do_background == ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_PNG
9623 #endif
9624 || (alpha < 0 /* alpha channel */
9625 #ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
9626 && do_background != ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN
9627 #endif
9628 ))
9629 {
9630 /* Then get the gamma corrected version of 'i' and compare to 'od', any
9631 * error less than .5 is insignificant - just quantization of the output
9632 * value to the nearest digital value (nevertheless the error is still
9633 * recorded - it's interesting ;-)
9634 */
9635 double encoded_sample = i;
9636 double encoded_error;
9637
9638 /* alpha less than 0 indicates the alpha channel, which is always linear
9639 */
9640 if (alpha >= 0 && vi->gamma_correction > 0)
9641 encoded_sample = pow(encoded_sample, vi->gamma_correction);
9642 encoded_sample *= outmax;
9643
9644 encoded_error = fabs(od-encoded_sample);
9645
9646 if (encoded_error > vi->dp->maxerrout)
9647 vi->dp->maxerrout = encoded_error;
9648
9649 if (encoded_error < vi->maxout_total && encoded_error < vi->outlog)
9650 return i;
9651 }
9652
9653 /* The slow route - attempt to do linear calculations. */
9654 /* There may be an error, or background processing is required, so calculate
9655 * the actual sample values - unencoded light intensity values. Note that in
9656 * practice these are not completely unencoded because they include a
9657 * 'viewing correction' to decrease or (normally) increase the perceptual
9658 * contrast of the image. There's nothing we can do about this - we don't
9659 * know what it is - so assume the unencoded value is perceptually linear.
9660 */
9661 {
9662 double input_sample = i; /* In range 0..1 */
9663 double output, error, encoded_sample, encoded_error;
9664 double es_lo, es_hi;
9665 int compose = 0; /* Set to one if composition done */
9666 int output_is_encoded; /* Set if encoded to screen gamma */
9667 int log_max_error = 1; /* Check maximum error values */
9668 png_const_charp pass = 0; /* Reason test passes (or 0 for fail) */
9669
9670 /* Convert to linear light (with the above caveat.) The alpha channel is
9671 * already linear.
9672 */
9673 if (alpha >= 0)
9674 {
9675 int tcompose;
9676
9677 if (vi->file_inverse > 0)
9678 input_sample = pow(input_sample, vi->file_inverse);
9679
9680 /* Handle the compose processing: */
9681 tcompose = 0;
9682 input_sample = gamma_component_compose(do_background, input_sample,
9683 alpha, background, &tcompose);
9684
9685 if (tcompose)
9686 compose = 1;
9687 }
9688
9689 /* And similarly for the output value, but we need to check the background
9690 * handling to linearize it correctly.
9691 */
9692 output = od;
9693 output /= outmax;
9694
9695 output_is_encoded = vi->screen_gamma > 0;
9696
9697 if (alpha < 0) /* The alpha channel */
9698 {
9699 #ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
9700 if (do_background != ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN)
9701 #endif
9702 {
9703 /* In all other cases the output alpha channel is linear already,
9704 * don't log errors here, they are much larger in linear data.
9705 */
9706 output_is_encoded = 0;
9707 log_max_error = 0;
9708 }
9709 }
9710
9711 #ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
9712 else /* A component */
9713 {
9714 if (do_background == ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED &&
9715 alpha < 1) /* the optimized case - linear output */
9716 {
9717 if (alpha > 0) log_max_error = 0;
9718 output_is_encoded = 0;
9719 }
9720 }
9721 #endif
9722
9723 if (output_is_encoded)
9724 output = pow(output, vi->screen_gamma);
9725
9726 /* Calculate (or recalculate) the encoded_sample value and repeat the
9727 * check above (unnecessary if we took the fast route, but harmless.)
9728 */
9729 encoded_sample = input_sample;
9730 if (output_is_encoded)
9731 encoded_sample = pow(encoded_sample, vi->screen_inverse);
9732 encoded_sample *= outmax;
9733
9734 encoded_error = fabs(od-encoded_sample);
9735
9736 /* Don't log errors in the alpha channel, or the 'optimized' case,
9737 * neither are significant to the overall perception.
9738 */
9739 if (log_max_error && encoded_error > vi->dp->maxerrout)
9740 vi->dp->maxerrout = encoded_error;
9741
9742 if (encoded_error < vi->maxout_total)
9743 {
9744 if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
9745 return i;
9746
9747 /* Test passed but error is bigger than the log limit, record why the
9748 * test passed:
9749 */
9750 pass = "less than maxout:\n";
9751 }
9752
9753 /* i: the original input value in the range 0..1
9754 *
9755 * pngvalid calculations:
9756 * input_sample: linear result; i linearized and composed, range 0..1
9757 * encoded_sample: encoded result; input_sample scaled to output bit depth
9758 *
9759 * libpng calculations:
9760 * output: linear result; od scaled to 0..1 and linearized
9761 * od: encoded result from libpng
9762 */
9763
9764 /* Now we have the numbers for real errors, both absolute values as as a
9765 * percentage of the correct value (output):
9766 */
9767 error = fabs(input_sample-output);
9768
9769 if (log_max_error && error > vi->dp->maxerrabs)
9770 vi->dp->maxerrabs = error;
9771
9772 /* The following is an attempt to ignore the tendency of quantization to
9773 * dominate the percentage errors for lower result values:
9774 */
9775 if (log_max_error && input_sample > .5)
9776 {
9777 double percentage_error = error/input_sample;
9778 if (percentage_error > vi->dp->maxerrpc)
9779 vi->dp->maxerrpc = percentage_error;
9780 }
9781
9782 /* Now calculate the digitization limits for 'encoded_sample' using the
9783 * 'max' values. Note that maxout is in the encoded space but maxpc and
9784 * maxabs are in linear light space.
9785 *
9786 * First find the maximum error in linear light space, range 0..1:
9787 */
9788 {
9789 double tmp = input_sample * vi->maxpc;
9790 if (tmp < vi->maxabs) tmp = vi->maxabs;
9791 /* If 'compose' is true the composition was done in linear space using
9792 * integer arithmetic. This introduces an extra error of +/- 0.5 (at
9793 * least) in the integer space used. 'maxcalc' records this, taking
9794 * into account the possibility that even for 16 bit output 8 bit space
9795 * may have been used.
9796 */
9797 if (compose && tmp < vi->maxcalc) tmp = vi->maxcalc;
9798
9799 /* The 'maxout' value refers to the encoded result, to compare with
9800 * this encode input_sample adjusted by the maximum error (tmp) above.
9801 */
9802 es_lo = encoded_sample - vi->maxout;
9803
9804 if (es_lo > 0 && input_sample-tmp > 0)
9805 {
9806 double low_value = input_sample-tmp;
9807 if (output_is_encoded)
9808 low_value = pow(low_value, vi->screen_inverse);
9809 low_value *= outmax;
9810 if (low_value < es_lo) es_lo = low_value;
9811
9812 /* Quantize this appropriately: */
9813 es_lo = ceil(es_lo / vi->outquant - .5) * vi->outquant;
9814 }
9815
9816 else
9817 es_lo = 0;
9818
9819 es_hi = encoded_sample + vi->maxout;
9820
9821 if (es_hi < outmax && input_sample+tmp < 1)
9822 {
9823 double high_value = input_sample+tmp;
9824 if (output_is_encoded)
9825 high_value = pow(high_value, vi->screen_inverse);
9826 high_value *= outmax;
9827 if (high_value > es_hi) es_hi = high_value;
9828
9829 es_hi = floor(es_hi / vi->outquant + .5) * vi->outquant;
9830 }
9831
9832 else
9833 es_hi = outmax;
9834 }
9835
9836 /* The primary test is that the final encoded value returned by the
9837 * library should be between the two limits (inclusive) that were
9838 * calculated above.
9839 */
9840 if (od >= es_lo && od <= es_hi)
9841 {
9842 /* The value passes, but we may need to log the information anyway. */
9843 if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
9844 return i;
9845
9846 if (pass == 0)
9847 pass = "within digitization limits:\n";
9848 }
9849
9850 {
9851 /* There has been an error in processing, or we need to log this
9852 * value.
9853 */
9854 double is_lo, is_hi;
9855
9856 /* pass is set at this point if either of the tests above would have
9857 * passed. Don't do these additional tests here - just log the
9858 * original [es_lo..es_hi] values.
9859 */
9860 if (pass == 0 && vi->use_input_precision && vi->dp->sbit)
9861 {
9862 /* Ok, something is wrong - this actually happens in current libpng
9863 * 16-to-8 processing. Assume that the input value (id, adjusted
9864 * for sbit) can be anywhere between value-.5 and value+.5 - quite a
9865 * large range if sbit is low.
9866 *
9867 * NOTE: at present because the libpng gamma table stuff has been
9868 * changed to use a rounding algorithm to correct errors in 8-bit
9869 * calculations the precise sbit calculation (a shift) has been
9870 * lost. This can result in up to a +/-1 error in the presence of
9871 * an sbit less than the bit depth.
9872 */
9873 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
9874 # define SBIT_ERROR .5
9875 # else
9876 # define SBIT_ERROR 1.
9877 # endif
9878 double tmp = (isbit - SBIT_ERROR)/sbit_max;
9879
9880 if (tmp <= 0)
9881 tmp = 0;
9882
9883 else if (alpha >= 0 && vi->file_inverse > 0 && tmp < 1)
9884 tmp = pow(tmp, vi->file_inverse);
9885
9886 tmp = gamma_component_compose(do_background, tmp, alpha, background,
9887 NULL);
9888
9889 if (output_is_encoded && tmp > 0 && tmp < 1)
9890 tmp = pow(tmp, vi->screen_inverse);
9891
9892 is_lo = ceil(outmax * tmp - vi->maxout_total);
9893
9894 if (is_lo < 0)
9895 is_lo = 0;
9896
9897 tmp = (isbit + SBIT_ERROR)/sbit_max;
9898
9899 if (tmp >= 1)
9900 tmp = 1;
9901
9902 else if (alpha >= 0 && vi->file_inverse > 0 && tmp < 1)
9903 tmp = pow(tmp, vi->file_inverse);
9904
9905 tmp = gamma_component_compose(do_background, tmp, alpha, background,
9906 NULL);
9907
9908 if (output_is_encoded && tmp > 0 && tmp < 1)
9909 tmp = pow(tmp, vi->screen_inverse);
9910
9911 is_hi = floor(outmax * tmp + vi->maxout_total);
9912
9913 if (is_hi > outmax)
9914 is_hi = outmax;
9915
9916 if (!(od < is_lo || od > is_hi))
9917 {
9918 if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
9919 return i;
9920
9921 pass = "within input precision limits:\n";
9922 }
9923
9924 /* One last chance. If this is an alpha channel and the 16to8
9925 * option has been used and 'inaccurate' scaling is used then the
9926 * bit reduction is obtained by simply using the top 8 bits of the
9927 * value.
9928 *
9929 * This is only done for older libpng versions when the 'inaccurate'
9930 * (chop) method of scaling was used.
9931 */
9932 # ifndef PNG_READ_16_TO_8_ACCURATE_SCALE_SUPPORTED
9933 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10504
9934 /* This may be required for other components in the future,
9935 * but at present the presence of gamma correction effectively
9936 * prevents the errors in the component scaling (I don't quite
9937 * understand why, but since it's better this way I care not
9938 * to ask, JB 20110419.)
9939 */
9940 if (pass == 0 && alpha < 0 && vi->scale16 && vi->sbit > 8 &&
9941 vi->sbit + vi->isbit_shift == 16)
9942 {
9943 tmp = ((id >> 8) - .5)/255;
9944
9945 if (tmp > 0)
9946 {
9947 is_lo = ceil(outmax * tmp - vi->maxout_total);
9948 if (is_lo < 0) is_lo = 0;
9949 }
9950
9951 else
9952 is_lo = 0;
9953
9954 tmp = ((id >> 8) + .5)/255;
9955
9956 if (tmp < 1)
9957 {
9958 is_hi = floor(outmax * tmp + vi->maxout_total);
9959 if (is_hi > outmax) is_hi = outmax;
9960 }
9961
9962 else
9963 is_hi = outmax;
9964
9965 if (!(od < is_lo || od > is_hi))
9966 {
9967 if (encoded_error < vi->outlog)
9968 return i;
9969
9970 pass = "within 8 bit limits:\n";
9971 }
9972 }
9973 # endif
9974 # endif
9975 }
9976 else /* !use_input_precision */
9977 is_lo = es_lo, is_hi = es_hi;
9978
9979 /* Attempt to output a meaningful error/warning message: the message
9980 * output depends on the background/composite operation being performed
9981 * because this changes what parameters were actually used above.
9982 */
9983 {
9984 size_t pos = 0;
9985 /* Need either 1/255 or 1/65535 precision here; 3 or 6 decimal
9986 * places. Just use outmax to work out which.
9987 */
9988 int precision = (outmax >= 1000 ? 6 : 3);
9989 int use_input=1, use_background=0, do_compose=0;
9990 char msg[256];
9991
9992 if (pass != 0)
9993 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\n\t");
9994
9995 /* Set up the various flags, the output_is_encoded flag above
9996 * is also used below. do_compose is just a double check.
9997 */
9998 switch (do_background)
9999 {
10000 # ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
10001 case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_SCREEN:
10002 case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE:
10003 case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE:
10004 use_background = (alpha >= 0 && alpha < 1);
10005 # endif
10006 # ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
10007 /* FALLTHROUGH */
10008 case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD:
10009 case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN:
10010 case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED:
10011 # endif /* ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED */
10012 do_compose = (alpha > 0 && alpha < 1);
10013 use_input = (alpha != 0);
10014 break;
10015
10016 default:
10017 break;
10018 }
10019
10020 /* Check the 'compose' flag */
10021 if (compose != do_compose)
10022 png_error(vi->pp, "internal error (compose)");
10023
10024 /* 'name' is the component name */
10025 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, name);
10026 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(");
10027 pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, id);
10028 if (use_input || pass != 0/*logging*/)
10029 {
10030 if (isbit != id)
10031 {
10032 /* sBIT has reduced the precision of the input: */
10033 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ", sbit(");
10034 pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->sbit);
10035 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "): ");
10036 pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, isbit);
10037 }
10038 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "/");
10039 /* The output is either "id/max" or "id sbit(sbit): isbit/max" */
10040 pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->sbit_max);
10041 }
10042 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ")");
10043
10044 /* A component may have been multiplied (in linear space) by the
10045 * alpha value, 'compose' says whether this is relevant.
10046 */
10047 if (compose || pass != 0)
10048 {
10049 /* If any form of composition is being done report our
10050 * calculated linear value here (the code above doesn't record
10051 * the input value before composition is performed, so what
10052 * gets reported is the value after composition.)
10053 */
10054 if (use_input || pass != 0)
10055 {
10056 if (vi->file_inverse > 0)
10057 {
10058 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "^");
10059 pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->file_inverse, 2);
10060 }
10061
10062 else
10063 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "[linear]");
10064
10065 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "*(alpha)");
10066 pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, alpha, precision);
10067 }
10068
10069 /* Now record the *linear* background value if it was used
10070 * (this function is not passed the original, non-linear,
10071 * value but it is contained in the test name.)
10072 */
10073 if (use_background)
10074 {
10075 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, use_input ? "+" : " ");
10076 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(background)");
10077 pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, background, precision);
10078 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "*");
10079 pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, 1-alpha, precision);
10080 }
10081 }
10082
10083 /* Report the calculated value (input_sample) and the linearized
10084 * libpng value (output) unless this is just a component gamma
10085 * correction.
10086 */
10087 if (compose || alpha < 0 || pass != 0)
10088 {
10089 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos,
10090 pass != 0 ? " =\n\t" : " = ");
10091 pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, input_sample, precision);
10092 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " (libpng: ");
10093 pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, output, precision);
10094 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ")");
10095
10096 /* Finally report the output gamma encoding, if any. */
10097 if (output_is_encoded)
10098 {
10099 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " ^");
10100 pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->screen_inverse, 2);
10101 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(to screen) =");
10102 }
10103
10104 else
10105 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " [screen is linear] =");
10106 }
10107
10108 if ((!compose && alpha >= 0) || pass != 0)
10109 {
10110 if (pass != 0) /* logging */
10111 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "\n\t[overall:");
10112
10113 /* This is the non-composition case, the internal linear
10114 * values are irrelevant (though the log below will reveal
10115 * them.) Output a much shorter warning/error message and report
10116 * the overall gamma correction.
10117 */
10118 if (vi->gamma_correction > 0)
10119 {
10120 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " ^");
10121 pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, vi->gamma_correction, 2);
10122 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "(gamma correction) =");
10123 }
10124
10125 else
10126 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos,
10127 " [no gamma correction] =");
10128
10129 if (pass != 0)
10130 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "]");
10131 }
10132
10133 /* This is our calculated encoded_sample which should (but does
10134 * not) match od:
10135 */
10136 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, pass != 0 ? "\n\t" : " ");
10137 pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, is_lo, 1);
10138 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " < ");
10139 pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, encoded_sample, 1);
10140 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " (libpng: ");
10141 pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, od);
10142 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, ")");
10143 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "/");
10144 pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, outmax);
10145 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, " < ");
10146 pos = safecatd(msg, sizeof msg, pos, is_hi, 1);
10147
10148 if (pass == 0) /* The error condition */
10149 {
10150 # ifdef PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED
10151 png_warning(vi->pp, msg);
10152 # else
10153 store_warning(vi->pp, msg);
10154 # endif
10155 }
10156
10157 else /* logging this value */
10158 store_verbose(&vi->dp->pm->this, vi->pp, pass, msg);
10159 }
10160 }
10161 }
10162
10163 return i;
10164 }
10165
10166 static void
gamma_image_validate(gamma_display * dp,png_const_structp pp,png_infop pi)10167 gamma_image_validate(gamma_display *dp, png_const_structp pp,
10168 png_infop pi)
10169 {
10170 /* Get some constants derived from the input and output file formats: */
10171 const png_store* const ps = dp->this.ps;
10172 png_byte in_ct = dp->this.colour_type;
10173 png_byte in_bd = dp->this.bit_depth;
10174 png_uint_32 w = dp->this.w;
10175 png_uint_32 h = dp->this.h;
10176 const size_t cbRow = dp->this.cbRow;
10177 png_byte out_ct = png_get_color_type(pp, pi);
10178 png_byte out_bd = png_get_bit_depth(pp, pi);
10179
10180 /* There are three sources of error, firstly the quantization in the
10181 * file encoding, determined by sbit and/or the file depth, secondly
10182 * the output (screen) gamma and thirdly the output file encoding.
10183 *
10184 * Since this API receives the screen and file gamma in double
10185 * precision it is possible to calculate an exact answer given an input
10186 * pixel value. Therefore we assume that the *input* value is exact -
10187 * sample/maxsample - calculate the corresponding gamma corrected
10188 * output to the limits of double precision arithmetic and compare with
10189 * what libpng returns.
10190 *
10191 * Since the library must quantize the output to 8 or 16 bits there is
10192 * a fundamental limit on the accuracy of the output of +/-.5 - this
10193 * quantization limit is included in addition to the other limits
10194 * specified by the parameters to the API. (Effectively, add .5
10195 * everywhere.)
10196 *
10197 * The behavior of the 'sbit' parameter is defined by section 12.5
10198 * (sample depth scaling) of the PNG spec. That section forces the
10199 * decoder to assume that the PNG values have been scaled if sBIT is
10200 * present:
10201 *
10202 * png-sample = floor( input-sample * (max-out/max-in) + .5);
10203 *
10204 * This means that only a subset of the possible PNG values should
10205 * appear in the input. However, the spec allows the encoder to use a
10206 * variety of approximations to the above and doesn't require any
10207 * restriction of the values produced.
10208 *
10209 * Nevertheless the spec requires that the upper 'sBIT' bits of the
10210 * value stored in a PNG file be the original sample bits.
10211 * Consequently the code below simply scales the top sbit bits by
10212 * (1<<sbit)-1 to obtain an original sample value.
10213 *
10214 * Because there is limited precision in the input it is arguable that
10215 * an acceptable result is any valid result from input-.5 to input+.5.
10216 * The basic tests below do not do this, however if 'use_input_precision'
10217 * is set a subsequent test is performed above.
10218 */
10219 unsigned int samples_per_pixel = (out_ct & 2U) ? 3U : 1U;
10220 int processing;
10221 png_uint_32 y;
10222 const store_palette_entry *in_palette = dp->this.palette;
10223 int in_is_transparent = dp->this.is_transparent;
10224 int process_tRNS;
10225 int out_npalette = -1;
10226 int out_is_transparent = 0; /* Just refers to the palette case */
10227 store_palette out_palette;
10228 validate_info vi;
10229
10230 /* Check for row overwrite errors */
10231 store_image_check(dp->this.ps, pp, 0);
10232
10233 /* Supply the input and output sample depths here - 8 for an indexed image,
10234 * otherwise the bit depth.
10235 */
10236 init_validate_info(&vi, dp, pp, in_ct==3?8:in_bd, out_ct==3?8:out_bd);
10237
10238 processing = (vi.gamma_correction > 0 && !dp->threshold_test)
10239 || in_bd != out_bd || in_ct != out_ct || vi.do_background;
10240 process_tRNS = dp->this.has_tRNS && vi.do_background;
10241
10242 /* TODO: FIX THIS: MAJOR BUG! If the transformations all happen inside
10243 * the palette there is no way of finding out, because libpng fails to
10244 * update the palette on png_read_update_info. Indeed, libpng doesn't
10245 * even do the required work until much later, when it doesn't have any
10246 * info pointer. Oops. For the moment 'processing' is turned off if
10247 * out_ct is palette.
10248 */
10249 if (in_ct == 3 && out_ct == 3)
10250 processing = 0;
10251
10252 if (processing && out_ct == 3)
10253 out_is_transparent = read_palette(out_palette, &out_npalette, pp, pi);
10254
10255 for (y=0; y<h; ++y)
10256 {
10257 png_const_bytep pRow = store_image_row(ps, pp, 0, y);
10258 png_byte std[STANDARD_ROWMAX];
10259
10260 transform_row(pp, std, in_ct, in_bd, y);
10261
10262 if (processing)
10263 {
10264 unsigned int x;
10265
10266 for (x=0; x<w; ++x)
10267 {
10268 double alpha = 1; /* serves as a flag value */
10269
10270 /* Record the palette index for index images. */
10271 unsigned int in_index =
10272 in_ct == 3 ? sample(std, 3, in_bd, x, 0, 0, 0) : 256;
10273 unsigned int out_index =
10274 out_ct == 3 ? sample(std, 3, out_bd, x, 0, 0, 0) : 256;
10275
10276 /* Handle input alpha - png_set_background will cause the output
10277 * alpha to disappear so there is nothing to check.
10278 */
10279 if ((in_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0 ||
10280 (in_ct == 3 && in_is_transparent))
10281 {
10282 unsigned int input_alpha = in_ct == 3 ?
10283 dp->this.palette[in_index].alpha :
10284 sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, samples_per_pixel, 0, 0);
10285
10286 unsigned int output_alpha = 65536 /* as a flag value */;
10287
10288 if (out_ct == 3)
10289 {
10290 if (out_is_transparent)
10291 output_alpha = out_palette[out_index].alpha;
10292 }
10293
10294 else if ((out_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0)
10295 output_alpha = sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x,
10296 samples_per_pixel, 0, 0);
10297
10298 if (output_alpha != 65536)
10299 alpha = gamma_component_validate("alpha", &vi, input_alpha,
10300 output_alpha, -1/*alpha*/, 0/*background*/);
10301
10302 else /* no alpha in output */
10303 {
10304 /* This is a copy of the calculation of 'i' above in order to
10305 * have the alpha value to use in the background calculation.
10306 */
10307 alpha = input_alpha >> vi.isbit_shift;
10308 alpha /= vi.sbit_max;
10309 }
10310 }
10311
10312 else if (process_tRNS)
10313 {
10314 /* alpha needs to be set appropriately for this pixel, it is
10315 * currently 1 and needs to be 0 for an input pixel which matches
10316 * the values in tRNS.
10317 */
10318 switch (in_ct)
10319 {
10320 case 0: /* gray */
10321 if (sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 0, 0, 0) ==
10322 dp->this.transparent.red)
10323 alpha = 0;
10324 break;
10325
10326 case 2: /* RGB */
10327 if (sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 0, 0, 0) ==
10328 dp->this.transparent.red &&
10329 sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 1, 0, 0) ==
10330 dp->this.transparent.green &&
10331 sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 2, 0, 0) ==
10332 dp->this.transparent.blue)
10333 alpha = 0;
10334 break;
10335
10336 default:
10337 break;
10338 }
10339 }
10340
10341 /* Handle grayscale or RGB components. */
10342 if ((in_ct & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR) == 0) /* grayscale */
10343 (void)gamma_component_validate("gray", &vi,
10344 sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 0, 0, 0),
10345 sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 0, 0, 0),
10346 alpha/*component*/, vi.background_red);
10347 else /* RGB or palette */
10348 {
10349 (void)gamma_component_validate("red", &vi,
10350 in_ct == 3 ? in_palette[in_index].red :
10351 sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 0, 0, 0),
10352 out_ct == 3 ? out_palette[out_index].red :
10353 sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 0, 0, 0),
10354 alpha/*component*/, vi.background_red);
10355
10356 (void)gamma_component_validate("green", &vi,
10357 in_ct == 3 ? in_palette[in_index].green :
10358 sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 1, 0, 0),
10359 out_ct == 3 ? out_palette[out_index].green :
10360 sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 1, 0, 0),
10361 alpha/*component*/, vi.background_green);
10362
10363 (void)gamma_component_validate("blue", &vi,
10364 in_ct == 3 ? in_palette[in_index].blue :
10365 sample(std, in_ct, in_bd, x, 2, 0, 0),
10366 out_ct == 3 ? out_palette[out_index].blue :
10367 sample(pRow, out_ct, out_bd, x, 2, 0, 0),
10368 alpha/*component*/, vi.background_blue);
10369 }
10370 }
10371 }
10372
10373 else if (memcmp(std, pRow, cbRow) != 0)
10374 {
10375 char msg[64];
10376
10377 /* No transform is expected on the threshold tests. */
10378 sprintf(msg, "gamma: below threshold row %lu changed",
10379 (unsigned long)y);
10380
10381 png_error(pp, msg);
10382 }
10383 } /* row (y) loop */
10384
10385 dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
10386 }
10387
10388 static void PNGCBAPI
gamma_end(png_structp ppIn,png_infop pi)10389 gamma_end(png_structp ppIn, png_infop pi)
10390 {
10391 png_const_structp pp = ppIn;
10392 gamma_display *dp = voidcast(gamma_display*, png_get_progressive_ptr(pp));
10393
10394 if (!dp->this.speed)
10395 gamma_image_validate(dp, pp, pi);
10396 else
10397 dp->this.ps->validated = 1;
10398 }
10399
10400 /* A single test run checking a gamma transformation.
10401 *
10402 * maxabs: maximum absolute error as a fraction
10403 * maxout: maximum output error in the output units
10404 * maxpc: maximum percentage error (as a percentage)
10405 */
10406 static void
gamma_test(png_modifier * pmIn,png_byte colour_typeIn,png_byte bit_depthIn,int palette_numberIn,int interlace_typeIn,const double file_gammaIn,const double screen_gammaIn,png_byte sbitIn,int threshold_testIn,const char * name,int use_input_precisionIn,int scale16In,int expand16In,int do_backgroundIn,const png_color_16 * bkgd_colorIn,double bkgd_gammaIn)10407 gamma_test(png_modifier *pmIn, png_byte colour_typeIn,
10408 png_byte bit_depthIn, int palette_numberIn,
10409 int interlace_typeIn,
10410 const double file_gammaIn, const double screen_gammaIn,
10411 png_byte sbitIn, int threshold_testIn,
10412 const char *name,
10413 int use_input_precisionIn, int scale16In,
10414 int expand16In, int do_backgroundIn,
10415 const png_color_16 *bkgd_colorIn, double bkgd_gammaIn)
10416 {
10417 gamma_display d;
10418 context(&pmIn->this, fault);
10419
10420 gamma_display_init(&d, pmIn, FILEID(colour_typeIn, bit_depthIn,
10421 palette_numberIn, interlace_typeIn, 0, 0, 0),
10422 file_gammaIn, screen_gammaIn, sbitIn,
10423 threshold_testIn, use_input_precisionIn, scale16In,
10424 expand16In, do_backgroundIn, bkgd_colorIn, bkgd_gammaIn);
10425
10426 Try
10427 {
10428 png_structp pp;
10429 png_infop pi;
10430 gama_modification gama_mod;
10431 srgb_modification srgb_mod;
10432 sbit_modification sbit_mod;
10433
10434 /* For the moment don't use the png_modifier support here. */
10435 d.pm->encoding_counter = 0;
10436 modifier_set_encoding(d.pm); /* Just resets everything */
10437 d.pm->current_gamma = d.file_gamma;
10438
10439 /* Make an appropriate modifier to set the PNG file gamma to the
10440 * given gamma value and the sBIT chunk to the given precision.
10441 */
10442 d.pm->modifications = NULL;
10443 gama_modification_init(&gama_mod, d.pm, d.file_gamma);
10444 srgb_modification_init(&srgb_mod, d.pm, 127 /*delete*/);
10445 if (d.sbit > 0)
10446 sbit_modification_init(&sbit_mod, d.pm, d.sbit);
10447
10448 modification_reset(d.pm->modifications);
10449
10450 /* Get a png_struct for reading the image. */
10451 pp = set_modifier_for_read(d.pm, &pi, d.this.id, name);
10452 standard_palette_init(&d.this);
10453
10454 /* Introduce the correct read function. */
10455 if (d.pm->this.progressive)
10456 {
10457 /* Share the row function with the standard implementation. */
10458 png_set_progressive_read_fn(pp, &d, gamma_info, progressive_row,
10459 gamma_end);
10460
10461 /* Now feed data into the reader until we reach the end: */
10462 modifier_progressive_read(d.pm, pp, pi);
10463 }
10464 else
10465 {
10466 /* modifier_read expects a png_modifier* */
10467 png_set_read_fn(pp, d.pm, modifier_read);
10468
10469 /* Check the header values: */
10470 png_read_info(pp, pi);
10471
10472 /* Process the 'info' requirements. Only one image is generated */
10473 gamma_info_imp(&d, pp, pi);
10474
10475 sequential_row(&d.this, pp, pi, -1, 0);
10476
10477 if (!d.this.speed)
10478 gamma_image_validate(&d, pp, pi);
10479 else
10480 d.this.ps->validated = 1;
10481 }
10482
10483 modifier_reset(d.pm);
10484
10485 if (d.pm->log && !d.threshold_test && !d.this.speed)
10486 fprintf(stderr, "%d bit %s %s: max error %f (%.2g, %2g%%)\n",
10487 d.this.bit_depth, colour_types[d.this.colour_type], name,
10488 d.maxerrout, d.maxerrabs, 100*d.maxerrpc);
10489
10490 /* Log the summary values too. */
10491 if (d.this.colour_type == 0 || d.this.colour_type == 4)
10492 {
10493 switch (d.this.bit_depth)
10494 {
10495 case 1:
10496 break;
10497
10498 case 2:
10499 if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_2)
10500 d.pm->error_gray_2 = d.maxerrout;
10501
10502 break;
10503
10504 case 4:
10505 if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_4)
10506 d.pm->error_gray_4 = d.maxerrout;
10507
10508 break;
10509
10510 case 8:
10511 if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_8)
10512 d.pm->error_gray_8 = d.maxerrout;
10513
10514 break;
10515
10516 case 16:
10517 if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_gray_16)
10518 d.pm->error_gray_16 = d.maxerrout;
10519
10520 break;
10521
10522 default:
10523 png_error(pp, "bad bit depth (internal: 1)");
10524 }
10525 }
10526
10527 else if (d.this.colour_type == 2 || d.this.colour_type == 6)
10528 {
10529 switch (d.this.bit_depth)
10530 {
10531 case 8:
10532
10533 if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_color_8)
10534 d.pm->error_color_8 = d.maxerrout;
10535
10536 break;
10537
10538 case 16:
10539
10540 if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_color_16)
10541 d.pm->error_color_16 = d.maxerrout;
10542
10543 break;
10544
10545 default:
10546 png_error(pp, "bad bit depth (internal: 2)");
10547 }
10548 }
10549
10550 else if (d.this.colour_type == 3)
10551 {
10552 if (d.maxerrout > d.pm->error_indexed)
10553 d.pm->error_indexed = d.maxerrout;
10554 }
10555 }
10556
10557 Catch(fault)
10558 modifier_reset(voidcast(png_modifier*,(void*)fault));
10559 }
10560
gamma_threshold_test(png_modifier * pm,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth,int interlace_type,double file_gamma,double screen_gamma)10561 static void gamma_threshold_test(png_modifier *pm, png_byte colour_type,
10562 png_byte bit_depth, int interlace_type, double file_gamma,
10563 double screen_gamma)
10564 {
10565 size_t pos = 0;
10566 char name[64];
10567 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "threshold ");
10568 pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, file_gamma, 3);
10569 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "/");
10570 pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, screen_gamma, 3);
10571
10572 (void)gamma_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, 0/*palette*/, interlace_type,
10573 file_gamma, screen_gamma, 0/*sBIT*/, 1/*threshold test*/, name,
10574 0 /*no input precision*/,
10575 0 /*no scale16*/, 0 /*no expand16*/, 0 /*no background*/, 0 /*hence*/,
10576 0 /*no background gamma*/);
10577 }
10578
10579 static void
perform_gamma_threshold_tests(png_modifier * pm)10580 perform_gamma_threshold_tests(png_modifier *pm)
10581 {
10582 png_byte colour_type = 0;
10583 png_byte bit_depth = 0;
10584 unsigned int palette_number = 0;
10585
10586 /* Don't test more than one instance of each palette - it's pointless, in
10587 * fact this test is somewhat excessive since libpng doesn't make this
10588 * decision based on colour type or bit depth!
10589 *
10590 * CHANGED: now test two palettes and, as a side effect, images with and
10591 * without tRNS.
10592 */
10593 while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number,
10594 pm->test_lbg_gamma_threshold, pm->test_tRNS))
10595 if (palette_number < 2)
10596 {
10597 double test_gamma = 1.0;
10598 while (test_gamma >= .4)
10599 {
10600 /* There's little point testing the interlacing vs non-interlacing,
10601 * but this can be set from the command line.
10602 */
10603 gamma_threshold_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, pm->interlace_type,
10604 test_gamma, 1/test_gamma);
10605 test_gamma *= .95;
10606 }
10607
10608 /* And a special test for sRGB */
10609 gamma_threshold_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, pm->interlace_type,
10610 .45455, 2.2);
10611
10612 if (fail(pm))
10613 return;
10614 }
10615 }
10616
gamma_transform_test(png_modifier * pm,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth,int palette_number,int interlace_type,const double file_gamma,const double screen_gamma,png_byte sbit,int use_input_precision,int scale16)10617 static void gamma_transform_test(png_modifier *pm,
10618 png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth,
10619 int palette_number,
10620 int interlace_type, const double file_gamma,
10621 const double screen_gamma, png_byte sbit,
10622 int use_input_precision, int scale16)
10623 {
10624 size_t pos = 0;
10625 char name[64];
10626
10627 if (sbit != bit_depth && sbit != 0)
10628 {
10629 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "sbit(");
10630 pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, sbit);
10631 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ") ");
10632 }
10633
10634 else
10635 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "gamma ");
10636
10637 if (scale16)
10638 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "16to8 ");
10639
10640 pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, file_gamma, 3);
10641 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "->");
10642 pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, screen_gamma, 3);
10643
10644 gamma_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number, interlace_type,
10645 file_gamma, screen_gamma, sbit, 0, name, use_input_precision,
10646 scale16, pm->test_gamma_expand16, 0 , 0, 0);
10647 }
10648
perform_gamma_transform_tests(png_modifier * pm)10649 static void perform_gamma_transform_tests(png_modifier *pm)
10650 {
10651 png_byte colour_type = 0;
10652 png_byte bit_depth = 0;
10653 unsigned int palette_number = 0;
10654
10655 while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number,
10656 pm->test_lbg_gamma_transform, pm->test_tRNS))
10657 {
10658 unsigned int i, j;
10659
10660 for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i)
10661 {
10662 for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j)
10663 {
10664 if (i != j)
10665 {
10666 gamma_transform_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
10667 pm->interlace_type, 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j],
10668 0/*sBIT*/, pm->use_input_precision, 0/*do not scale16*/);
10669
10670 if (fail(pm))
10671 return;
10672 }
10673 }
10674 }
10675 }
10676 }
10677
perform_gamma_sbit_tests(png_modifier * pm)10678 static void perform_gamma_sbit_tests(png_modifier *pm)
10679 {
10680 png_byte sbit;
10681
10682 /* The only interesting cases are colour and grayscale, alpha is ignored here
10683 * for overall speed. Only bit depths where sbit is less than the bit depth
10684 * are tested.
10685 */
10686 for (sbit=pm->sbitlow; sbit<(1<<READ_BDHI); ++sbit)
10687 {
10688 png_byte colour_type = 0, bit_depth = 0;
10689 unsigned int npalette = 0;
10690
10691 while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &npalette,
10692 pm->test_lbg_gamma_sbit, pm->test_tRNS))
10693 if ((colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) == 0 &&
10694 ((colour_type == 3 && sbit < 8) ||
10695 (colour_type != 3 && sbit < bit_depth)))
10696 {
10697 unsigned int i;
10698
10699 for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i)
10700 {
10701 unsigned int j;
10702
10703 for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j)
10704 {
10705 if (i != j)
10706 {
10707 gamma_transform_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, npalette,
10708 pm->interlace_type, 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j],
10709 sbit, pm->use_input_precision_sbit, 0 /*scale16*/);
10710
10711 if (fail(pm))
10712 return;
10713 }
10714 }
10715 }
10716 }
10717 }
10718 }
10719
10720 /* Note that this requires a 16 bit source image but produces 8 bit output, so
10721 * we only need the 16bit write support, but the 16 bit images are only
10722 * generated if DO_16BIT is defined.
10723 */
10724 #ifdef DO_16BIT
perform_gamma_scale16_tests(png_modifier * pm)10725 static void perform_gamma_scale16_tests(png_modifier *pm)
10726 {
10727 # ifndef PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8
10728 # define PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8 11
10729 # endif
10730 # if defined PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8 || PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
10731 # define SBIT_16_TO_8 PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8
10732 # else
10733 # define SBIT_16_TO_8 16
10734 # endif
10735 /* Include the alpha cases here. Note that sbit matches the internal value
10736 * used by the library - otherwise we will get spurious errors from the
10737 * internal sbit style approximation.
10738 *
10739 * The threshold test is here because otherwise the 16 to 8 conversion will
10740 * proceed *without* gamma correction, and the tests above will fail (but not
10741 * by much) - this could be fixed, it only appears with the -g option.
10742 */
10743 unsigned int i, j;
10744 for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i)
10745 {
10746 for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j)
10747 {
10748 if (i != j &&
10749 fabs(pm->gammas[j]/pm->gammas[i]-1) >= PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
10750 {
10751 gamma_transform_test(pm, 0, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
10752 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], SBIT_16_TO_8,
10753 pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
10754
10755 if (fail(pm))
10756 return;
10757
10758 gamma_transform_test(pm, 2, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
10759 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], SBIT_16_TO_8,
10760 pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
10761
10762 if (fail(pm))
10763 return;
10764
10765 gamma_transform_test(pm, 4, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
10766 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], SBIT_16_TO_8,
10767 pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
10768
10769 if (fail(pm))
10770 return;
10771
10772 gamma_transform_test(pm, 6, 16, 0, pm->interlace_type,
10773 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j], SBIT_16_TO_8,
10774 pm->use_input_precision_16to8, 1 /*scale16*/);
10775
10776 if (fail(pm))
10777 return;
10778 }
10779 }
10780 }
10781 }
10782 #endif /* 16 to 8 bit conversion */
10783
10784 #if defined(PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED) ||\
10785 defined(PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED)
gamma_composition_test(png_modifier * pm,png_byte colour_type,png_byte bit_depth,int palette_number,int interlace_type,const double file_gamma,const double screen_gamma,int use_input_precision,int do_background,int expand_16)10786 static void gamma_composition_test(png_modifier *pm,
10787 png_byte colour_type, png_byte bit_depth,
10788 int palette_number,
10789 int interlace_type, const double file_gamma,
10790 const double screen_gamma,
10791 int use_input_precision, int do_background,
10792 int expand_16)
10793 {
10794 size_t pos = 0;
10795 png_const_charp base;
10796 double bg;
10797 char name[128];
10798 png_color_16 background;
10799
10800 /* Make up a name and get an appropriate background gamma value. */
10801 switch (do_background)
10802 {
10803 default:
10804 base = "";
10805 bg = 4; /* should not be used */
10806 break;
10807 case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_SCREEN:
10808 base = " bckg(Screen):";
10809 bg = 1/screen_gamma;
10810 break;
10811 case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE:
10812 base = " bckg(File):";
10813 bg = file_gamma;
10814 break;
10815 case PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE:
10816 base = " bckg(Unique):";
10817 /* This tests the handling of a unique value, the math is such that the
10818 * value tends to be <1, but is neither screen nor file (even if they
10819 * match!)
10820 */
10821 bg = (file_gamma + screen_gamma) / 3;
10822 break;
10823 #ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
10824 case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_PNG:
10825 base = " alpha(PNG)";
10826 bg = 4; /* should not be used */
10827 break;
10828 case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD:
10829 base = " alpha(Porter-Duff)";
10830 bg = 4; /* should not be used */
10831 break;
10832 case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_OPTIMIZED:
10833 base = " alpha(Optimized)";
10834 bg = 4; /* should not be used */
10835 break;
10836 case ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN:
10837 base = " alpha(Broken)";
10838 bg = 4; /* should not be used */
10839 break;
10840 #endif
10841 }
10842
10843 /* Use random background values - the background is always presented in the
10844 * output space (8 or 16 bit components).
10845 */
10846 if (expand_16 || bit_depth == 16)
10847 {
10848 png_uint_32 r = random_32();
10849
10850 background.red = (png_uint_16)r;
10851 background.green = (png_uint_16)(r >> 16);
10852 r = random_32();
10853 background.blue = (png_uint_16)r;
10854 background.gray = (png_uint_16)(r >> 16);
10855
10856 /* In earlier libpng versions, those where DIGITIZE is set, any background
10857 * gamma correction in the expand16 case was done using 8-bit gamma
10858 * correction tables, resulting in larger errors. To cope with those
10859 * cases use a 16-bit background value which will handle this gamma
10860 * correction.
10861 */
10862 # if DIGITIZE
10863 if (expand_16 && (do_background == PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE ||
10864 do_background == PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_FILE) &&
10865 fabs(bg*screen_gamma-1) > PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD)
10866 {
10867 /* The background values will be looked up in an 8-bit table to do
10868 * the gamma correction, so only select values which are an exact
10869 * match for the 8-bit table entries:
10870 */
10871 background.red = (png_uint_16)((background.red >> 8) * 257);
10872 background.green = (png_uint_16)((background.green >> 8) * 257);
10873 background.blue = (png_uint_16)((background.blue >> 8) * 257);
10874 background.gray = (png_uint_16)((background.gray >> 8) * 257);
10875 }
10876 # endif
10877 }
10878
10879 else /* 8 bit colors */
10880 {
10881 png_uint_32 r = random_32();
10882
10883 background.red = (png_byte)r;
10884 background.green = (png_byte)(r >> 8);
10885 background.blue = (png_byte)(r >> 16);
10886 background.gray = (png_byte)(r >> 24);
10887 }
10888
10889 background.index = 193; /* rgb(193,193,193) to detect errors */
10890
10891 if (!(colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR))
10892 {
10893 /* Because, currently, png_set_background is always called with
10894 * 'need_expand' false in this case and because the gamma test itself
10895 * doesn't cause an expand to 8-bit for lower bit depths the colour must
10896 * be reduced to the correct range.
10897 */
10898 if (bit_depth < 8)
10899 background.gray &= (png_uint_16)((1U << bit_depth)-1);
10900
10901 /* Grayscale input, we do not convert to RGB (TBD), so we must set the
10902 * background to gray - else libpng seems to fail.
10903 */
10904 background.red = background.green = background.blue = background.gray;
10905 }
10906
10907 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "gamma ");
10908 pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, file_gamma, 3);
10909 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "->");
10910 pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, screen_gamma, 3);
10911
10912 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, base);
10913 if (do_background < ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET)
10914 {
10915 /* Include the background color and gamma in the name: */
10916 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, "(");
10917 /* This assumes no expand gray->rgb - the current code won't handle that!
10918 */
10919 if (colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_COLOR)
10920 {
10921 pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.red);
10922 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ",");
10923 pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.green);
10924 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ",");
10925 pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.blue);
10926 }
10927 else
10928 pos = safecatn(name, sizeof name, pos, background.gray);
10929 pos = safecat(name, sizeof name, pos, ")^");
10930 pos = safecatd(name, sizeof name, pos, bg, 3);
10931 }
10932
10933 gamma_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number, interlace_type,
10934 file_gamma, screen_gamma, 0/*sBIT*/, 0, name, use_input_precision,
10935 0/*strip 16*/, expand_16, do_background, &background, bg);
10936 }
10937
10938
10939 static void
perform_gamma_composition_tests(png_modifier * pm,int do_background,int expand_16)10940 perform_gamma_composition_tests(png_modifier *pm, int do_background,
10941 int expand_16)
10942 {
10943 png_byte colour_type = 0;
10944 png_byte bit_depth = 0;
10945 unsigned int palette_number = 0;
10946
10947 /* Skip the non-alpha cases - there is no setting of a transparency colour at
10948 * present.
10949 *
10950 * TODO: incorrect; the palette case sets tRNS and, now RGB and gray do,
10951 * however the palette case fails miserably so is commented out below.
10952 */
10953 while (next_format(&colour_type, &bit_depth, &palette_number,
10954 pm->test_lbg_gamma_composition, pm->test_tRNS))
10955 if ((colour_type & PNG_COLOR_MASK_ALPHA) != 0
10956 #if 0 /* TODO: FIXME */
10957 /*TODO: FIXME: this should work */
10958 || colour_type == 3
10959 #endif
10960 || (colour_type != 3 && palette_number != 0))
10961 {
10962 unsigned int i, j;
10963
10964 /* Don't skip the i==j case here - it's relevant. */
10965 for (i=0; i<pm->ngamma_tests; ++i)
10966 {
10967 for (j=0; j<pm->ngamma_tests; ++j)
10968 {
10969 gamma_composition_test(pm, colour_type, bit_depth, palette_number,
10970 pm->interlace_type, 1/pm->gammas[i], pm->gammas[j],
10971 pm->use_input_precision, do_background, expand_16);
10972
10973 if (fail(pm))
10974 return;
10975 }
10976 }
10977 }
10978 }
10979 #endif /* READ_BACKGROUND || READ_ALPHA_MODE */
10980
10981 static void
init_gamma_errors(png_modifier * pm)10982 init_gamma_errors(png_modifier *pm)
10983 {
10984 /* Use -1 to catch tests that were not actually run */
10985 pm->error_gray_2 = pm->error_gray_4 = pm->error_gray_8 = -1.;
10986 pm->error_color_8 = -1.;
10987 pm->error_indexed = -1.;
10988 pm->error_gray_16 = pm->error_color_16 = -1.;
10989 }
10990
10991 static void
print_one(const char * leader,double err)10992 print_one(const char *leader, double err)
10993 {
10994 if (err != -1.)
10995 printf(" %s %.5f\n", leader, err);
10996 }
10997
10998 static void
summarize_gamma_errors(png_modifier * pm,png_const_charp who,int low_bit_depth,int indexed)10999 summarize_gamma_errors(png_modifier *pm, png_const_charp who, int low_bit_depth,
11000 int indexed)
11001 {
11002 fflush(stderr);
11003
11004 if (who)
11005 printf("\nGamma correction with %s:\n", who);
11006
11007 else
11008 printf("\nBasic gamma correction:\n");
11009
11010 if (low_bit_depth)
11011 {
11012 print_one(" 2 bit gray: ", pm->error_gray_2);
11013 print_one(" 4 bit gray: ", pm->error_gray_4);
11014 print_one(" 8 bit gray: ", pm->error_gray_8);
11015 print_one(" 8 bit color:", pm->error_color_8);
11016 if (indexed)
11017 print_one(" indexed: ", pm->error_indexed);
11018 }
11019
11020 print_one("16 bit gray: ", pm->error_gray_16);
11021 print_one("16 bit color:", pm->error_color_16);
11022
11023 fflush(stdout);
11024 }
11025
11026 static void
perform_gamma_test(png_modifier * pm,int summary)11027 perform_gamma_test(png_modifier *pm, int summary)
11028 {
11029 /*TODO: remove this*/
11030 /* Save certain values for the temporary overrides below. */
11031 unsigned int calculations_use_input_precision =
11032 pm->calculations_use_input_precision;
11033 # ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
11034 double maxout8 = pm->maxout8;
11035 # endif
11036
11037 /* First some arbitrary no-transform tests: */
11038 if (!pm->this.speed && pm->test_gamma_threshold)
11039 {
11040 perform_gamma_threshold_tests(pm);
11041
11042 if (fail(pm))
11043 return;
11044 }
11045
11046 /* Now some real transforms. */
11047 if (pm->test_gamma_transform)
11048 {
11049 if (summary)
11050 {
11051 fflush(stderr);
11052 printf("Gamma correction error summary\n\n");
11053 printf("The printed value is the maximum error in the pixel values\n");
11054 printf("calculated by the libpng gamma correction code. The error\n");
11055 printf("is calculated as the difference between the output pixel\n");
11056 printf("value (always an integer) and the ideal value from the\n");
11057 printf("libpng specification (typically not an integer).\n\n");
11058
11059 printf("Expect this value to be less than .5 for 8 bit formats,\n");
11060 printf("less than 1 for formats with fewer than 8 bits and a small\n");
11061 printf("number (typically less than 5) for the 16 bit formats.\n");
11062 printf("For performance reasons the value for 16 bit formats\n");
11063 printf("increases when the image file includes an sBIT chunk.\n");
11064 fflush(stdout);
11065 }
11066
11067 init_gamma_errors(pm);
11068 /*TODO: remove this. Necessary because the current libpng
11069 * implementation works in 8 bits:
11070 */
11071 if (pm->test_gamma_expand16)
11072 pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 1;
11073 perform_gamma_transform_tests(pm);
11074 if (!calculations_use_input_precision)
11075 pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
11076
11077 if (summary)
11078 summarize_gamma_errors(pm, NULL/*who*/, 1/*low bit depth*/, 1/*indexed*/);
11079
11080 if (fail(pm))
11081 return;
11082 }
11083
11084 /* The sbit tests produce much larger errors: */
11085 if (pm->test_gamma_sbit)
11086 {
11087 init_gamma_errors(pm);
11088 perform_gamma_sbit_tests(pm);
11089
11090 if (summary)
11091 summarize_gamma_errors(pm, "sBIT", pm->sbitlow < 8U, 1/*indexed*/);
11092
11093 if (fail(pm))
11094 return;
11095 }
11096
11097 #ifdef DO_16BIT /* Should be READ_16BIT_SUPPORTED */
11098 if (pm->test_gamma_scale16)
11099 {
11100 /* The 16 to 8 bit strip operations: */
11101 init_gamma_errors(pm);
11102 perform_gamma_scale16_tests(pm);
11103
11104 if (summary)
11105 {
11106 fflush(stderr);
11107 printf("\nGamma correction with 16 to 8 bit reduction:\n");
11108 printf(" 16 bit gray: %.5f\n", pm->error_gray_16);
11109 printf(" 16 bit color: %.5f\n", pm->error_color_16);
11110 fflush(stdout);
11111 }
11112
11113 if (fail(pm))
11114 return;
11115 }
11116 #endif
11117
11118 #ifdef PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
11119 if (pm->test_gamma_background)
11120 {
11121 init_gamma_errors(pm);
11122
11123 /*TODO: remove this. Necessary because the current libpng
11124 * implementation works in 8 bits:
11125 */
11126 if (pm->test_gamma_expand16)
11127 {
11128 pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 1;
11129 pm->maxout8 = .499; /* because the 16 bit background is smashed */
11130 }
11131 perform_gamma_composition_tests(pm, PNG_BACKGROUND_GAMMA_UNIQUE,
11132 pm->test_gamma_expand16);
11133 if (!calculations_use_input_precision)
11134 pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
11135 pm->maxout8 = maxout8;
11136
11137 if (summary)
11138 summarize_gamma_errors(pm, "background", 1, 0/*indexed*/);
11139
11140 if (fail(pm))
11141 return;
11142 }
11143 #endif
11144
11145 #ifdef PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
11146 if (pm->test_gamma_alpha_mode)
11147 {
11148 int do_background;
11149
11150 init_gamma_errors(pm);
11151
11152 /*TODO: remove this. Necessary because the current libpng
11153 * implementation works in 8 bits:
11154 */
11155 if (pm->test_gamma_expand16)
11156 pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 1;
11157 for (do_background = ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_STANDARD;
11158 do_background <= ALPHA_MODE_OFFSET + PNG_ALPHA_BROKEN && !fail(pm);
11159 ++do_background)
11160 perform_gamma_composition_tests(pm, do_background,
11161 pm->test_gamma_expand16);
11162 if (!calculations_use_input_precision)
11163 pm->calculations_use_input_precision = 0;
11164
11165 if (summary)
11166 summarize_gamma_errors(pm, "alpha mode", 1, 0/*indexed*/);
11167
11168 if (fail(pm))
11169 return;
11170 }
11171 #endif
11172 }
11173 #endif /* PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED */
11174 #endif /* PNG_READ_SUPPORTED */
11175
11176 /* INTERLACE MACRO VALIDATION */
11177 /* This is copied verbatim from the specification, it is simply the pass
11178 * number in which each pixel in each 8x8 tile appears. The array must
11179 * be indexed adam7[y][x] and notice that the pass numbers are based at
11180 * 1, not 0 - the base libpng uses.
11181 */
11182 static const
11183 png_byte adam7[8][8] =
11184 {
11185 { 1,6,4,6,2,6,4,6 },
11186 { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 },
11187 { 5,6,5,6,5,6,5,6 },
11188 { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 },
11189 { 3,6,4,6,3,6,4,6 },
11190 { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 },
11191 { 5,6,5,6,5,6,5,6 },
11192 { 7,7,7,7,7,7,7,7 }
11193 };
11194
11195 /* This routine validates all the interlace support macros in png.h for
11196 * a variety of valid PNG widths and heights. It uses a number of similarly
11197 * named internal routines that feed off the above array.
11198 */
11199 static png_uint_32
png_pass_start_row(int pass)11200 png_pass_start_row(int pass)
11201 {
11202 int x, y;
11203 ++pass;
11204 for (y=0; y<8; ++y)
11205 for (x=0; x<8; ++x)
11206 if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
11207 return y;
11208 return 0xf;
11209 }
11210
11211 static png_uint_32
png_pass_start_col(int pass)11212 png_pass_start_col(int pass)
11213 {
11214 int x, y;
11215 ++pass;
11216 for (x=0; x<8; ++x)
11217 for (y=0; y<8; ++y)
11218 if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
11219 return x;
11220 return 0xf;
11221 }
11222
11223 static int
png_pass_row_shift(int pass)11224 png_pass_row_shift(int pass)
11225 {
11226 int x, y, base=(-1), inc=8;
11227 ++pass;
11228 for (y=0; y<8; ++y)
11229 {
11230 for (x=0; x<8; ++x)
11231 {
11232 if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
11233 {
11234 if (base == (-1))
11235 base = y;
11236 else if (base == y)
11237 {}
11238 else if (inc == y-base)
11239 base=y;
11240 else if (inc == 8)
11241 inc = y-base, base=y;
11242 else if (inc != y-base)
11243 return 0xff; /* error - more than one 'inc' value! */
11244 }
11245 }
11246 }
11247
11248 if (base == (-1)) return 0xfe; /* error - no row in pass! */
11249
11250 /* The shift is always 1, 2 or 3 - no pass has all the rows! */
11251 switch (inc)
11252 {
11253 case 2: return 1;
11254 case 4: return 2;
11255 case 8: return 3;
11256 default: break;
11257 }
11258
11259 /* error - unrecognized 'inc' */
11260 return (inc << 8) + 0xfd;
11261 }
11262
11263 static int
png_pass_col_shift(int pass)11264 png_pass_col_shift(int pass)
11265 {
11266 int x, y, base=(-1), inc=8;
11267 ++pass;
11268 for (x=0; x<8; ++x)
11269 {
11270 for (y=0; y<8; ++y)
11271 {
11272 if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
11273 {
11274 if (base == (-1))
11275 base = x;
11276 else if (base == x)
11277 {}
11278 else if (inc == x-base)
11279 base=x;
11280 else if (inc == 8)
11281 inc = x-base, base=x;
11282 else if (inc != x-base)
11283 return 0xff; /* error - more than one 'inc' value! */
11284 }
11285 }
11286 }
11287
11288 if (base == (-1)) return 0xfe; /* error - no row in pass! */
11289
11290 /* The shift is always 1, 2 or 3 - no pass has all the rows! */
11291 switch (inc)
11292 {
11293 case 1: return 0; /* pass 7 has all the columns */
11294 case 2: return 1;
11295 case 4: return 2;
11296 case 8: return 3;
11297 default: break;
11298 }
11299
11300 /* error - unrecognized 'inc' */
11301 return (inc << 8) + 0xfd;
11302 }
11303
11304 static png_uint_32
png_row_from_pass_row(png_uint_32 yIn,int pass)11305 png_row_from_pass_row(png_uint_32 yIn, int pass)
11306 {
11307 /* By examination of the array: */
11308 switch (pass)
11309 {
11310 case 0: return yIn * 8;
11311 case 1: return yIn * 8;
11312 case 2: return yIn * 8 + 4;
11313 case 3: return yIn * 4;
11314 case 4: return yIn * 4 + 2;
11315 case 5: return yIn * 2;
11316 case 6: return yIn * 2 + 1;
11317 default: break;
11318 }
11319
11320 return 0xff; /* bad pass number */
11321 }
11322
11323 static png_uint_32
png_col_from_pass_col(png_uint_32 xIn,int pass)11324 png_col_from_pass_col(png_uint_32 xIn, int pass)
11325 {
11326 /* By examination of the array: */
11327 switch (pass)
11328 {
11329 case 0: return xIn * 8;
11330 case 1: return xIn * 8 + 4;
11331 case 2: return xIn * 4;
11332 case 3: return xIn * 4 + 2;
11333 case 4: return xIn * 2;
11334 case 5: return xIn * 2 + 1;
11335 case 6: return xIn;
11336 default: break;
11337 }
11338
11339 return 0xff; /* bad pass number */
11340 }
11341
11342 static int
png_row_in_interlace_pass(png_uint_32 y,int pass)11343 png_row_in_interlace_pass(png_uint_32 y, int pass)
11344 {
11345 /* Is row 'y' in pass 'pass'? */
11346 int x;
11347 y &= 7;
11348 ++pass;
11349 for (x=0; x<8; ++x)
11350 if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
11351 return 1;
11352
11353 return 0;
11354 }
11355
11356 static int
png_col_in_interlace_pass(png_uint_32 x,int pass)11357 png_col_in_interlace_pass(png_uint_32 x, int pass)
11358 {
11359 /* Is column 'x' in pass 'pass'? */
11360 int y;
11361 x &= 7;
11362 ++pass;
11363 for (y=0; y<8; ++y)
11364 if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
11365 return 1;
11366
11367 return 0;
11368 }
11369
11370 static png_uint_32
png_pass_rows(png_uint_32 height,int pass)11371 png_pass_rows(png_uint_32 height, int pass)
11372 {
11373 png_uint_32 tiles = height>>3;
11374 png_uint_32 rows = 0;
11375 unsigned int x, y;
11376
11377 height &= 7;
11378 ++pass;
11379 for (y=0; y<8; ++y)
11380 {
11381 for (x=0; x<8; ++x)
11382 {
11383 if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
11384 {
11385 rows += tiles;
11386 if (y < height) ++rows;
11387 break; /* i.e. break the 'x', column, loop. */
11388 }
11389 }
11390 }
11391
11392 return rows;
11393 }
11394
11395 static png_uint_32
png_pass_cols(png_uint_32 width,int pass)11396 png_pass_cols(png_uint_32 width, int pass)
11397 {
11398 png_uint_32 tiles = width>>3;
11399 png_uint_32 cols = 0;
11400 unsigned int x, y;
11401
11402 width &= 7;
11403 ++pass;
11404 for (x=0; x<8; ++x)
11405 {
11406 for (y=0; y<8; ++y)
11407 {
11408 if (adam7[y][x] == pass)
11409 {
11410 cols += tiles;
11411 if (x < width) ++cols;
11412 break; /* i.e. break the 'y', row, loop. */
11413 }
11414 }
11415 }
11416
11417 return cols;
11418 }
11419
11420 static void
perform_interlace_macro_validation(void)11421 perform_interlace_macro_validation(void)
11422 {
11423 /* The macros to validate, first those that depend only on pass:
11424 *
11425 * PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass)
11426 * PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass)
11427 * PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass)
11428 * PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass)
11429 */
11430 int pass;
11431
11432 for (pass=0; pass<7; ++pass)
11433 {
11434 png_uint_32 m, f, v;
11435
11436 m = PNG_PASS_START_ROW(pass);
11437 f = png_pass_start_row(pass);
11438 if (m != f)
11439 {
11440 fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_START_ROW(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
11441 exit(99);
11442 }
11443
11444 m = PNG_PASS_START_COL(pass);
11445 f = png_pass_start_col(pass);
11446 if (m != f)
11447 {
11448 fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_START_COL(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
11449 exit(99);
11450 }
11451
11452 m = PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(pass);
11453 f = png_pass_row_shift(pass);
11454 if (m != f)
11455 {
11456 fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_ROW_SHIFT(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
11457 exit(99);
11458 }
11459
11460 m = PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(pass);
11461 f = png_pass_col_shift(pass);
11462 if (m != f)
11463 {
11464 fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_COL_SHIFT(%d) = %u != %x\n", pass, m, f);
11465 exit(99);
11466 }
11467
11468 /* Macros that depend on the image or sub-image height too:
11469 *
11470 * PNG_PASS_ROWS(height, pass)
11471 * PNG_PASS_COLS(width, pass)
11472 * PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(yIn, pass)
11473 * PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(xIn, pass)
11474 * PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(y, pass)
11475 * PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(x, pass)
11476 */
11477 for (v=0;;)
11478 {
11479 /* The first two tests overflow if the pass row or column is outside
11480 * the possible range for a 32-bit result. In fact the values should
11481 * never be outside the range for a 31-bit result, but checking for 32
11482 * bits here ensures that if an app uses a bogus pass row or column
11483 * (just so long as it fits in a 32 bit integer) it won't get a
11484 * possibly dangerous overflow.
11485 */
11486 /* First the base 0 stuff: */
11487 if (v < png_pass_rows(0xFFFFFFFFU, pass))
11488 {
11489 m = PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(v, pass);
11490 f = png_row_from_pass_row(v, pass);
11491 if (m != f)
11492 {
11493 fprintf(stderr, "PNG_ROW_FROM_PASS_ROW(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
11494 v, pass, m, f);
11495 exit(99);
11496 }
11497 }
11498
11499 if (v < png_pass_cols(0xFFFFFFFFU, pass))
11500 {
11501 m = PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(v, pass);
11502 f = png_col_from_pass_col(v, pass);
11503 if (m != f)
11504 {
11505 fprintf(stderr, "PNG_COL_FROM_PASS_COL(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
11506 v, pass, m, f);
11507 exit(99);
11508 }
11509 }
11510
11511 m = PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(v, pass);
11512 f = png_row_in_interlace_pass(v, pass);
11513 if (m != f)
11514 {
11515 fprintf(stderr, "PNG_ROW_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
11516 v, pass, m, f);
11517 exit(99);
11518 }
11519
11520 m = PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(v, pass);
11521 f = png_col_in_interlace_pass(v, pass);
11522 if (m != f)
11523 {
11524 fprintf(stderr, "PNG_COL_IN_INTERLACE_PASS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
11525 v, pass, m, f);
11526 exit(99);
11527 }
11528
11529 /* Then the base 1 stuff: */
11530 ++v;
11531 m = PNG_PASS_ROWS(v, pass);
11532 f = png_pass_rows(v, pass);
11533 if (m != f)
11534 {
11535 fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_ROWS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
11536 v, pass, m, f);
11537 exit(99);
11538 }
11539
11540 m = PNG_PASS_COLS(v, pass);
11541 f = png_pass_cols(v, pass);
11542 if (m != f)
11543 {
11544 fprintf(stderr, "PNG_PASS_COLS(%u, %d) = %u != %x\n",
11545 v, pass, m, f);
11546 exit(99);
11547 }
11548
11549 /* Move to the next v - the stepping algorithm starts skipping
11550 * values above 1024.
11551 */
11552 if (v > 1024)
11553 {
11554 if (v == PNG_UINT_31_MAX)
11555 break;
11556
11557 v = (v << 1) ^ v;
11558 if (v >= PNG_UINT_31_MAX)
11559 v = PNG_UINT_31_MAX-1;
11560 }
11561 }
11562 }
11563 }
11564
11565 /* Test color encodings. These values are back-calculated from the published
11566 * chromaticities. The values are accurate to about 14 decimal places; 15 are
11567 * given. These values are much more accurate than the ones given in the spec,
11568 * which typically don't exceed 4 decimal places. This allows testing of the
11569 * libpng code to its theoretical accuracy of 4 decimal places. (If pngvalid
11570 * used the published errors the 'slack' permitted would have to be +/-.5E-4 or
11571 * more.)
11572 *
11573 * The png_modifier code assumes that encodings[0] is sRGB and treats it
11574 * specially: do not change the first entry in this list!
11575 */
11576 static const color_encoding test_encodings[] =
11577 {
11578 /* sRGB: must be first in this list! */
11579 /*gamma:*/ { 1/2.2,
11580 /*red: */ { 0.412390799265959, 0.212639005871510, 0.019330818715592 },
11581 /*green:*/ { 0.357584339383878, 0.715168678767756, 0.119194779794626 },
11582 /*blue: */ { 0.180480788401834, 0.072192315360734, 0.950532152249660} },
11583 /* Kodak ProPhoto (wide gamut) */
11584 /*gamma:*/ { 1/1.6 /*approximate: uses 1.8 power law compared to sRGB 2.4*/,
11585 /*red: */ { 0.797760489672303, 0.288071128229293, 0.000000000000000 },
11586 /*green:*/ { 0.135185837175740, 0.711843217810102, 0.000000000000000 },
11587 /*blue: */ { 0.031349349581525, 0.000085653960605, 0.825104602510460} },
11588 /* Adobe RGB (1998) */
11589 /*gamma:*/ { 1/(2+51./256),
11590 /*red: */ { 0.576669042910131, 0.297344975250536, 0.027031361386412 },
11591 /*green:*/ { 0.185558237906546, 0.627363566255466, 0.070688852535827 },
11592 /*blue: */ { 0.188228646234995, 0.075291458493998, 0.991337536837639} },
11593 /* Adobe Wide Gamut RGB */
11594 /*gamma:*/ { 1/(2+51./256),
11595 /*red: */ { 0.716500716779386, 0.258728243040113, 0.000000000000000 },
11596 /*green:*/ { 0.101020574397477, 0.724682314948566, 0.051211818965388 },
11597 /*blue: */ { 0.146774385252705, 0.016589442011321, 0.773892783545073} },
11598 /* Fake encoding which selects just the green channel */
11599 /*gamma:*/ { 1.45/2.2, /* the 'Mac' gamma */
11600 /*red: */ { 0.716500716779386, 0.000000000000000, 0.000000000000000 },
11601 /*green:*/ { 0.101020574397477, 1.000000000000000, 0.051211818965388 },
11602 /*blue: */ { 0.146774385252705, 0.000000000000000, 0.773892783545073} },
11603 };
11604
11605 /* signal handler
11606 *
11607 * This attempts to trap signals and escape without crashing. It needs a
11608 * context pointer so that it can throw an exception (call longjmp) to recover
11609 * from the condition; this is handled by making the png_modifier used by 'main'
11610 * into a global variable.
11611 */
11612 static png_modifier pm;
11613
signal_handler(int signum)11614 static void signal_handler(int signum)
11615 {
11616
11617 size_t pos = 0;
11618 char msg[64];
11619
11620 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "caught signal: ");
11621
11622 switch (signum)
11623 {
11624 case SIGABRT:
11625 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "abort");
11626 break;
11627
11628 case SIGFPE:
11629 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "floating point exception");
11630 break;
11631
11632 case SIGILL:
11633 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "illegal instruction");
11634 break;
11635
11636 case SIGINT:
11637 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "interrupt");
11638 break;
11639
11640 case SIGSEGV:
11641 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "invalid memory access");
11642 break;
11643
11644 case SIGTERM:
11645 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "termination request");
11646 break;
11647
11648 default:
11649 pos = safecat(msg, sizeof msg, pos, "unknown ");
11650 pos = safecatn(msg, sizeof msg, pos, signum);
11651 break;
11652 }
11653
11654 store_log(&pm.this, NULL/*png_structp*/, msg, 1/*error*/);
11655
11656 /* And finally throw an exception so we can keep going, unless this is
11657 * SIGTERM in which case stop now.
11658 */
11659 if (signum != SIGTERM)
11660 {
11661 struct exception_context *the_exception_context =
11662 &pm.this.exception_context;
11663
11664 Throw &pm.this;
11665 }
11666
11667 else
11668 exit(1);
11669 }
11670
11671 /* main program */
main(int argc,char ** argv)11672 int main(int argc, char **argv)
11673 {
11674 int summary = 1; /* Print the error summary at the end */
11675 int memstats = 0; /* Print memory statistics at the end */
11676
11677 /* Create the given output file on success: */
11678 const char *touch = NULL;
11679
11680 /* This is an array of standard gamma values (believe it or not I've seen
11681 * every one of these mentioned somewhere.)
11682 *
11683 * In the following list the most useful values are first!
11684 */
11685 static double
11686 gammas[]={2.2, 1.0, 2.2/1.45, 1.8, 1.5, 2.4, 2.5, 2.62, 2.9};
11687
11688 /* This records the command and arguments: */
11689 size_t cp = 0;
11690 char command[1024];
11691
11692 anon_context(&pm.this);
11693
11694 gnu_volatile(summary)
11695 gnu_volatile(memstats)
11696 gnu_volatile(touch)
11697
11698 /* Add appropriate signal handlers, just the ANSI specified ones: */
11699 signal(SIGABRT, signal_handler);
11700 signal(SIGFPE, signal_handler);
11701 signal(SIGILL, signal_handler);
11702 signal(SIGINT, signal_handler);
11703 signal(SIGSEGV, signal_handler);
11704 signal(SIGTERM, signal_handler);
11705
11706 #ifdef HAVE_FEENABLEEXCEPT
11707 /* Only required to enable FP exceptions on platforms where they start off
11708 * disabled; this is not necessary but if it is not done pngvalid will likely
11709 * end up ignoring FP conditions that other platforms fault.
11710 */
11711 feenableexcept(FE_DIVBYZERO | FE_INVALID | FE_OVERFLOW);
11712 #endif
11713
11714 modifier_init(&pm);
11715
11716 /* Preallocate the image buffer, because we know how big it needs to be,
11717 * note that, for testing purposes, it is deliberately mis-aligned by tag
11718 * bytes either side. All rows have an additional five bytes of padding for
11719 * overwrite checking.
11720 */
11721 store_ensure_image(&pm.this, NULL, 2, TRANSFORM_ROWMAX, TRANSFORM_HEIGHTMAX);
11722
11723 /* Don't give argv[0], it's normally some horrible libtool string: */
11724 cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, "pngvalid");
11725
11726 /* Default to error on warning: */
11727 pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors = 1;
11728
11729 /* Default assume_16_bit_calculations appropriately; this tells the checking
11730 * code that 16-bit arithmetic is used for 8-bit samples when it would make a
11731 * difference.
11732 */
11733 pm.assume_16_bit_calculations = PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10700;
11734
11735 /* Currently 16 bit expansion happens at the end of the pipeline, so the
11736 * calculations are done in the input bit depth not the output.
11737 *
11738 * TODO: fix this
11739 */
11740 pm.calculations_use_input_precision = 1U;
11741
11742 /* Store the test gammas */
11743 pm.gammas = gammas;
11744 pm.ngammas = ARRAY_SIZE(gammas);
11745 pm.ngamma_tests = 0; /* default to off */
11746
11747 /* Low bit depth gray images don't do well in the gamma tests, until
11748 * this is fixed turn them off for some gamma cases:
11749 */
11750 # ifdef PNG_WRITE_tRNS_SUPPORTED
11751 pm.test_tRNS = 1;
11752 # endif
11753 pm.test_lbg = PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10600;
11754 pm.test_lbg_gamma_threshold = 1;
11755 pm.test_lbg_gamma_transform = PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10600;
11756 pm.test_lbg_gamma_sbit = 1;
11757 pm.test_lbg_gamma_composition = PNG_LIBPNG_VER >= 10700;
11758
11759 /* And the test encodings */
11760 pm.encodings = test_encodings;
11761 pm.nencodings = ARRAY_SIZE(test_encodings);
11762
11763 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
11764 pm.sbitlow = 8U; /* because libpng doesn't do sBIT below 8! */
11765 # else
11766 pm.sbitlow = 1U;
11767 # endif
11768
11769 /* The following allows results to pass if they correspond to anything in the
11770 * transformed range [input-.5,input+.5]; this is is required because of the
11771 * way libpng treats the 16_TO_8 flag when building the gamma tables in
11772 * releases up to 1.6.0.
11773 *
11774 * TODO: review this
11775 */
11776 pm.use_input_precision_16to8 = 1U;
11777 pm.use_input_precision_sbit = 1U; /* because libpng now rounds sBIT */
11778
11779 /* Some default values (set the behavior for 'make check' here).
11780 * These values simply control the maximum error permitted in the gamma
11781 * transformations. The practical limits for human perception are described
11782 * below (the setting for maxpc16), however for 8 bit encodings it isn't
11783 * possible to meet the accepted capabilities of human vision - i.e. 8 bit
11784 * images can never be good enough, regardless of encoding.
11785 */
11786 pm.maxout8 = .1; /* Arithmetic error in *encoded* value */
11787 pm.maxabs8 = .00005; /* 1/20000 */
11788 pm.maxcalc8 = 1./255; /* +/-1 in 8 bits for compose errors */
11789 pm.maxpc8 = .499; /* I.e., .499% fractional error */
11790 pm.maxout16 = .499; /* Error in *encoded* value */
11791 pm.maxabs16 = .00005;/* 1/20000 */
11792 pm.maxcalc16 =1./65535;/* +/-1 in 16 bits for compose errors */
11793 # if PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10700
11794 pm.maxcalcG = 1./((1<<PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8)-1);
11795 # else
11796 pm.maxcalcG = 1./((1<<16)-1);
11797 # endif
11798
11799 /* NOTE: this is a reasonable perceptual limit. We assume that humans can
11800 * perceive light level differences of 1% over a 100:1 range, so we need to
11801 * maintain 1 in 10000 accuracy (in linear light space), which is what the
11802 * following guarantees. It also allows significantly higher errors at
11803 * higher 16 bit values, which is important for performance. The actual
11804 * maximum 16 bit error is about +/-1.9 in the fixed point implementation but
11805 * this is only allowed for values >38149 by the following:
11806 */
11807 pm.maxpc16 = .005; /* I.e., 1/200% - 1/20000 */
11808
11809 /* Now parse the command line options. */
11810 while (--argc >= 1)
11811 {
11812 int catmore = 0; /* Set if the argument has an argument. */
11813
11814 /* Record each argument for posterity: */
11815 cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, " ");
11816 cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, *++argv);
11817
11818 if (strcmp(*argv, "-v") == 0)
11819 pm.this.verbose = 1;
11820
11821 else if (strcmp(*argv, "-l") == 0)
11822 pm.log = 1;
11823
11824 else if (strcmp(*argv, "-q") == 0)
11825 summary = pm.this.verbose = pm.log = 0;
11826
11827 else if (strcmp(*argv, "-w") == 0 ||
11828 strcmp(*argv, "--strict") == 0)
11829 pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors = 1; /* NOTE: this is the default! */
11830
11831 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nostrict") == 0)
11832 pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors = 0;
11833
11834 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--speed") == 0)
11835 pm.this.speed = 1, pm.ngamma_tests = pm.ngammas, pm.test_standard = 0,
11836 summary = 0;
11837
11838 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--memory") == 0)
11839 memstats = 1;
11840
11841 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--size") == 0)
11842 pm.test_size = 1;
11843
11844 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nosize") == 0)
11845 pm.test_size = 0;
11846
11847 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--standard") == 0)
11848 pm.test_standard = 1;
11849
11850 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nostandard") == 0)
11851 pm.test_standard = 0;
11852
11853 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--transform") == 0)
11854 pm.test_transform = 1;
11855
11856 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--notransform") == 0)
11857 pm.test_transform = 0;
11858
11859 #ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
11860 else if (strncmp(*argv, "--transform-disable=",
11861 sizeof "--transform-disable") == 0)
11862 {
11863 pm.test_transform = 1;
11864 transform_disable(*argv + sizeof "--transform-disable");
11865 }
11866
11867 else if (strncmp(*argv, "--transform-enable=",
11868 sizeof "--transform-enable") == 0)
11869 {
11870 pm.test_transform = 1;
11871 transform_enable(*argv + sizeof "--transform-enable");
11872 }
11873 #endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
11874
11875 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma") == 0)
11876 {
11877 /* Just do two gamma tests here (2.2 and linear) for speed: */
11878 pm.ngamma_tests = 2U;
11879 pm.test_gamma_threshold = 1;
11880 pm.test_gamma_transform = 1;
11881 pm.test_gamma_sbit = 1;
11882 pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 1;
11883 pm.test_gamma_background = 1; /* composition */
11884 pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 1;
11885 }
11886
11887 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma") == 0)
11888 pm.ngamma_tests = 0;
11889
11890 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-threshold") == 0)
11891 pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_threshold = 1;
11892
11893 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-threshold") == 0)
11894 pm.test_gamma_threshold = 0;
11895
11896 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-transform") == 0)
11897 pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_transform = 1;
11898
11899 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-transform") == 0)
11900 pm.test_gamma_transform = 0;
11901
11902 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-sbit") == 0)
11903 pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_sbit = 1;
11904
11905 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-sbit") == 0)
11906 pm.test_gamma_sbit = 0;
11907
11908 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-16-to-8") == 0)
11909 pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 1;
11910
11911 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-16-to-8") == 0)
11912 pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 0;
11913
11914 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-background") == 0)
11915 pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_background = 1;
11916
11917 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-background") == 0)
11918 pm.test_gamma_background = 0;
11919
11920 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--gamma-alpha-mode") == 0)
11921 pm.ngamma_tests = 2U, pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 1;
11922
11923 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nogamma-alpha-mode") == 0)
11924 pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 0;
11925
11926 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--expand16") == 0)
11927 pm.test_gamma_expand16 = 1;
11928
11929 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--noexpand16") == 0)
11930 pm.test_gamma_expand16 = 0;
11931
11932 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--low-depth-gray") == 0)
11933 pm.test_lbg = pm.test_lbg_gamma_threshold =
11934 pm.test_lbg_gamma_transform = pm.test_lbg_gamma_sbit =
11935 pm.test_lbg_gamma_composition = 1;
11936
11937 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--nolow-depth-gray") == 0)
11938 pm.test_lbg = pm.test_lbg_gamma_threshold =
11939 pm.test_lbg_gamma_transform = pm.test_lbg_gamma_sbit =
11940 pm.test_lbg_gamma_composition = 0;
11941
11942 # ifdef PNG_WRITE_tRNS_SUPPORTED
11943 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--tRNS") == 0)
11944 pm.test_tRNS = 1;
11945 # endif
11946
11947 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--notRNS") == 0)
11948 pm.test_tRNS = 0;
11949
11950 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--more-gammas") == 0)
11951 pm.ngamma_tests = 3U;
11952
11953 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--all-gammas") == 0)
11954 pm.ngamma_tests = pm.ngammas;
11955
11956 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--progressive-read") == 0)
11957 pm.this.progressive = 1;
11958
11959 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--use-update-info") == 0)
11960 ++pm.use_update_info; /* Can call multiple times */
11961
11962 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--interlace") == 0)
11963 {
11964 # if CAN_WRITE_INTERLACE
11965 pm.interlace_type = PNG_INTERLACE_ADAM7;
11966 # else /* !CAN_WRITE_INTERLACE */
11967 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: no write interlace support\n");
11968 return SKIP;
11969 # endif /* !CAN_WRITE_INTERLACE */
11970 }
11971
11972 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--use-input-precision") == 0)
11973 pm.use_input_precision = 1U;
11974
11975 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--use-calculation-precision") == 0)
11976 pm.use_input_precision = 0;
11977
11978 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--calculations-use-input-precision") == 0)
11979 pm.calculations_use_input_precision = 1U;
11980
11981 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--assume-16-bit-calculations") == 0)
11982 pm.assume_16_bit_calculations = 1U;
11983
11984 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--calculations-follow-bit-depth") == 0)
11985 pm.calculations_use_input_precision =
11986 pm.assume_16_bit_calculations = 0;
11987
11988 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--exhaustive") == 0)
11989 pm.test_exhaustive = 1;
11990
11991 else if (argc > 1 && strcmp(*argv, "--sbitlow") == 0)
11992 --argc, pm.sbitlow = (png_byte)atoi(*++argv), catmore = 1;
11993
11994 else if (argc > 1 && strcmp(*argv, "--touch") == 0)
11995 --argc, touch = *++argv, catmore = 1;
11996
11997 else if (argc > 1 && strncmp(*argv, "--max", 5) == 0)
11998 {
11999 --argc;
12000
12001 if (strcmp(5+*argv, "abs8") == 0)
12002 pm.maxabs8 = atof(*++argv);
12003
12004 else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "abs16") == 0)
12005 pm.maxabs16 = atof(*++argv);
12006
12007 else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "calc8") == 0)
12008 pm.maxcalc8 = atof(*++argv);
12009
12010 else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "calc16") == 0)
12011 pm.maxcalc16 = atof(*++argv);
12012
12013 else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "out8") == 0)
12014 pm.maxout8 = atof(*++argv);
12015
12016 else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "out16") == 0)
12017 pm.maxout16 = atof(*++argv);
12018
12019 else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "pc8") == 0)
12020 pm.maxpc8 = atof(*++argv);
12021
12022 else if (strcmp(5+*argv, "pc16") == 0)
12023 pm.maxpc16 = atof(*++argv);
12024
12025 else
12026 {
12027 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %s: unknown 'max' option\n", *argv);
12028 exit(99);
12029 }
12030
12031 catmore = 1;
12032 }
12033
12034 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--log8") == 0)
12035 --argc, pm.log8 = atof(*++argv), catmore = 1;
12036
12037 else if (strcmp(*argv, "--log16") == 0)
12038 --argc, pm.log16 = atof(*++argv), catmore = 1;
12039
12040 #ifdef PNG_SET_OPTION_SUPPORTED
12041 else if (strncmp(*argv, "--option=", 9) == 0)
12042 {
12043 /* Syntax of the argument is <option>:{on|off} */
12044 const char *arg = 9+*argv;
12045 unsigned char option=0, setting=0;
12046
12047 #ifdef PNG_ARM_NEON
12048 if (strncmp(arg, "arm-neon:", 9) == 0)
12049 option = PNG_ARM_NEON, arg += 9;
12050
12051 else
12052 #endif
12053 #ifdef PNG_EXTENSIONS
12054 if (strncmp(arg, "extensions:", 11) == 0)
12055 option = PNG_EXTENSIONS, arg += 11;
12056
12057 else
12058 #endif
12059 #ifdef PNG_MAXIMUM_INFLATE_WINDOW
12060 if (strncmp(arg, "max-inflate-window:", 19) == 0)
12061 option = PNG_MAXIMUM_INFLATE_WINDOW, arg += 19;
12062
12063 else
12064 #endif
12065 {
12066 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %s: %s: unknown option\n", *argv, arg);
12067 exit(99);
12068 }
12069
12070 if (strcmp(arg, "off") == 0)
12071 setting = PNG_OPTION_OFF;
12072
12073 else if (strcmp(arg, "on") == 0)
12074 setting = PNG_OPTION_ON;
12075
12076 else
12077 {
12078 fprintf(stderr,
12079 "pngvalid: %s: %s: unknown setting (use 'on' or 'off')\n",
12080 *argv, arg);
12081 exit(99);
12082 }
12083
12084 pm.this.options[pm.this.noptions].option = option;
12085 pm.this.options[pm.this.noptions++].setting = setting;
12086 }
12087 #endif /* PNG_SET_OPTION_SUPPORTED */
12088
12089 else
12090 {
12091 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %s: unknown argument\n", *argv);
12092 exit(99);
12093 }
12094
12095 if (catmore) /* consumed an extra *argv */
12096 {
12097 cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, " ");
12098 cp = safecat(command, sizeof command, cp, *argv);
12099 }
12100 }
12101
12102 /* If pngvalid is run with no arguments default to a reasonable set of the
12103 * tests.
12104 */
12105 if (pm.test_standard == 0 && pm.test_size == 0 && pm.test_transform == 0 &&
12106 pm.ngamma_tests == 0)
12107 {
12108 /* Make this do all the tests done in the test shell scripts with the same
12109 * parameters, where possible. The limitation is that all the progressive
12110 * read and interlace stuff has to be done in separate runs, so only the
12111 * basic 'standard' and 'size' tests are done.
12112 */
12113 pm.test_standard = 1;
12114 pm.test_size = 1;
12115 pm.test_transform = 1;
12116 pm.ngamma_tests = 2U;
12117 }
12118
12119 if (pm.ngamma_tests > 0 &&
12120 pm.test_gamma_threshold == 0 && pm.test_gamma_transform == 0 &&
12121 pm.test_gamma_sbit == 0 && pm.test_gamma_scale16 == 0 &&
12122 pm.test_gamma_background == 0 && pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode == 0)
12123 {
12124 pm.test_gamma_threshold = 1;
12125 pm.test_gamma_transform = 1;
12126 pm.test_gamma_sbit = 1;
12127 pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 1;
12128 pm.test_gamma_background = 1;
12129 pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 1;
12130 }
12131
12132 else if (pm.ngamma_tests == 0)
12133 {
12134 /* Nothing to test so turn everything off: */
12135 pm.test_gamma_threshold = 0;
12136 pm.test_gamma_transform = 0;
12137 pm.test_gamma_sbit = 0;
12138 pm.test_gamma_scale16 = 0;
12139 pm.test_gamma_background = 0;
12140 pm.test_gamma_alpha_mode = 0;
12141 }
12142
12143 Try
12144 {
12145 /* Make useful base images */
12146 make_transform_images(&pm);
12147
12148 /* Perform the standard and gamma tests. */
12149 if (pm.test_standard)
12150 {
12151 perform_interlace_macro_validation();
12152 perform_formatting_test(&pm.this);
12153 # ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
12154 perform_standard_test(&pm);
12155 # endif
12156 perform_error_test(&pm);
12157 }
12158
12159 /* Various oddly sized images: */
12160 if (pm.test_size)
12161 {
12162 make_size_images(&pm.this);
12163 # ifdef PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
12164 perform_size_test(&pm);
12165 # endif
12166 }
12167
12168 #ifdef PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
12169 /* Combinatorial transforms: */
12170 if (pm.test_transform)
12171 perform_transform_test(&pm);
12172 #endif /* PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED */
12173
12174 #ifdef PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED
12175 if (pm.ngamma_tests > 0)
12176 perform_gamma_test(&pm, summary);
12177 #endif
12178 }
12179
12180 Catch_anonymous
12181 {
12182 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: test aborted (probably failed in cleanup)\n");
12183 if (!pm.this.verbose)
12184 {
12185 if (pm.this.error[0] != 0)
12186 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: first error: %s\n", pm.this.error);
12187
12188 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: run with -v to see what happened\n");
12189 }
12190 exit(1);
12191 }
12192
12193 if (summary)
12194 {
12195 printf("%s: %s (%s point arithmetic)\n",
12196 (pm.this.nerrors || (pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors &&
12197 pm.this.nwarnings)) ? "FAIL" : "PASS",
12198 command,
12199 #if defined(PNG_FLOATING_ARITHMETIC_SUPPORTED) || PNG_LIBPNG_VER < 10500
12200 "floating"
12201 #else
12202 "fixed"
12203 #endif
12204 );
12205 }
12206
12207 if (memstats)
12208 {
12209 printf("Allocated memory statistics (in bytes):\n"
12210 "\tread %lu maximum single, %lu peak, %lu total\n"
12211 "\twrite %lu maximum single, %lu peak, %lu total\n",
12212 (unsigned long)pm.this.read_memory_pool.max_max,
12213 (unsigned long)pm.this.read_memory_pool.max_limit,
12214 (unsigned long)pm.this.read_memory_pool.max_total,
12215 (unsigned long)pm.this.write_memory_pool.max_max,
12216 (unsigned long)pm.this.write_memory_pool.max_limit,
12217 (unsigned long)pm.this.write_memory_pool.max_total);
12218 }
12219
12220 /* Do this here to provoke memory corruption errors in memory not directly
12221 * allocated by libpng - not a complete test, but better than nothing.
12222 */
12223 store_delete(&pm.this);
12224
12225 /* Error exit if there are any errors, and maybe if there are any
12226 * warnings.
12227 */
12228 if (pm.this.nerrors || (pm.this.treat_warnings_as_errors &&
12229 pm.this.nwarnings))
12230 {
12231 if (!pm.this.verbose)
12232 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %s\n", pm.this.error);
12233
12234 fprintf(stderr, "pngvalid: %d errors, %d warnings\n", pm.this.nerrors,
12235 pm.this.nwarnings);
12236
12237 exit(1);
12238 }
12239
12240 /* Success case. */
12241 if (touch != NULL)
12242 {
12243 FILE *fsuccess = fopen(touch, "wt");
12244
12245 if (fsuccess != NULL)
12246 {
12247 int error = 0;
12248 fprintf(fsuccess, "PNG validation succeeded\n");
12249 fflush(fsuccess);
12250 error = ferror(fsuccess);
12251
12252 if (fclose(fsuccess) || error)
12253 {
12254 fprintf(stderr, "%s: write failed\n", touch);
12255 exit(1);
12256 }
12257 }
12258
12259 else
12260 {
12261 fprintf(stderr, "%s: open failed\n", touch);
12262 exit(1);
12263 }
12264 }
12265
12266 /* This is required because some very minimal configurations do not use it:
12267 */
12268 UNUSED(fail)
12269 return 0;
12270 }
12271 #else /* write or low level APIs not supported */
main(void)12272 int main(void)
12273 {
12274 fprintf(stderr,
12275 "pngvalid: no low level write support in libpng, all tests skipped\n");
12276 /* So the test is skipped: */
12277 return SKIP;
12278 }
12279 #endif
12280